]>
Commit | Line | Data |
---|---|---|
1 | /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB. | |
2 | ||
3 | Copyright (C) 1986-2025 Free Software Foundation, Inc. | |
4 | ||
5 | This file is part of GDB. | |
6 | ||
7 | This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify | |
8 | it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by | |
9 | the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or | |
10 | (at your option) any later version. | |
11 | ||
12 | This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
13 | but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
14 | MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
15 | GNU General Public License for more details. | |
16 | ||
17 | You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
18 | along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ | |
19 | ||
20 | #include "arch-utils.h" | |
21 | #include <ctype.h> | |
22 | #include "event-top.h" | |
23 | #include "exceptions.h" | |
24 | #include "gdbsupport/gdb_vecs.h" | |
25 | #include "gdbsupport/unordered_set.h" | |
26 | #include "symtab.h" | |
27 | #include "frame.h" | |
28 | #include "breakpoint.h" | |
29 | #include "tracepoint.h" | |
30 | #include "gdbtypes.h" | |
31 | #include "expression.h" | |
32 | #include "gdbcore.h" | |
33 | #include "cli/cli-cmds.h" | |
34 | #include "value.h" | |
35 | #include "command.h" | |
36 | #include "inferior.h" | |
37 | #include "infrun.h" | |
38 | #include "gdbthread.h" | |
39 | #include "target.h" | |
40 | #include "language.h" | |
41 | #include "gdb-demangle.h" | |
42 | #include "filenames.h" | |
43 | #include "annotate.h" | |
44 | #include "symfile.h" | |
45 | #include "objfiles.h" | |
46 | #include "source.h" | |
47 | #include "linespec.h" | |
48 | #include "completer.h" | |
49 | #include "ui-out.h" | |
50 | #include "cli/cli-script.h" | |
51 | #include "block.h" | |
52 | #include "solib.h" | |
53 | #include "observable.h" | |
54 | #include "memattr.h" | |
55 | #include "ada-lang.h" | |
56 | #include "top.h" | |
57 | #include "ui.h" | |
58 | #include "valprint.h" | |
59 | #include "jit.h" | |
60 | #include "parser-defs.h" | |
61 | #include "probe.h" | |
62 | #include "cli/cli-utils.h" | |
63 | #include "stack.h" | |
64 | #include "ax-gdb.h" | |
65 | #include "dummy-frame.h" | |
66 | #include "interps.h" | |
67 | #include "gdbsupport/format.h" | |
68 | #include "thread-fsm.h" | |
69 | #include "tid-parse.h" | |
70 | #include "cli/cli-style.h" | |
71 | #include "cli/cli-decode.h" | |
72 | #include "break-cond-parse.h" | |
73 | ||
74 | /* readline include files */ | |
75 | #include "readline/tilde.h" | |
76 | ||
77 | /* readline defines this. */ | |
78 | #undef savestring | |
79 | ||
80 | #include "mi/mi-common.h" | |
81 | #include "extension.h" | |
82 | #include <algorithm> | |
83 | #include "progspace-and-thread.h" | |
84 | #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h" | |
85 | #include <optional> | |
86 | #include "gdbsupport/common-utils.h" | |
87 | ||
88 | /* Prototypes for local functions. */ | |
89 | ||
90 | static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *, | |
91 | gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>); | |
92 | ||
93 | static void parse_breakpoint_sals (location_spec *locspec, | |
94 | linespec_result *canonical, | |
95 | program_space *search_pspace); | |
96 | ||
97 | static void breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b, | |
98 | program_space *filter_pspace); | |
99 | ||
100 | static void create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *, | |
101 | struct linespec_result *, | |
102 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, | |
103 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>, | |
104 | enum bptype, | |
105 | enum bpdisp, int, int, int, | |
106 | int, | |
107 | int, int, int, unsigned); | |
108 | ||
109 | static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint | |
110 | (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals); | |
111 | ||
112 | static void mention (const breakpoint *); | |
113 | ||
114 | static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); | |
115 | ||
116 | static breakpoint *add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b); | |
117 | ||
118 | static struct breakpoint * | |
119 | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | |
120 | enum bptype type, | |
121 | int loc_enabled, int thread); | |
122 | ||
123 | static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, bool); | |
124 | ||
125 | static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
126 | CORE_ADDR bpaddr, | |
127 | enum bptype bptype, | |
128 | struct program_space *pspace); | |
129 | ||
130 | static bool watchpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | |
131 | const struct bp_location *loc2); | |
132 | ||
133 | static bool breakpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | |
134 | const struct bp_location *loc2, | |
135 | bool sw_hw_bps_match = false); | |
136 | ||
137 | static bool breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | |
138 | const struct address_space *aspace, | |
139 | CORE_ADDR addr); | |
140 | ||
141 | static bool breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *, | |
142 | const address_space *, | |
143 | CORE_ADDR, int); | |
144 | ||
145 | static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *); | |
146 | static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason); | |
147 | ||
148 | static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs); | |
149 | ||
150 | static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void); | |
151 | ||
152 | static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *); | |
153 | ||
154 | static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | |
155 | enum bptype type, | |
156 | int *other_type_used); | |
157 | ||
158 | static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp, | |
159 | int count); | |
160 | ||
161 | static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc); | |
162 | ||
163 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec | |
164 | (struct breakpoint *b, | |
165 | location_spec *locspec, | |
166 | struct program_space *search_pspace); | |
167 | ||
168 | static bool bl_address_is_meaningful (const bp_location *loc); | |
169 | ||
170 | static int find_loc_num_by_location (const bp_location *loc); | |
171 | ||
172 | /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to | |
173 | insert locations now. */ | |
174 | enum ugll_insert_mode | |
175 | { | |
176 | /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only | |
177 | remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be | |
178 | inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints | |
179 | should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't | |
180 | have the side effect of inserting the locations of other | |
181 | breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted | |
182 | returns true on them. | |
183 | ||
184 | This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g., | |
185 | after an exec, while the target still has execution, but | |
186 | breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT* | |
187 | be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the | |
188 | target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from | |
189 | GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from | |
190 | the inferior. */ | |
191 | UGLL_DONT_INSERT, | |
192 | ||
193 | /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now | |
194 | claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */ | |
195 | UGLL_MAY_INSERT, | |
196 | ||
197 | /* Insert locations now, irrespective of | |
198 | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are | |
199 | stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to | |
200 | insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but | |
201 | UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because | |
202 | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point, | |
203 | as no thread is running yet. */ | |
204 | UGLL_INSERT | |
205 | }; | |
206 | ||
207 | /* Return a textual version of INSERT_MODE. */ | |
208 | ||
209 | static const char * | |
210 | ugll_insert_mode_text (ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | |
211 | { | |
212 | /* Make sure the compiler warns if a new ugll_insert_mode enumerator is added | |
213 | but not handled here. */ | |
214 | DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH | |
215 | DIAGNOSTIC_ERROR_SWITCH | |
216 | switch (insert_mode) | |
217 | { | |
218 | case UGLL_DONT_INSERT: | |
219 | return "UGLL_DONT_INSERT"; | |
220 | case UGLL_MAY_INSERT: | |
221 | return "UGLL_MAY_INSERT"; | |
222 | case UGLL_INSERT: | |
223 | return "UGLL_INSERT"; | |
224 | } | |
225 | DIAGNOSTIC_POP | |
226 | ||
227 | gdb_assert_not_reached ("must handle all enum values"); | |
228 | } | |
229 | ||
230 | /* Return a textual version of REASON. */ | |
231 | ||
232 | static const char * | |
233 | remove_bp_reason_str (remove_bp_reason reason) | |
234 | { | |
235 | /* Make sure the compiler warns if a new remove_bp_reason enumerator is added | |
236 | but not handled here. */ | |
237 | DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH | |
238 | DIAGNOSTIC_ERROR_SWITCH | |
239 | switch (reason) | |
240 | { | |
241 | case REMOVE_BREAKPOINT: | |
242 | return "regular remove"; | |
243 | case DETACH_BREAKPOINT: | |
244 | return "detach"; | |
245 | } | |
246 | DIAGNOSTIC_POP | |
247 | ||
248 | gdb_assert_not_reached ("must handle all enum values"); | |
249 | } | |
250 | ||
251 | /* Return a textual version of breakpoint location BL describing number, | |
252 | location and address. */ | |
253 | ||
254 | static std::string | |
255 | breakpoint_location_address_str (const bp_location *bl) | |
256 | { | |
257 | std::string str = string_printf ("Breakpoint %d (%s) ", | |
258 | bl->owner->number, | |
259 | host_address_to_string (bl)); | |
260 | ||
261 | if (bl_address_is_meaningful (bl)) | |
262 | { | |
263 | gdb_assert (bl->gdbarch != nullptr); | |
264 | str += string_printf ("at address %s", | |
265 | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | |
266 | ||
267 | std::string loc_string = bl->to_string (); | |
268 | if (!loc_string.empty ()) | |
269 | str += string_printf (" %s", loc_string.c_str ()); | |
270 | } | |
271 | else | |
272 | str += "with dummy location"; | |
273 | ||
274 | return str; | |
275 | } | |
276 | ||
277 | static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode); | |
278 | ||
279 | static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode); | |
280 | ||
281 | static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void); | |
282 | ||
283 | static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int); | |
284 | ||
285 | static void set_tracepoint_count (int num); | |
286 | ||
287 | static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b); | |
288 | ||
289 | /* Return true if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), | |
290 | zero otherwise. */ | |
291 | ||
292 | static bool strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b); | |
293 | ||
294 | static void bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec | |
295 | (location_spec *locspec, | |
296 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
297 | struct program_space *search_pspace); | |
298 | ||
299 | const struct breakpoint_ops code_breakpoint_ops = | |
300 | { | |
301 | parse_breakpoint_sals, | |
302 | create_breakpoints_sal, | |
303 | }; | |
304 | ||
305 | /* Breakpoints set on probes. */ | |
306 | static const struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops = | |
307 | { | |
308 | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec, | |
309 | create_breakpoints_sal, | |
310 | }; | |
311 | ||
312 | /* Tracepoints set on probes. We use the same methods as for breakpoints | |
313 | on probes. */ | |
314 | static const struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops = | |
315 | { | |
316 | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec, | |
317 | create_breakpoints_sal, | |
318 | }; | |
319 | ||
320 | /* Implementation of abstract dtors. These must exist to satisfy the | |
321 | linker. */ | |
322 | ||
323 | breakpoint::~breakpoint () | |
324 | { | |
325 | } | |
326 | ||
327 | code_breakpoint::~code_breakpoint () | |
328 | { | |
329 | } | |
330 | ||
331 | catchpoint::~catchpoint () | |
332 | { | |
333 | } | |
334 | ||
335 | /* The structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */ | |
336 | struct ordinary_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | |
337 | { | |
338 | using code_breakpoint::code_breakpoint; | |
339 | ||
340 | int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | |
341 | enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | |
342 | void print_mention () const override; | |
343 | void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | |
344 | }; | |
345 | ||
346 | /* Internal breakpoints. These typically have a lifetime the same as | |
347 | the program, and they end up installed on the breakpoint chain with | |
348 | a negative breakpoint number. They're visible in "maint info | |
349 | breakpoints", but not "info breakpoints". */ | |
350 | struct internal_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | |
351 | { | |
352 | internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
353 | enum bptype type, CORE_ADDR address) | |
354 | : code_breakpoint (gdbarch, type) | |
355 | { | |
356 | symtab_and_line sal; | |
357 | sal.pc = address; | |
358 | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc); | |
359 | sal.pspace = current_program_space; | |
360 | add_location (sal); | |
361 | ||
362 | pspace = current_program_space; | |
363 | disposition = disp_donttouch; | |
364 | } | |
365 | ||
366 | void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | |
367 | void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; | |
368 | enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | |
369 | void print_mention () const override; | |
370 | }; | |
371 | ||
372 | /* Momentary breakpoints. These typically have a lifetime of some run | |
373 | control command only, are always thread-specific, and have 0 for | |
374 | breakpoint number. I.e., there can be many momentary breakpoints | |
375 | on the breakpoint chain and they all same the same number (zero). | |
376 | They're visible in "maint info breakpoints", but not "info | |
377 | breakpoints". */ | |
378 | struct momentary_breakpoint : public code_breakpoint | |
379 | { | |
380 | momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, enum bptype bptype, | |
381 | program_space *pspace_, | |
382 | const struct frame_id &frame_id_, | |
383 | int thread_) | |
384 | : code_breakpoint (gdbarch_, bptype) | |
385 | { | |
386 | /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined | |
387 | or tail-called one. */ | |
388 | gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); | |
389 | ||
390 | /* Momentary breakpoints are always thread-specific. */ | |
391 | gdb_assert (thread_ > 0); | |
392 | ||
393 | pspace = pspace_; | |
394 | enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
395 | disposition = disp_donttouch; | |
396 | frame_id = frame_id_; | |
397 | thread = thread_; | |
398 | ||
399 | /* The inferior should have been set by the parent constructor. */ | |
400 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1); | |
401 | } | |
402 | ||
403 | void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | |
404 | void check_status (struct bpstat *bs) override; | |
405 | enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | |
406 | void print_mention () const override; | |
407 | }; | |
408 | ||
409 | /* DPrintf breakpoints. */ | |
410 | struct dprintf_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint | |
411 | { | |
412 | using ordinary_breakpoint::ordinary_breakpoint; | |
413 | ||
414 | void re_set (program_space *pspace) override; | |
415 | int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
416 | const address_space *aspace, | |
417 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
418 | const target_waitstatus &ws) override; | |
419 | void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | |
420 | void after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) override; | |
421 | }; | |
422 | ||
423 | /* Ranged breakpoints. */ | |
424 | struct ranged_breakpoint : public ordinary_breakpoint | |
425 | { | |
426 | explicit ranged_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
427 | const symtab_and_line &sal_start, | |
428 | int length, | |
429 | location_spec_up start_locspec, | |
430 | location_spec_up end_locspec) | |
431 | : ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_hardware_breakpoint) | |
432 | { | |
433 | bp_location *bl = add_location (sal_start); | |
434 | bl->length = length; | |
435 | ||
436 | disposition = disp_donttouch; | |
437 | ||
438 | locspec = std::move (start_locspec); | |
439 | locspec_range_end = std::move (end_locspec); | |
440 | } | |
441 | ||
442 | int breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
443 | const address_space *aspace, | |
444 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
445 | const target_waitstatus &ws) override; | |
446 | int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | |
447 | enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | |
448 | bool print_one (const bp_location **) const override; | |
449 | void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; | |
450 | void print_mention () const override; | |
451 | void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | |
452 | }; | |
453 | ||
454 | /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */ | |
455 | struct static_marker_tracepoint : public tracepoint | |
456 | { | |
457 | using tracepoint::tracepoint; | |
458 | ||
459 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_spec | |
460 | (struct location_spec *locspec, | |
461 | struct program_space *search_pspace) override; | |
462 | }; | |
463 | ||
464 | /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user | |
465 | option because different output options have different tradeoffs; | |
466 | if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there | |
467 | is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior | |
468 | function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of | |
469 | output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */ | |
470 | ||
471 | static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb"; | |
472 | static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call"; | |
473 | static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent"; | |
474 | static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = { | |
475 | dprintf_style_gdb, | |
476 | dprintf_style_call, | |
477 | dprintf_style_agent, | |
478 | NULL | |
479 | }; | |
480 | static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb; | |
481 | ||
482 | /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | |
483 | call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is | |
484 | copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can | |
485 | evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */ | |
486 | ||
487 | static std::string dprintf_function = "printf"; | |
488 | ||
489 | /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to | |
490 | call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to | |
491 | the call as the first argument, with the format string as the | |
492 | second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that | |
493 | GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like | |
494 | "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like | |
495 | "mystreams[curlogger]". */ | |
496 | ||
497 | static std::string dprintf_channel; | |
498 | ||
499 | /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB | |
500 | has disconnected. */ | |
501 | static bool disconnected_dprintf = true; | |
502 | ||
503 | struct command_line * | |
504 | breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b) | |
505 | { | |
506 | return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; | |
507 | } | |
508 | ||
509 | /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the | |
510 | current breakpoint. */ | |
511 | ||
512 | static bool breakpoint_proceeded; | |
513 | ||
514 | const char * | |
515 | bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp) | |
516 | { | |
517 | /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and | |
518 | represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at | |
519 | a breakpoint. */ | |
520 | static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"}; | |
521 | ||
522 | return bpdisps[(int) disp]; | |
523 | } | |
524 | ||
525 | /* Prototypes for exported functions. */ | |
526 | /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even | |
527 | if such is available. */ | |
528 | static int can_use_hw_watchpoints; | |
529 | ||
530 | static void | |
531 | show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
532 | struct cmd_list_element *c, | |
533 | const char *value) | |
534 | { | |
535 | gdb_printf (file, | |
536 | _("Debugger's willingness to use " | |
537 | "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"), | |
538 | value); | |
539 | } | |
540 | ||
541 | /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints. | |
542 | If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints | |
543 | for unrecognized breakpoint locations. | |
544 | If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */ | |
545 | static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support; | |
546 | static void | |
547 | show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
548 | struct cmd_list_element *c, | |
549 | const char *value) | |
550 | { | |
551 | gdb_printf (file, | |
552 | _("Debugger's behavior regarding " | |
553 | "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"), | |
554 | value); | |
555 | } | |
556 | ||
557 | /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints | |
558 | set with "break" but falling in read-only memory. | |
559 | If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically | |
560 | use hardware breakpoints. */ | |
561 | static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints; | |
562 | static void | |
563 | show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
564 | struct cmd_list_element *c, | |
565 | const char *value) | |
566 | { | |
567 | gdb_printf (file, | |
568 | _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"), | |
569 | value); | |
570 | } | |
571 | ||
572 | /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is | |
573 | stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as | |
574 | they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of | |
575 | the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting | |
576 | breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the | |
577 | target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while | |
578 | processing user input. */ | |
579 | static bool always_inserted_mode = false; | |
580 | ||
581 | static void | |
582 | show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
583 | struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | |
584 | { | |
585 | gdb_printf (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"), | |
586 | value); | |
587 | } | |
588 | ||
589 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
590 | bool debug_breakpoint = false; | |
591 | ||
592 | /* "show debug breakpoint" implementation. */ | |
593 | static void | |
594 | show_debug_breakpoint (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
595 | struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | |
596 | { | |
597 | gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint location debugging is %s.\n"), value); | |
598 | } | |
599 | ||
600 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
601 | ||
602 | int | |
603 | breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void) | |
604 | { | |
605 | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ())) | |
606 | { | |
607 | /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no | |
608 | thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are | |
609 | no threads under GDB's control yet. */ | |
610 | return 1; | |
611 | } | |
612 | else | |
613 | { | |
614 | if (always_inserted_mode) | |
615 | { | |
616 | /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads | |
617 | are stopped. */ | |
618 | return 1; | |
619 | } | |
620 | ||
621 | for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | |
622 | if (inf->has_execution () | |
623 | && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ())) | |
624 | return 1; | |
625 | ||
626 | /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are | |
627 | stopped, we still have events to process. */ | |
628 | for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ()) | |
629 | if (tp->resumed () && tp->has_pending_waitstatus ()) | |
630 | return 1; | |
631 | } | |
632 | return 0; | |
633 | } | |
634 | ||
635 | static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target"; | |
636 | ||
637 | /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */ | |
638 | static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto"; | |
639 | static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host"; | |
640 | static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target"; | |
641 | static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = { | |
642 | condition_evaluation_auto, | |
643 | condition_evaluation_host, | |
644 | condition_evaluation_target, | |
645 | NULL | |
646 | }; | |
647 | ||
648 | /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */ | |
649 | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto; | |
650 | ||
651 | /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from | |
652 | condition_evaluation_mode_1. */ | |
653 | static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto; | |
654 | ||
655 | /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host" | |
656 | or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the | |
657 | real setting that is being used. It returns the translated | |
658 | evaluation mode. */ | |
659 | ||
660 | static const char * | |
661 | translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode) | |
662 | { | |
663 | if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | |
664 | { | |
665 | if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
666 | return condition_evaluation_target; | |
667 | else | |
668 | return condition_evaluation_host; | |
669 | } | |
670 | else | |
671 | return mode; | |
672 | } | |
673 | ||
674 | /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */ | |
675 | ||
676 | static const char * | |
677 | breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void) | |
678 | { | |
679 | return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | |
680 | } | |
681 | ||
682 | /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false | |
683 | otherwise. */ | |
684 | ||
685 | static bool | |
686 | gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void) | |
687 | { | |
688 | const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (); | |
689 | ||
690 | return (mode == condition_evaluation_host); | |
691 | } | |
692 | ||
693 | /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */ | |
694 | static int executing_breakpoint_commands; | |
695 | ||
696 | /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */ | |
697 | static int overlay_events_enabled; | |
698 | ||
699 | /* See description in breakpoint.h. */ | |
700 | bool target_exact_watchpoints = false; | |
701 | ||
702 | /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */ | |
703 | ||
704 | static intrusive_list<breakpoint> breakpoint_chain; | |
705 | ||
706 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
707 | ||
708 | breakpoint_range | |
709 | all_breakpoints () | |
710 | { | |
711 | return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain.begin (), breakpoint_chain.end ()); | |
712 | } | |
713 | ||
714 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
715 | ||
716 | breakpoint_safe_range | |
717 | all_breakpoints_safe () | |
718 | { | |
719 | return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ()); | |
720 | } | |
721 | ||
722 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
723 | ||
724 | tracepoint_range | |
725 | all_tracepoints () | |
726 | { | |
727 | return tracepoint_range (tracepoint_iterator (breakpoint_chain.begin ()), | |
728 | tracepoint_iterator (breakpoint_chain.end ())); | |
729 | } | |
730 | ||
731 | /* Array is sorted by bp_location_ptr_is_less_than - primarily by the | |
732 | ADDRESS. */ | |
733 | ||
734 | static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations; | |
735 | ||
736 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
737 | ||
738 | const std::vector<bp_location *> & | |
739 | all_bp_locations () | |
740 | { | |
741 | return bp_locations; | |
742 | } | |
743 | ||
744 | /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address. */ | |
745 | ||
746 | struct bp_locations_at_addr_range | |
747 | { | |
748 | using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator; | |
749 | ||
750 | bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr) | |
751 | { | |
752 | struct compare | |
753 | { | |
754 | bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const | |
755 | { return loc->address < addr_; } | |
756 | ||
757 | bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const | |
758 | { return addr_ < loc->address; } | |
759 | }; | |
760 | ||
761 | auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), | |
762 | addr, compare ()); | |
763 | ||
764 | m_begin = it_pair.first; | |
765 | m_end = it_pair.second; | |
766 | } | |
767 | ||
768 | iterator begin () const | |
769 | { return m_begin; } | |
770 | ||
771 | iterator end () const | |
772 | { return m_end; } | |
773 | ||
774 | private: | |
775 | iterator m_begin; | |
776 | iterator m_end; | |
777 | }; | |
778 | ||
779 | /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address | |
780 | ADDR. | |
781 | ||
782 | If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible | |
783 | to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times: | |
784 | ||
785 | auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr); | |
786 | ||
787 | for (bp_location *loc : range) | |
788 | // use loc | |
789 | ||
790 | for (bp_location *loc : range) | |
791 | // use loc | |
792 | ||
793 | This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find | |
794 | the range's boundaries. Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector | |
795 | in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale. */ | |
796 | ||
797 | static bp_locations_at_addr_range | |
798 | all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr) | |
799 | { | |
800 | return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr); | |
801 | } | |
802 | ||
803 | /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and | |
804 | ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid | |
805 | result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly | |
806 | limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for | |
807 | an address you need to read. */ | |
808 | ||
809 | static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max; | |
810 | ||
811 | /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS | |
812 | + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of | |
813 | BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow. | |
814 | You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to | |
815 | scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */ | |
816 | ||
817 | static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max; | |
818 | ||
819 | /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked | |
820 | from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be | |
821 | reported by a target. */ | |
822 | static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations; | |
823 | ||
824 | /* Number of last breakpoint made. */ | |
825 | ||
826 | static int breakpoint_count; | |
827 | ||
828 | /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that | |
829 | created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more | |
830 | than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT | |
831 | and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */ | |
832 | static int prev_breakpoint_count; | |
833 | ||
834 | /* Number of last tracepoint made. */ | |
835 | ||
836 | static int tracepoint_count; | |
837 | ||
838 | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist; | |
839 | static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist; | |
840 | struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist; | |
841 | ||
842 | /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */ | |
843 | static bool | |
844 | breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b) | |
845 | { | |
846 | return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled); | |
847 | } | |
848 | ||
849 | /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */ | |
850 | ||
851 | static void | |
852 | set_breakpoint_count (int num) | |
853 | { | |
854 | prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | |
855 | breakpoint_count = num; | |
856 | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num); | |
857 | } | |
858 | ||
859 | /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current | |
860 | breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */ | |
861 | static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | |
862 | ||
863 | /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first | |
864 | breakpoint made. */ | |
865 | ||
866 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () | |
867 | { | |
868 | rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count; | |
869 | } | |
870 | ||
871 | /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last | |
872 | breakpoint made. */ | |
873 | ||
874 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints () | |
875 | { | |
876 | prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count; | |
877 | } | |
878 | ||
879 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
880 | ||
881 | int | |
882 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::first_breakpoint () const | |
883 | { | |
884 | return rbreak_start_breakpoint_count + 1; | |
885 | } | |
886 | ||
887 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
888 | ||
889 | int | |
890 | scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::last_breakpoint () const | |
891 | { | |
892 | return (rbreak_start_breakpoint_count == breakpoint_count | |
893 | ? -1 | |
894 | : breakpoint_count); | |
895 | } | |
896 | ||
897 | /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */ | |
898 | ||
899 | void | |
900 | clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void) | |
901 | { | |
902 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
903 | b.hit_count = 0; | |
904 | } | |
905 | ||
906 | \f | |
907 | /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL | |
908 | if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */ | |
909 | ||
910 | struct breakpoint * | |
911 | get_breakpoint (int num) | |
912 | { | |
913 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
914 | if (b.number == num) | |
915 | return &b; | |
916 | ||
917 | return nullptr; | |
918 | } | |
919 | ||
920 | /* Return TRUE if NUM refer to an existing breakpoint that has | |
921 | multiple code locations. */ | |
922 | ||
923 | static bool | |
924 | has_multiple_locations (int num) | |
925 | { | |
926 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
927 | if (b.number == num) | |
928 | return b.has_multiple_locations (); | |
929 | ||
930 | return false; | |
931 | } | |
932 | ||
933 | \f | |
934 | ||
935 | /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | |
936 | evaluating conditions on its side. */ | |
937 | ||
938 | static void | |
939 | mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b) | |
940 | { | |
941 | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | |
942 | evaluating conditions and if the user has | |
943 | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | |
944 | side. */ | |
945 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
946 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
947 | return; | |
948 | ||
949 | if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | |
950 | return; | |
951 | ||
952 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
953 | loc.condition_changed = condition_modified; | |
954 | } | |
955 | ||
956 | /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports | |
957 | evaluating conditions on its side. */ | |
958 | ||
959 | static void | |
960 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc) | |
961 | { | |
962 | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | |
963 | evaluating conditions and if the user has | |
964 | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | |
965 | side. */ | |
966 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
967 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
968 | ||
969 | return; | |
970 | ||
971 | if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)) | |
972 | return; | |
973 | ||
974 | loc->condition_changed = condition_modified; | |
975 | } | |
976 | ||
977 | /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global | |
978 | condition_evaluation_mode. */ | |
979 | ||
980 | static void | |
981 | set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty, | |
982 | struct cmd_list_element *c) | |
983 | { | |
984 | const char *old_mode, *new_mode; | |
985 | ||
986 | if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target) | |
987 | && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
988 | { | |
989 | condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode; | |
990 | warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n" | |
991 | "Using host evaluation mode instead.")); | |
992 | return; | |
993 | } | |
994 | ||
995 | new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1); | |
996 | old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode); | |
997 | ||
998 | /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the | |
999 | settings was "auto". */ | |
1000 | condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1; | |
1001 | ||
1002 | /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */ | |
1003 | if (new_mode != old_mode) | |
1004 | { | |
1005 | /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we | |
1006 | need to synch the changes with the target as follows: | |
1007 | ||
1008 | "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target. | |
1009 | "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target. | |
1010 | */ | |
1011 | ||
1012 | if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target) | |
1013 | { | |
1014 | /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the | |
1015 | target. */ | |
1016 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
1017 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | |
1018 | } | |
1019 | else | |
1020 | { | |
1021 | /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions | |
1022 | with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the | |
1023 | target knows about. */ | |
1024 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
1025 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted) | |
1026 | loc->needs_update = 1; | |
1027 | } | |
1028 | ||
1029 | /* Do the update. */ | |
1030 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
1031 | } | |
1032 | ||
1033 | return; | |
1034 | } | |
1035 | ||
1036 | /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows | |
1037 | what "auto" is translating to. */ | |
1038 | ||
1039 | static void | |
1040 | show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty, | |
1041 | struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value) | |
1042 | { | |
1043 | if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto) | |
1044 | gdb_printf (file, | |
1045 | _("Breakpoint condition evaluation " | |
1046 | "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"), | |
1047 | value, | |
1048 | breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()); | |
1049 | else | |
1050 | gdb_printf (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"), | |
1051 | value); | |
1052 | } | |
1053 | ||
1054 | /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition | |
1055 | expression of LOC. BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is | |
1056 | the number of LOC within its owner. In case of parsing error, mark | |
1057 | LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND. In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND. */ | |
1058 | ||
1059 | static void | |
1060 | set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc, | |
1061 | int bp_num, int loc_num) | |
1062 | { | |
1063 | bool has_junk = false; | |
1064 | try | |
1065 | { | |
1066 | expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address, | |
1067 | block_for_pc (loc->address), 0); | |
1068 | if (*cond_string != 0) | |
1069 | has_junk = true; | |
1070 | else | |
1071 | { | |
1072 | loc->cond = std::move (new_exp); | |
1073 | if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled) | |
1074 | gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " | |
1075 | "location %d, enabling.\n"), | |
1076 | bp_num, loc_num); | |
1077 | ||
1078 | loc->disabled_by_cond = false; | |
1079 | } | |
1080 | } | |
1081 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
1082 | { | |
1083 | if (loc->enabled) | |
1084 | { | |
1085 | /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond. | |
1086 | BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first | |
1087 | time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if | |
1088 | already defined. */ | |
1089 | if (bp_num != 0) | |
1090 | warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, " | |
1091 | "disabling:\n %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ()); | |
1092 | else | |
1093 | warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, " | |
1094 | "disabling:\n %s"), loc_num, e.what ()); | |
1095 | } | |
1096 | ||
1097 | loc->disabled_by_cond = true; | |
1098 | } | |
1099 | ||
1100 | if (has_junk) | |
1101 | error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string); | |
1102 | } | |
1103 | ||
1104 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1105 | ||
1106 | void | |
1107 | notify_breakpoint_modified (breakpoint *b) | |
1108 | { | |
1109 | interps_notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1110 | gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b); | |
1111 | } | |
1112 | ||
1113 | void | |
1114 | set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp, | |
1115 | int from_tty, bool force) | |
1116 | { | |
1117 | if (*exp == 0) | |
1118 | { | |
1119 | b->cond_string.reset (); | |
1120 | ||
1121 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
1122 | gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset (); | |
1123 | else | |
1124 | { | |
1125 | int loc_num = 1; | |
1126 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
1127 | { | |
1128 | loc.cond.reset (); | |
1129 | if (loc.disabled_by_cond && loc.enabled) | |
1130 | gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at " | |
1131 | "location %d, enabling.\n"), | |
1132 | b->number, loc_num); | |
1133 | loc.disabled_by_cond = false; | |
1134 | loc_num++; | |
1135 | ||
1136 | /* No need to free the condition agent expression | |
1137 | bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this | |
1138 | when we go through update_global_location_list. */ | |
1139 | } | |
1140 | } | |
1141 | ||
1142 | if (from_tty) | |
1143 | gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number); | |
1144 | } | |
1145 | else | |
1146 | { | |
1147 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
1148 | { | |
1149 | innermost_block_tracker tracker; | |
1150 | const char *arg = exp; | |
1151 | expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); | |
1152 | if (*arg != 0) | |
1153 | error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | |
1154 | watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | |
1155 | w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp); | |
1156 | w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); | |
1157 | } | |
1158 | else | |
1159 | { | |
1160 | /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes. | |
1161 | In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it | |
1162 | is valid in at least one location. If so, the condition | |
1163 | would be accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations' | |
1164 | conditions. In case no valid case is found, we throw | |
1165 | the error and the condition string will be rejected. | |
1166 | This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the | |
1167 | state of locations in case of a reject. */ | |
1168 | for (const bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
1169 | { | |
1170 | try | |
1171 | { | |
1172 | const char *arg = exp; | |
1173 | parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc.address, | |
1174 | block_for_pc (loc.address), 0); | |
1175 | if (*arg != 0) | |
1176 | error (_("Junk at end of expression")); | |
1177 | break; | |
1178 | } | |
1179 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
1180 | { | |
1181 | /* Condition string is invalid. If this happens to | |
1182 | be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue | |
1183 | (if forced). */ | |
1184 | if (&loc == &b->last_loc () && !force) | |
1185 | throw; | |
1186 | } | |
1187 | } | |
1188 | ||
1189 | /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations. */ | |
1190 | int loc_num = 1; | |
1191 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
1192 | { | |
1193 | set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, &loc, b->number, loc_num); | |
1194 | loc_num++; | |
1195 | } | |
1196 | } | |
1197 | ||
1198 | /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The | |
1199 | condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */ | |
1200 | b->cond_string = make_unique_xstrdup (exp); | |
1201 | b->condition_not_parsed = 0; | |
1202 | } | |
1203 | mark_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1204 | ||
1205 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1206 | } | |
1207 | ||
1208 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1209 | ||
1210 | void | |
1211 | set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty, | |
1212 | bool force) | |
1213 | { | |
1214 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
1215 | if (b.number == bpnum) | |
1216 | { | |
1217 | /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an | |
1218 | extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB | |
1219 | from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */ | |
1220 | const struct extension_language_defn *extlang | |
1221 | = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (&b, EXT_LANG_NONE); | |
1222 | ||
1223 | if (extlang != NULL) | |
1224 | { | |
1225 | error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently" | |
1226 | " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."), | |
1227 | ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang)); | |
1228 | } | |
1229 | set_breakpoint_condition (&b, exp, from_tty, force); | |
1230 | ||
1231 | if (is_breakpoint (&b)) | |
1232 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
1233 | ||
1234 | return; | |
1235 | } | |
1236 | ||
1237 | error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum); | |
1238 | } | |
1239 | ||
1240 | /* The options for the "condition" command. */ | |
1241 | ||
1242 | struct condition_command_opts | |
1243 | { | |
1244 | /* For "-force". */ | |
1245 | bool force_condition = false; | |
1246 | }; | |
1247 | ||
1248 | static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = { | |
1249 | ||
1250 | gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> { | |
1251 | "force", | |
1252 | [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; }, | |
1253 | N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."), | |
1254 | }, | |
1255 | ||
1256 | }; | |
1257 | ||
1258 | /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with | |
1259 | CC_OPTS as context. */ | |
1260 | ||
1261 | static inline gdb::option::option_def_group | |
1262 | make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts) | |
1263 | { | |
1264 | return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts}; | |
1265 | } | |
1266 | ||
1267 | /* Completion for the "condition" command. */ | |
1268 | ||
1269 | static void | |
1270 | condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, | |
1271 | completion_tracker &tracker, | |
1272 | const char *text, const char * /*word*/) | |
1273 | { | |
1274 | bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0'); | |
1275 | condition_command_opts cc_opts; | |
1276 | const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); | |
1277 | if (gdb::option::complete_options | |
1278 | (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group)) | |
1279 | return; | |
1280 | ||
1281 | text = skip_spaces (text); | |
1282 | const char *space = skip_to_space (text); | |
1283 | if (*space == '\0') | |
1284 | { | |
1285 | int len; | |
1286 | ||
1287 | if (text[0] == '$') | |
1288 | { | |
1289 | tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1); | |
1290 | /* We don't support completion of history indices. */ | |
1291 | if (!isdigit (text[1])) | |
1292 | complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]); | |
1293 | return; | |
1294 | } | |
1295 | ||
1296 | /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given. If | |
1297 | arguments were passed, they either already include the flag, | |
1298 | or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's | |
1299 | positionally the first argument. */ | |
1300 | if (has_no_arguments) | |
1301 | gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group); | |
1302 | ||
1303 | /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */ | |
1304 | len = strlen (text); | |
1305 | ||
1306 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
1307 | { | |
1308 | char number[50]; | |
1309 | ||
1310 | xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b.number); | |
1311 | ||
1312 | if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0) | |
1313 | tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number)); | |
1314 | } | |
1315 | ||
1316 | return; | |
1317 | } | |
1318 | ||
1319 | /* We're completing the expression part. Skip the breakpoint num. */ | |
1320 | const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space); | |
1321 | tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text); | |
1322 | text = exp_start; | |
1323 | const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); | |
1324 | expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word); | |
1325 | } | |
1326 | ||
1327 | /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */ | |
1328 | ||
1329 | static void | |
1330 | condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
1331 | { | |
1332 | const char *p; | |
1333 | int bnum; | |
1334 | ||
1335 | if (arg == 0) | |
1336 | error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number")); | |
1337 | ||
1338 | p = arg; | |
1339 | ||
1340 | /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed. */ | |
1341 | condition_command_opts cc_opts; | |
1342 | const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts); | |
1343 | gdb::option::process_options | |
1344 | (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group); | |
1345 | ||
1346 | bnum = get_number (&p); | |
1347 | if (bnum == 0) | |
1348 | error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg); | |
1349 | ||
1350 | set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition); | |
1351 | } | |
1352 | ||
1353 | /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable | |
1354 | only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints. | |
1355 | Throw if any such commands is found. */ | |
1356 | ||
1357 | static void | |
1358 | check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands) | |
1359 | { | |
1360 | struct command_line *c; | |
1361 | ||
1362 | for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | |
1363 | { | |
1364 | if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | |
1365 | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can " | |
1366 | "only be used for tracepoints")); | |
1367 | ||
1368 | check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ()); | |
1369 | check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ()); | |
1370 | ||
1371 | /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment | |
1372 | lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for | |
1373 | command directly. */ | |
1374 | if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line) | |
1375 | error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | |
1376 | ||
1377 | if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line) | |
1378 | error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints")); | |
1379 | } | |
1380 | } | |
1381 | ||
1382 | struct longjmp_breakpoint : public momentary_breakpoint | |
1383 | { | |
1384 | using momentary_breakpoint::momentary_breakpoint; | |
1385 | ||
1386 | ~longjmp_breakpoint () override; | |
1387 | }; | |
1388 | ||
1389 | /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */ | |
1390 | ||
1391 | static bool | |
1392 | is_tracepoint_type (bptype type) | |
1393 | { | |
1394 | return (type == bp_tracepoint | |
1395 | || type == bp_fast_tracepoint | |
1396 | || type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
1397 | || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); | |
1398 | } | |
1399 | ||
1400 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1401 | ||
1402 | bool | |
1403 | is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | |
1404 | { | |
1405 | return is_tracepoint_type (b->type); | |
1406 | } | |
1407 | ||
1408 | /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given | |
1409 | TYPE. */ | |
1410 | ||
1411 | template<typename... Arg> | |
1412 | static std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> | |
1413 | new_breakpoint_from_type (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bptype type, | |
1414 | Arg&&... args) | |
1415 | { | |
1416 | code_breakpoint *b; | |
1417 | ||
1418 | switch (type) | |
1419 | { | |
1420 | case bp_breakpoint: | |
1421 | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | |
1422 | b = new ordinary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | |
1423 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
1424 | break; | |
1425 | ||
1426 | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | |
1427 | case bp_static_tracepoint: | |
1428 | case bp_tracepoint: | |
1429 | b = new tracepoint (gdbarch, type, | |
1430 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
1431 | break; | |
1432 | ||
1433 | case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | |
1434 | b = new static_marker_tracepoint (gdbarch, type, | |
1435 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
1436 | break; | |
1437 | ||
1438 | case bp_dprintf: | |
1439 | b = new dprintf_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | |
1440 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
1441 | break; | |
1442 | ||
1443 | default: | |
1444 | gdb_assert_not_reached ("invalid type"); | |
1445 | } | |
1446 | ||
1447 | return std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> (b); | |
1448 | } | |
1449 | ||
1450 | /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a | |
1451 | breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is | |
1452 | found. */ | |
1453 | ||
1454 | static void | |
1455 | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, | |
1456 | struct command_line *commands) | |
1457 | { | |
1458 | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
1459 | { | |
1460 | tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | |
1461 | struct command_line *c; | |
1462 | struct command_line *while_stepping = 0; | |
1463 | ||
1464 | /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands | |
1465 | might have included a while-stepping action, while the new | |
1466 | ones might not. */ | |
1467 | t->step_count = 0; | |
1468 | ||
1469 | /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is | |
1470 | valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one | |
1471 | while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body | |
1472 | has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping. | |
1473 | We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the | |
1474 | context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually | |
1475 | has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's | |
1476 | while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the | |
1477 | collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the | |
1478 | tracepoint's context. */ | |
1479 | for (c = commands; c; c = c->next) | |
1480 | { | |
1481 | if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control) | |
1482 | { | |
1483 | if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | |
1484 | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | |
1485 | "cannot be used for fast tracepoint")); | |
1486 | else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
1487 | || b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | |
1488 | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | |
1489 | "cannot be used for static tracepoint")); | |
1490 | ||
1491 | if (while_stepping) | |
1492 | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command " | |
1493 | "can be used only once")); | |
1494 | else | |
1495 | while_stepping = c; | |
1496 | } | |
1497 | ||
1498 | validate_actionline (c->line, t); | |
1499 | } | |
1500 | if (while_stepping) | |
1501 | { | |
1502 | struct command_line *c2; | |
1503 | ||
1504 | gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr); | |
1505 | c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get (); | |
1506 | for (; c2; c2 = c2->next) | |
1507 | { | |
1508 | if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control) | |
1509 | error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested")); | |
1510 | } | |
1511 | } | |
1512 | } | |
1513 | else | |
1514 | { | |
1515 | check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands); | |
1516 | } | |
1517 | } | |
1518 | ||
1519 | /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The | |
1520 | caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */ | |
1521 | ||
1522 | std::vector<breakpoint *> | |
1523 | static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr) | |
1524 | { | |
1525 | std::vector<breakpoint *> found; | |
1526 | ||
1527 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
1528 | if (b.type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
1529 | || b.type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | |
1530 | { | |
1531 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
1532 | if (loc.address == addr) | |
1533 | found.push_back (&b); | |
1534 | } | |
1535 | ||
1536 | return found; | |
1537 | } | |
1538 | ||
1539 | /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint, | |
1540 | validate that only allowed commands are included. */ | |
1541 | ||
1542 | void | |
1543 | breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b, | |
1544 | counted_command_line &&commands) | |
1545 | { | |
1546 | /* If the commands have not changed then there's no need to update | |
1547 | anything, and no need to emit a breakpoint modified event. */ | |
1548 | if (commands_equal (b->commands.get (), commands.get ())) | |
1549 | return; | |
1550 | ||
1551 | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ()); | |
1552 | ||
1553 | b->commands = std::move (commands); | |
1554 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1555 | } | |
1556 | ||
1557 | /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this | |
1558 | is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's | |
1559 | commands. */ | |
1560 | ||
1561 | void | |
1562 | breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent) | |
1563 | { | |
1564 | int old_silent = b->silent; | |
1565 | ||
1566 | b->silent = silent; | |
1567 | if (old_silent != silent) | |
1568 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1569 | } | |
1570 | ||
1571 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1572 | ||
1573 | void | |
1574 | breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread) | |
1575 | { | |
1576 | /* THREAD should be -1, meaning no thread restriction, or it should be a | |
1577 | valid global thread-id, which are greater than zero. */ | |
1578 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | |
1579 | ||
1580 | /* It is not valid to set a thread restriction for a breakpoint that | |
1581 | already has task or inferior restriction. */ | |
1582 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || (b->task == -1 && b->inferior == -1)); | |
1583 | ||
1584 | int old_thread = b->thread; | |
1585 | b->thread = thread; | |
1586 | if (old_thread != thread) | |
1587 | { | |
1588 | /* If THREAD is in a different program_space than OLD_THREAD, or the | |
1589 | breakpoint has switched to or from being thread-specific, then we | |
1590 | need to re-set the locations of this breakpoint. First, figure | |
1591 | out the program_space for the old and new threads, use a value of | |
1592 | nullptr to indicate the breakpoint is in all program spaces. */ | |
1593 | program_space *old_pspace = nullptr; | |
1594 | if (old_thread != -1) | |
1595 | { | |
1596 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (old_thread); | |
1597 | gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | |
1598 | old_pspace = thr->inf->pspace; | |
1599 | } | |
1600 | ||
1601 | program_space *new_pspace = nullptr; | |
1602 | if (thread != -1) | |
1603 | { | |
1604 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | |
1605 | gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | |
1606 | new_pspace = thr->inf->pspace; | |
1607 | } | |
1608 | ||
1609 | /* If the program space has changed for this breakpoint, then | |
1610 | re-evaluate it's locations. */ | |
1611 | if (old_pspace != new_pspace) | |
1612 | { | |
1613 | /* The breakpoint is now associated with a completely different | |
1614 | program space. Discard all of the current locations and then | |
1615 | re-set the breakpoint in the new program space, this will | |
1616 | create the new locations. */ | |
1617 | b->clear_locations (); | |
1618 | breakpoint_re_set_one (b, new_pspace); | |
1619 | } | |
1620 | ||
1621 | /* If the program space didn't change, or the breakpoint didn't | |
1622 | acquire any new locations after the clear_locations call, then we | |
1623 | need to notify of the breakpoint modification now. */ | |
1624 | if (old_pspace == new_pspace || !b->has_locations ()) | |
1625 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1626 | } | |
1627 | } | |
1628 | ||
1629 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1630 | ||
1631 | void | |
1632 | breakpoint_set_inferior (struct breakpoint *b, int inferior) | |
1633 | { | |
1634 | /* INFERIOR should be -1, meaning no inferior restriction, or it should | |
1635 | be a valid inferior number, which are greater than zero. */ | |
1636 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | |
1637 | ||
1638 | /* It is not valid to set an inferior restriction for a breakpoint that | |
1639 | already has a task or thread restriction. */ | |
1640 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || (b->task == -1 && b->thread == -1)); | |
1641 | ||
1642 | int old_inferior = b->inferior; | |
1643 | b->inferior = inferior; | |
1644 | if (old_inferior != inferior) | |
1645 | { | |
1646 | /* If INFERIOR is in a different program_space than OLD_INFERIOR, or | |
1647 | the breakpoint has switch to or from inferior-specific, then we | |
1648 | need to re-set the locations of this breakpoint. First, figure | |
1649 | out the program_space for the old and new inferiors, use a value | |
1650 | of nullptr to indicate the breakpoint is in all program | |
1651 | spaces. */ | |
1652 | program_space *old_pspace = nullptr; | |
1653 | if (old_inferior != -1) | |
1654 | { | |
1655 | struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (old_inferior); | |
1656 | gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | |
1657 | old_pspace = inf->pspace; | |
1658 | } | |
1659 | ||
1660 | program_space *new_pspace = nullptr; | |
1661 | if (inferior != -1) | |
1662 | { | |
1663 | struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (inferior); | |
1664 | gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | |
1665 | new_pspace = inf->pspace; | |
1666 | } | |
1667 | ||
1668 | if (old_pspace != new_pspace) | |
1669 | { | |
1670 | /* The breakpoint is now associated with a completely different | |
1671 | program space. Discard all of the current locations and then | |
1672 | re-set the breakpoint in the new program space, this will | |
1673 | create the new locations. */ | |
1674 | b->clear_locations (); | |
1675 | breakpoint_re_set_one (b, new_pspace); | |
1676 | } | |
1677 | ||
1678 | /* If the program space didn't change, or the breakpoint didn't | |
1679 | acquire any new locations after the clear_locations call, then we | |
1680 | need to notify of the breakpoint modification now. */ | |
1681 | if (old_pspace == new_pspace || !b->has_locations ()) | |
1682 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1683 | } | |
1684 | } | |
1685 | ||
1686 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
1687 | ||
1688 | void | |
1689 | breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task) | |
1690 | { | |
1691 | /* TASK should be -1, meaning no task restriction, or it should be a | |
1692 | valid task-id, which are greater than zero. */ | |
1693 | gdb_assert (task == -1 || task > 0); | |
1694 | ||
1695 | /* It is not valid to set a task restriction for a breakpoint that | |
1696 | already has a thread or inferior restriction. */ | |
1697 | gdb_assert (task == -1 || (b->thread == -1 && b->inferior == -1)); | |
1698 | ||
1699 | int old_task = b->task; | |
1700 | b->task = task; | |
1701 | if (old_task != task) | |
1702 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1703 | } | |
1704 | ||
1705 | static void | |
1706 | commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty, | |
1707 | struct command_line *control) | |
1708 | { | |
1709 | counted_command_line cmd; | |
1710 | /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be | |
1711 | NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty | |
1712 | list of command by just typing "end". */ | |
1713 | bool cmd_read = false; | |
1714 | ||
1715 | std::string new_arg; | |
1716 | ||
1717 | if (arg == NULL || !*arg) | |
1718 | { | |
1719 | /* Argument not explicitly given. Synthesize it. */ | |
1720 | if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1) | |
1721 | new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1, | |
1722 | breakpoint_count); | |
1723 | else if (breakpoint_count > 0) | |
1724 | new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count); | |
1725 | } | |
1726 | else | |
1727 | { | |
1728 | /* Create a copy of ARG. This is needed because the "commands" | |
1729 | command may be coming from a script. In that case, the read | |
1730 | line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of | |
1731 | 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line | |
1732 | before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers. */ | |
1733 | new_arg = arg; | |
1734 | } | |
1735 | arg = new_arg.c_str (); | |
1736 | ||
1737 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
1738 | (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b) | |
1739 | { | |
1740 | if (!cmd_read) | |
1741 | { | |
1742 | gdb_assert (cmd == NULL); | |
1743 | if (control != NULL) | |
1744 | cmd = control->body_list_0; | |
1745 | else | |
1746 | { | |
1747 | std::string str | |
1748 | = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) " | |
1749 | "%s, one per line."), | |
1750 | arg); | |
1751 | ||
1752 | auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line) | |
1753 | { | |
1754 | tracepoint *t | |
1755 | = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | |
1756 | validate_actionline (line, t); | |
1757 | }; | |
1758 | gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator; | |
1759 | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
1760 | validator = do_validate; | |
1761 | ||
1762 | cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator); | |
1763 | } | |
1764 | cmd_read = true; | |
1765 | } | |
1766 | ||
1767 | /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to | |
1768 | do anything. */ | |
1769 | if (b->commands != cmd) | |
1770 | { | |
1771 | validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ()); | |
1772 | b->commands = cmd; | |
1773 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
1774 | } | |
1775 | }); | |
1776 | } | |
1777 | ||
1778 | static void | |
1779 | commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
1780 | { | |
1781 | commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL); | |
1782 | } | |
1783 | ||
1784 | /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from | |
1785 | input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure. | |
1786 | ||
1787 | This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands | |
1788 | that are part of if and while bodies. */ | |
1789 | enum command_control_type | |
1790 | commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd) | |
1791 | { | |
1792 | commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd); | |
1793 | return simple_control; | |
1794 | } | |
1795 | ||
1796 | /* Return true if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */ | |
1797 | ||
1798 | static bool | |
1799 | bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl) | |
1800 | { | |
1801 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | |
1802 | return false; | |
1803 | if (!bl->inserted) | |
1804 | return false; | |
1805 | if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0) | |
1806 | /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */ | |
1807 | return false; | |
1808 | return true; | |
1809 | } | |
1810 | ||
1811 | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address | |
1812 | MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed | |
1813 | contents. | |
1814 | ||
1815 | If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of | |
1816 | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a | |
1817 | failed assertion internal error will be raised. */ | |
1818 | ||
1819 | static void | |
1820 | one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | |
1821 | const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | |
1822 | ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len, | |
1823 | struct bp_target_info *target_info, | |
1824 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | |
1825 | { | |
1826 | /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */ | |
1827 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0; | |
1828 | int bp_size = 0; | |
1829 | int bptoffset = 0; | |
1830 | ||
1831 | if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0, | |
1832 | current_program_space->aspace.get (), 0)) | |
1833 | { | |
1834 | /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */ | |
1835 | return; | |
1836 | } | |
1837 | ||
1838 | /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that | |
1839 | we need to copy. */ | |
1840 | bp_addr = target_info->placed_address; | |
1841 | bp_size = target_info->shadow_len; | |
1842 | ||
1843 | if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr) | |
1844 | { | |
1845 | /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are | |
1846 | reading. */ | |
1847 | return; | |
1848 | } | |
1849 | ||
1850 | if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len) | |
1851 | { | |
1852 | /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are | |
1853 | reading. */ | |
1854 | return; | |
1855 | } | |
1856 | ||
1857 | /* Offset within shadow_contents. */ | |
1858 | if (bp_addr < memaddr) | |
1859 | { | |
1860 | /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */ | |
1861 | bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr; | |
1862 | bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr; | |
1863 | bp_addr = memaddr; | |
1864 | } | |
1865 | ||
1866 | if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len) | |
1867 | { | |
1868 | /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */ | |
1869 | bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len); | |
1870 | } | |
1871 | ||
1872 | if (readbuf != NULL) | |
1873 | { | |
1874 | /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the | |
1875 | shadow_contents buffer. */ | |
1876 | gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len | |
1877 | || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents | |
1878 | + target_info->shadow_len)); | |
1879 | ||
1880 | /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's | |
1881 | shadow. */ | |
1882 | memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr, | |
1883 | target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size); | |
1884 | } | |
1885 | else | |
1886 | { | |
1887 | const unsigned char *bp; | |
1888 | CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address; | |
1889 | int placed_size; | |
1890 | ||
1891 | /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */ | |
1892 | memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, | |
1893 | writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size); | |
1894 | ||
1895 | /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this | |
1896 | address. */ | |
1897 | bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size); | |
1898 | ||
1899 | /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted | |
1900 | breakpoint's INSN. */ | |
1901 | memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size); | |
1902 | } | |
1903 | } | |
1904 | ||
1905 | /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR, | |
1906 | by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents. | |
1907 | ||
1908 | If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of | |
1909 | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise, | |
1910 | a failed assertion internal error will be raised. | |
1911 | ||
1912 | The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is: | |
1913 | bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max | |
1914 | up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | |
1915 | The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is: | |
1916 | memaddr ... memaddr + len | |
1917 | Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are | |
1918 | memaddr + len <= (bl->address | |
1919 | - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) | |
1920 | and: | |
1921 | bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */ | |
1922 | ||
1923 | void | |
1924 | breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf, | |
1925 | const gdb_byte *writebuf_org, | |
1926 | ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len) | |
1927 | { | |
1928 | /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary | |
1929 | search. */ | |
1930 | unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc; | |
1931 | ||
1932 | /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF | |
1933 | content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to | |
1934 | report higher one. */ | |
1935 | ||
1936 | bc_l = 0; | |
1937 | bc_r = bp_locations.size (); | |
1938 | while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r) | |
1939 | { | |
1940 | struct bp_location *bl; | |
1941 | ||
1942 | bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2; | |
1943 | bl = bp_locations[bc]; | |
1944 | ||
1945 | /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added | |
1946 | constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure | |
1947 | the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR | |
1948 | to MEMADDR + LEN range). | |
1949 | ||
1950 | Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety | |
1951 | offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow | |
1952 | range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */ | |
1953 | ||
1954 | if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | |
1955 | >= bl->address) | |
1956 | && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max | |
1957 | <= memaddr)) | |
1958 | bc_l = bc; | |
1959 | else | |
1960 | bc_r = bc; | |
1961 | } | |
1962 | ||
1963 | /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the | |
1964 | first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are | |
1965 | multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing | |
1966 | at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted" | |
1967 | location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and | |
1968 | B: | |
1969 | ||
1970 | L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ... | |
1971 | ||
1972 | BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master" | |
1973 | location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set | |
1974 | on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1 | |
1975 | and L2. */ | |
1976 | while (bc_l > 0 | |
1977 | && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address) | |
1978 | bc_l--; | |
1979 | ||
1980 | /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */ | |
1981 | ||
1982 | for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++) | |
1983 | { | |
1984 | struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc]; | |
1985 | ||
1986 | /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ | |
1987 | if (bl->owner->type == bp_none) | |
1988 | warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"), | |
1989 | bl->owner->number); | |
1990 | ||
1991 | /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF | |
1992 | content. */ | |
1993 | ||
1994 | if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max | |
1995 | && (memaddr + len | |
1996 | <= (bl->address | |
1997 | - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max))) | |
1998 | break; | |
1999 | ||
2000 | if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | |
2001 | continue; | |
2002 | ||
2003 | one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org, | |
2004 | memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch); | |
2005 | } | |
2006 | } | |
2007 | ||
2008 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
2009 | ||
2010 | bool | |
2011 | is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
2012 | { | |
2013 | return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint | |
2014 | || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | |
2015 | || bpt->type == bp_dprintf); | |
2016 | } | |
2017 | ||
2018 | /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */ | |
2019 | ||
2020 | static bool | |
2021 | is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
2022 | { | |
2023 | return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | |
2024 | || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint | |
2025 | || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint); | |
2026 | } | |
2027 | ||
2028 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
2029 | ||
2030 | bool | |
2031 | is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
2032 | { | |
2033 | return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt) | |
2034 | || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint); | |
2035 | } | |
2036 | ||
2037 | /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe | |
2038 | to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local | |
2039 | expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that | |
2040 | was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs | |
2041 | to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context. | |
2042 | Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread, | |
2043 | and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing | |
2044 | memory accesses when threads are running. */ | |
2045 | ||
2046 | static bool | |
2047 | watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b) | |
2048 | { | |
2049 | return (b->pspace == current_program_space | |
2050 | && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid | |
2051 | || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread | |
2052 | && !inferior_thread ()->executing ()))); | |
2053 | } | |
2054 | ||
2055 | /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible | |
2056 | associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */ | |
2057 | ||
2058 | static void | |
2059 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w) | |
2060 | { | |
2061 | if (w->related_breakpoint != w) | |
2062 | { | |
2063 | gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope); | |
2064 | gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w); | |
2065 | w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | |
2066 | w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint; | |
2067 | w->related_breakpoint = w; | |
2068 | } | |
2069 | w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | |
2070 | disable_breakpoint (w); | |
2071 | } | |
2072 | ||
2073 | /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in | |
2074 | watchpoint W. */ | |
2075 | ||
2076 | static struct value * | |
2077 | extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val) | |
2078 | { | |
2079 | struct value *bit_val; | |
2080 | ||
2081 | if (val == NULL) | |
2082 | return NULL; | |
2083 | ||
2084 | bit_val = value::allocate (val->type ()); | |
2085 | ||
2086 | val->unpack_bitfield (bit_val, | |
2087 | w->val_bitpos, | |
2088 | w->val_bitsize, | |
2089 | val->contents_for_printing ().data (), | |
2090 | val->offset ()); | |
2091 | ||
2092 | return bit_val; | |
2093 | } | |
2094 | ||
2095 | /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B. This is required | |
2096 | because bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report | |
2097 | stops. */ | |
2098 | ||
2099 | static void | |
2100 | add_dummy_location (struct breakpoint *b, | |
2101 | struct program_space *pspace) | |
2102 | { | |
2103 | gdb_assert (!b->has_locations ()); | |
2104 | ||
2105 | bp_location *loc = new bp_location (b, bp_loc_other); | |
2106 | loc->pspace = pspace; | |
2107 | b->add_location (*loc); | |
2108 | } | |
2109 | ||
2110 | /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint: | |
2111 | - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is true | |
2112 | - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val | |
2113 | - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result | |
2114 | in b->loc->cond. | |
2115 | - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc. | |
2116 | ||
2117 | If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do | |
2118 | nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete | |
2119 | it. | |
2120 | ||
2121 | Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are | |
2122 | removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must | |
2123 | never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread | |
2124 | when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware | |
2125 | watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific | |
2126 | to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug | |
2127 | registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to | |
2128 | be able to modify its hardware watchpoints. | |
2129 | ||
2130 | Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being | |
2131 | presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would | |
2132 | reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And | |
2133 | it must not be done later because it could display the same single | |
2134 | watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is | |
2135 | relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint | |
2136 | and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is | |
2137 | not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has | |
2138 | not changed. | |
2139 | ||
2140 | The following constraints influence the location where we can reset | |
2141 | hardware watchpoints: | |
2142 | ||
2143 | * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are | |
2144 | called several times when GDB stops. | |
2145 | ||
2146 | [linux] | |
2147 | * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time, | |
2148 | causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint | |
2149 | hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits | |
2150 | are presented later, one after the other, each time the user | |
2151 | requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed | |
2152 | for the threads still having pending hit event stored in | |
2153 | LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from | |
2154 | the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being | |
2155 | reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address | |
2156 | until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets | |
2157 | presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset. | |
2158 | ||
2159 | Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the | |
2160 | watchpoint removal from inferior. */ | |
2161 | ||
2162 | static void | |
2163 | update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, bool reparse) | |
2164 | { | |
2165 | bool within_current_scope; | |
2166 | ||
2167 | /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | |
2168 | watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | |
2169 | that was used to create the watchpoint. */ | |
2170 | if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | |
2171 | return; | |
2172 | ||
2173 | if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
2174 | return; | |
2175 | ||
2176 | std::optional<scoped_restore_selected_frame> restore_frame; | |
2177 | ||
2178 | /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */ | |
2179 | if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | |
2180 | within_current_scope = true; | |
2181 | else | |
2182 | { | |
2183 | frame_info_ptr fi = get_current_frame (); | |
2184 | struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi); | |
2185 | CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi); | |
2186 | ||
2187 | /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed | |
2188 | (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work | |
2189 | properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this | |
2190 | point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */ | |
2191 | if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | |
2192 | return; | |
2193 | ||
2194 | /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after | |
2195 | evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */ | |
2196 | /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression | |
2197 | took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the | |
2198 | selected frame. */ | |
2199 | restore_frame.emplace (); | |
2200 | ||
2201 | fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | |
2202 | within_current_scope = (fi != NULL); | |
2203 | if (within_current_scope) | |
2204 | select_frame (fi); | |
2205 | } | |
2206 | ||
2207 | /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array | |
2208 | and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and | |
2209 | remove breakpoints if needed. */ | |
2210 | b->clear_locations (); | |
2211 | ||
2212 | if (within_current_scope && reparse) | |
2213 | { | |
2214 | const char *s; | |
2215 | ||
2216 | b->exp.reset (); | |
2217 | s = (b->exp_string_reparse | |
2218 | ? b->exp_string_reparse.get () | |
2219 | : b->exp_string.get ()); | |
2220 | b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0); | |
2221 | /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is | |
2222 | no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit | |
2223 | to the user when the old value and the new value may actually | |
2224 | be completely different objects. */ | |
2225 | b->val = NULL; | |
2226 | b->val_valid = false; | |
2227 | ||
2228 | /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition | |
2229 | expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the | |
2230 | locations (re)created below. */ | |
2231 | if (b->cond_string != NULL) | |
2232 | { | |
2233 | b->cond_exp.reset (); | |
2234 | ||
2235 | s = b->cond_string.get (); | |
2236 | b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0); | |
2237 | } | |
2238 | } | |
2239 | ||
2240 | /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because | |
2241 | it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library, | |
2242 | don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete | |
2243 | such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression | |
2244 | is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */ | |
2245 | if (!target_has_execution ()) | |
2246 | { | |
2247 | /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and | |
2248 | set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when | |
2249 | the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */ | |
2250 | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | |
2251 | { | |
2252 | if (b->works_in_software_mode ()) | |
2253 | b->type = bp_watchpoint; | |
2254 | else | |
2255 | error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | |
2256 | "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | |
2257 | } | |
2258 | } | |
2259 | else if (within_current_scope && b->exp) | |
2260 | { | |
2261 | std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain; | |
2262 | struct value *v, *result; | |
2263 | struct program_space *wp_pspace; | |
2264 | ||
2265 | fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result, | |
2266 | &val_chain, false); | |
2267 | ||
2268 | /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of | |
2269 | b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update | |
2270 | it only if we reported that last value to user. As it | |
2271 | happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly. | |
2272 | We don't keep track of the memory value for masked | |
2273 | watchpoints. */ | |
2274 | if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b)) | |
2275 | { | |
2276 | if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | |
2277 | v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v); | |
2278 | b->val = release_value (v); | |
2279 | b->val_valid = true; | |
2280 | } | |
2281 | ||
2282 | if (b->exp_valid_block == nullptr) | |
2283 | wp_pspace = current_program_space; | |
2284 | else | |
2285 | wp_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL)); | |
2286 | ||
2287 | /* Look at each value on the value chain. */ | |
2288 | gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ()); | |
2289 | for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain) | |
2290 | { | |
2291 | v = iter.get (); | |
2292 | ||
2293 | /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed | |
2294 | its contents to evaluate the expression, then we | |
2295 | must watch it. If the first value returned is | |
2296 | still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it; | |
2297 | watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */ | |
2298 | if (v->lval () == lval_memory | |
2299 | && (v == val_chain[0] || ! v->lazy ())) | |
2300 | { | |
2301 | struct type *vtype = check_typedef (v->type ()); | |
2302 | ||
2303 | /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked | |
2304 | for it explicitly, never if they just happen to | |
2305 | appear in the middle of some value chain. */ | |
2306 | if (v == result | |
2307 | || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | |
2308 | && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | |
2309 | { | |
2310 | CORE_ADDR addr; | |
2311 | enum target_hw_bp_type type; | |
2312 | int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0; | |
2313 | ||
2314 | if (v->bitsize () != 0) | |
2315 | { | |
2316 | /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield | |
2317 | sub-expression. */ | |
2318 | bitpos = v->bitpos (); | |
2319 | bitsize = v->bitsize (); | |
2320 | } | |
2321 | else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0) | |
2322 | { | |
2323 | /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield | |
2324 | lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields | |
2325 | VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */ | |
2326 | bitpos = b->val_bitpos; | |
2327 | bitsize = b->val_bitsize; | |
2328 | } | |
2329 | ||
2330 | addr = v->address (); | |
2331 | if (bitsize != 0) | |
2332 | { | |
2333 | /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */ | |
2334 | addr += bitpos / 8; | |
2335 | } | |
2336 | ||
2337 | type = hw_write; | |
2338 | if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | |
2339 | type = hw_read; | |
2340 | else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | |
2341 | type = hw_access; | |
2342 | ||
2343 | bp_location *loc = b->allocate_location (); | |
2344 | loc->gdbarch = v->type ()->arch (); | |
2345 | loc->pspace = wp_pspace; | |
2346 | loc->address | |
2347 | = gdbarch_remove_non_address_bits_watchpoint (loc->gdbarch, | |
2348 | addr); | |
2349 | b->add_location (*loc); | |
2350 | ||
2351 | if (bitsize != 0) | |
2352 | { | |
2353 | /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */ | |
2354 | loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8; | |
2355 | } | |
2356 | else | |
2357 | loc->length = v->type ()->length (); | |
2358 | ||
2359 | loc->watchpoint_type = type; | |
2360 | } | |
2361 | } | |
2362 | } | |
2363 | ||
2364 | /* Helper function to bundle possibly emitting a warning along with | |
2365 | changing the type of B to bp_watchpoint. */ | |
2366 | auto change_type_to_bp_watchpoint = [] (breakpoint *bp) | |
2367 | { | |
2368 | /* Only warn for breakpoints that have been assigned a +ve number, | |
2369 | anything else is either an internal watchpoint (which we don't | |
2370 | currently create) or has not yet been finalized, in which case | |
2371 | this change of type will be occurring before the user is told | |
2372 | the type of this watchpoint. */ | |
2373 | if (bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bp->number > 0) | |
2374 | warning (_("watchpoint %d downgraded to software watchpoint"), | |
2375 | bp->number); | |
2376 | bp->type = bp_watchpoint; | |
2377 | }; | |
2378 | ||
2379 | /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or | |
2380 | an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support and | |
2381 | free hardware slots. Recheck the number of free hardware slots | |
2382 | as the value chain may have changed. */ | |
2383 | { | |
2384 | int reg_cnt; | |
2385 | enum bp_loc_type loc_type; | |
2386 | ||
2387 | reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain); | |
2388 | ||
2389 | if (reg_cnt) | |
2390 | { | |
2391 | int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used; | |
2392 | enum bptype type; | |
2393 | ||
2394 | /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be | |
2395 | watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */ | |
2396 | b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1; | |
2397 | ||
2398 | /* We need to determine how many resources are already | |
2399 | used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one | |
2400 | to see if we still have enough resources to also fit | |
2401 | this watchpoint in as well. */ | |
2402 | ||
2403 | /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it | |
2404 | to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of | |
2405 | hardware watchpoint type. */ | |
2406 | type = b->type; | |
2407 | if (type == bp_watchpoint) | |
2408 | type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | |
2409 | ||
2410 | /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on | |
2411 | the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list | |
2412 | if we're trying to create it for the first time, | |
2413 | through watch_command), so always account for it | |
2414 | manually. */ | |
2415 | ||
2416 | /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */ | |
2417 | i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used); | |
2418 | ||
2419 | /* Add in the resources needed for B. */ | |
2420 | i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b); | |
2421 | ||
2422 | target_resources_ok | |
2423 | = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used); | |
2424 | if (target_resources_ok <= 0) | |
2425 | { | |
2426 | bool sw_mode = b->works_in_software_mode (); | |
2427 | ||
2428 | if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode) | |
2429 | error (_("Target does not support this type of " | |
2430 | "hardware watchpoint.")); | |
2431 | else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode) | |
2432 | error (_("There are not enough available hardware " | |
2433 | "resources for this watchpoint.")); | |
2434 | ||
2435 | /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */ | |
2436 | change_type_to_bp_watchpoint (b); | |
2437 | } | |
2438 | else | |
2439 | { | |
2440 | /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just | |
2441 | found we have enough resources to turn it to a | |
2442 | hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a | |
2443 | nop. */ | |
2444 | b->type = type; | |
2445 | } | |
2446 | } | |
2447 | else if (!b->works_in_software_mode ()) | |
2448 | { | |
2449 | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | |
2450 | error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when " | |
2451 | "hardware watchpoints are disabled.")); | |
2452 | else | |
2453 | error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with " | |
2454 | "read/access watchpoint.")); | |
2455 | } | |
2456 | else | |
2457 | change_type_to_bp_watchpoint (b); | |
2458 | ||
2459 | loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_software_watchpoint | |
2460 | : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint); | |
2461 | ||
2462 | for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | |
2463 | bl.loc_type = loc_type; | |
2464 | } | |
2465 | ||
2466 | /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the | |
2467 | above left it without any location set up. But, | |
2468 | bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report | |
2469 | stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */ | |
2470 | if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && !b->has_locations ()) | |
2471 | add_dummy_location (b, wp_pspace); | |
2472 | } | |
2473 | else if (!within_current_scope) | |
2474 | { | |
2475 | gdb_printf (_("\ | |
2476 | Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\ | |
2477 | in which its expression is valid.\n"), | |
2478 | b->number); | |
2479 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | |
2480 | } | |
2481 | } | |
2482 | ||
2483 | /* Returns true iff breakpoint location should be | |
2484 | inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner | |
2485 | (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's | |
2486 | breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location, | |
2487 | tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */ | |
2488 | ||
2489 | static bool | |
2490 | should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | |
2491 | { | |
2492 | if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)) | |
2493 | return false; | |
2494 | ||
2495 | if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
2496 | return false; | |
2497 | ||
2498 | if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond | |
2499 | || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate) | |
2500 | return false; | |
2501 | ||
2502 | if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup) | |
2503 | return false; | |
2504 | ||
2505 | /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a | |
2506 | vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running | |
2507 | free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the | |
2508 | OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports | |
2509 | that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared | |
2510 | memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise | |
2511 | the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since | |
2512 | the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */ | |
2513 | if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed) | |
2514 | return false; | |
2515 | ||
2516 | /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its | |
2517 | location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint, | |
2518 | and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past | |
2519 | a breakpoint. */ | |
2520 | if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
2521 | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
2522 | && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | |
2523 | bl->address) | |
2524 | /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location | |
2525 | we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself. | |
2526 | However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may | |
2527 | break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the | |
2528 | instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags. | |
2529 | We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction | |
2530 | or switch to displaced stepping. */ | |
2531 | && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step | |
2532 | && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread))) | |
2533 | { | |
2534 | infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s", | |
2535 | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | |
2536 | return false; | |
2537 | } | |
2538 | ||
2539 | /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the | |
2540 | instruction that triggered one. */ | |
2541 | if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | |
2542 | && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ()) | |
2543 | { | |
2544 | infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. " | |
2545 | "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d", | |
2546 | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length); | |
2547 | return false; | |
2548 | } | |
2549 | ||
2550 | return true; | |
2551 | } | |
2552 | ||
2553 | /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming | |
2554 | that the location is not duplicated. */ | |
2555 | ||
2556 | static bool | |
2557 | unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl) | |
2558 | { | |
2559 | scoped_restore restore_bl_duplicate | |
2560 | = make_scoped_restore (&bl->duplicate, 0); | |
2561 | ||
2562 | return should_be_inserted (bl); | |
2563 | } | |
2564 | ||
2565 | /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an | |
2566 | agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation | |
2567 | by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was | |
2568 | any error during parsing. */ | |
2569 | ||
2570 | static agent_expr_up | |
2571 | parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond) | |
2572 | { | |
2573 | if (cond == NULL) | |
2574 | return NULL; | |
2575 | ||
2576 | agent_expr_up aexpr; | |
2577 | ||
2578 | /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | |
2579 | that may show up. */ | |
2580 | try | |
2581 | { | |
2582 | aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond); | |
2583 | } | |
2584 | ||
2585 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | |
2586 | { | |
2587 | /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid | |
2588 | bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | |
2589 | It's no use iterating through the conditions. */ | |
2590 | } | |
2591 | ||
2592 | /* We have a valid agent expression. */ | |
2593 | return aexpr; | |
2594 | } | |
2595 | ||
2596 | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be | |
2597 | passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different | |
2598 | conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the | |
2599 | target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when | |
2600 | one of them is true. */ | |
2601 | ||
2602 | static void | |
2603 | build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl) | |
2604 | { | |
2605 | bool null_condition_or_parse_error = false; | |
2606 | int modified = bl->needs_update; | |
2607 | ||
2608 | /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */ | |
2609 | bl->target_info.conditions.clear (); | |
2610 | ||
2611 | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | |
2612 | evaluating conditions and if the user has | |
2613 | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | |
2614 | side. */ | |
2615 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
2616 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
2617 | return; | |
2618 | ||
2619 | auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); | |
2620 | ||
2621 | /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | |
2622 | conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent | |
2623 | expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to | |
2624 | send conditions to the target since this location will always | |
2625 | trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider | |
2626 | all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e., | |
2627 | even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g., | |
2628 | software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same | |
2629 | address). */ | |
2630 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2631 | { | |
2632 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | |
2633 | { | |
2634 | if (modified) | |
2635 | { | |
2636 | /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that | |
2637 | case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see | |
2638 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just | |
2639 | need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */ | |
2640 | loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, | |
2641 | loc->cond.get ()); | |
2642 | } | |
2643 | ||
2644 | /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | |
2645 | went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */ | |
2646 | if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | |
2647 | { | |
2648 | null_condition_or_parse_error = true; | |
2649 | break; | |
2650 | } | |
2651 | } | |
2652 | } | |
2653 | ||
2654 | /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions | |
2655 | for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes | |
2656 | for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here. | |
2657 | ||
2658 | This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are | |
2659 | being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */ | |
2660 | if (null_condition_or_parse_error) | |
2661 | { | |
2662 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2663 | { | |
2664 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | |
2665 | { | |
2666 | /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | |
2667 | located. */ | |
2668 | if (!loc->cond_bytecode) | |
2669 | return; | |
2670 | ||
2671 | loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | |
2672 | } | |
2673 | } | |
2674 | } | |
2675 | ||
2676 | /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a | |
2677 | condition list for this location's address. If we have software | |
2678 | and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't | |
2679 | considered duplicates, but we still merge all the conditions | |
2680 | anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical | |
2681 | difference. */ | |
2682 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2683 | if (loc->cond | |
2684 | && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | |
2685 | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | |
2686 | && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | |
2687 | && loc->enabled | |
2688 | && !loc->disabled_by_cond) | |
2689 | { | |
2690 | /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later | |
2691 | to send the conditions to the target. */ | |
2692 | bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ()); | |
2693 | } | |
2694 | ||
2695 | return; | |
2696 | } | |
2697 | ||
2698 | /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression | |
2699 | bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter. | |
2700 | Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */ | |
2701 | ||
2702 | static agent_expr_up | |
2703 | parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd) | |
2704 | { | |
2705 | const char *cmdrest; | |
2706 | const char *format_start, *format_end; | |
2707 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch (); | |
2708 | ||
2709 | if (cmd == NULL) | |
2710 | return NULL; | |
2711 | ||
2712 | cmdrest = cmd; | |
2713 | ||
2714 | if (*cmdrest == ',') | |
2715 | ++cmdrest; | |
2716 | cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | |
2717 | ||
2718 | if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | |
2719 | error (_("No format string following the location")); | |
2720 | ||
2721 | format_start = cmdrest; | |
2722 | ||
2723 | format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest); | |
2724 | ||
2725 | format_end = cmdrest; | |
2726 | ||
2727 | if (*cmdrest++ != '"') | |
2728 | error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'.")); | |
2729 | ||
2730 | cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | |
2731 | ||
2732 | if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0')) | |
2733 | error (_("Invalid argument syntax")); | |
2734 | ||
2735 | if (*cmdrest == ',') | |
2736 | cmdrest++; | |
2737 | cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest); | |
2738 | ||
2739 | /* For each argument, make an expression. */ | |
2740 | ||
2741 | std::vector<struct expression *> argvec; | |
2742 | while (*cmdrest != '\0') | |
2743 | { | |
2744 | const char *cmd1; | |
2745 | ||
2746 | cmd1 = cmdrest; | |
2747 | expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), | |
2748 | PARSER_COMMA_TERMINATES); | |
2749 | argvec.push_back (expr.release ()); | |
2750 | cmdrest = cmd1; | |
2751 | if (*cmdrest == ',') | |
2752 | ++cmdrest; | |
2753 | } | |
2754 | ||
2755 | agent_expr_up aexpr; | |
2756 | ||
2757 | /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors | |
2758 | that may show up. */ | |
2759 | try | |
2760 | { | |
2761 | aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0, | |
2762 | format_start, format_end - format_start, | |
2763 | argvec.size (), argvec.data ()); | |
2764 | } | |
2765 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | |
2766 | { | |
2767 | /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid | |
2768 | bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side. | |
2769 | It's no use iterating through the other commands. */ | |
2770 | } | |
2771 | ||
2772 | /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */ | |
2773 | return aexpr; | |
2774 | } | |
2775 | ||
2776 | /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be | |
2777 | passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with | |
2778 | different commands, we will add any such to the list. */ | |
2779 | ||
2780 | static void | |
2781 | build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl) | |
2782 | { | |
2783 | bool null_command_or_parse_error = false; | |
2784 | int modified = bl->needs_update; | |
2785 | ||
2786 | /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */ | |
2787 | bl->target_info.tcommands.clear (); | |
2788 | ||
2789 | if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | |
2790 | return; | |
2791 | ||
2792 | /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */ | |
2793 | if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent) | |
2794 | return; | |
2795 | ||
2796 | auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address); | |
2797 | ||
2798 | /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a | |
2799 | dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would | |
2800 | make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose | |
2801 | control. */ | |
2802 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2803 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | |
2804 | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | |
2805 | && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf) | |
2806 | return; | |
2807 | ||
2808 | /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned | |
2809 | conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression | |
2810 | bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions | |
2811 | to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a | |
2812 | response back to GDB. */ | |
2813 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2814 | { | |
2815 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | |
2816 | { | |
2817 | if (modified) | |
2818 | { | |
2819 | /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that | |
2820 | case we already freed the command bytecodes (see | |
2821 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just | |
2822 | need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */ | |
2823 | loc->cmd_bytecode | |
2824 | = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address, | |
2825 | loc->owner->extra_string.get ()); | |
2826 | } | |
2827 | ||
2828 | /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something | |
2829 | went wrong or we have a null command expression. */ | |
2830 | if (!loc->cmd_bytecode) | |
2831 | { | |
2832 | null_command_or_parse_error = true; | |
2833 | break; | |
2834 | } | |
2835 | } | |
2836 | } | |
2837 | ||
2838 | /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands, | |
2839 | and so clean up. */ | |
2840 | if (null_command_or_parse_error) | |
2841 | { | |
2842 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2843 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | |
2844 | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num) | |
2845 | { | |
2846 | /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is | |
2847 | located. */ | |
2848 | if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL) | |
2849 | return; | |
2850 | ||
2851 | loc->cmd_bytecode.reset (); | |
2852 | } | |
2853 | } | |
2854 | ||
2855 | /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command | |
2856 | list for all duplicate locations at this location's address. | |
2857 | Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location | |
2858 | types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a | |
2859 | software and hardware location at the same address, the target | |
2860 | could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only | |
2861 | support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt | |
2862 | to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */ | |
2863 | for (bp_location *loc : loc_range) | |
2864 | if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc) | |
2865 | && loc->owner->extra_string | |
2866 | && is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | |
2867 | && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num | |
2868 | && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled | |
2869 | && loc->enabled | |
2870 | && !loc->disabled_by_cond) | |
2871 | { | |
2872 | /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later | |
2873 | to send the commands to the target. */ | |
2874 | bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ()); | |
2875 | } | |
2876 | ||
2877 | bl->target_info.persist = 0; | |
2878 | /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */ | |
2879 | if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf) | |
2880 | bl->target_info.persist = 1; | |
2881 | } | |
2882 | ||
2883 | /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind | |
2884 | of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint. | |
2885 | Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current | |
2886 | registers state. */ | |
2887 | ||
2888 | static int | |
2889 | breakpoint_kind (const struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr) | |
2890 | { | |
2891 | if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step) | |
2892 | { | |
2893 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread); | |
2894 | struct regcache *regcache; | |
2895 | ||
2896 | regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr); | |
2897 | ||
2898 | return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch, | |
2899 | regcache, addr); | |
2900 | } | |
2901 | else | |
2902 | return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr); | |
2903 | } | |
2904 | ||
2905 | /* Rethrow the currently handled exception, if it's a TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR. | |
2906 | E is either the currently handled exception, or a copy, or a sliced copy, | |
2907 | so we can't rethrow that one, but we can use it to inspect the properties | |
2908 | of the currently handled exception. */ | |
2909 | ||
2910 | static void | |
2911 | rethrow_on_target_close_error (const gdb_exception &e) | |
2912 | { | |
2913 | if (e.reason == 0) | |
2914 | return; | |
2915 | /* Can't set the breakpoint. */ | |
2916 | ||
2917 | if (e.error != TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR) | |
2918 | return; | |
2919 | ||
2920 | /* If the target has closed then it will have deleted any breakpoints | |
2921 | inserted within the target inferior, as a result any further attempts | |
2922 | to interact with the breakpoint objects is not possible. Just rethrow | |
2923 | the error. Don't use e to rethrow, to prevent object slicing of the | |
2924 | exception. */ | |
2925 | throw; | |
2926 | } | |
2927 | ||
2928 | /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint | |
2929 | location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and | |
2930 | DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems. | |
2931 | Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or | |
2932 | -1 for failure. | |
2933 | ||
2934 | NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an | |
2935 | object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */ | |
2936 | static int | |
2937 | insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl, | |
2938 | struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream, | |
2939 | int *disabled_breaks, | |
2940 | int *hw_breakpoint_error, | |
2941 | int *hw_bp_error_explained_already) | |
2942 | { | |
2943 | gdb_exception bp_excpt; | |
2944 | ||
2945 | if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | |
2946 | return 0; | |
2947 | ||
2948 | breakpoint_debug_printf ("%s", breakpoint_location_address_str (bl).c_str ()); | |
2949 | ||
2950 | /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out | |
2951 | the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint | |
2952 | is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks | |
2953 | target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when | |
2954 | a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location: | |
2955 | Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that | |
2956 | we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus | |
2957 | read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in | |
2958 | the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */ | |
2959 | bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address; | |
2960 | bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace.get (); | |
2961 | bl->target_info.length = bl->length; | |
2962 | ||
2963 | /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions | |
2964 | for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not | |
2965 | insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target | |
2966 | can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */ | |
2967 | ||
2968 | if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | |
2969 | { | |
2970 | build_target_condition_list (bl); | |
2971 | build_target_command_list (bl); | |
2972 | /* Reset the modification marker. */ | |
2973 | bl->needs_update = 0; | |
2974 | } | |
2975 | ||
2976 | /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was | |
2977 | set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have | |
2978 | been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is | |
2979 | "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the | |
2980 | breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */ | |
2981 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
2982 | && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints) | |
2983 | { | |
2984 | mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); | |
2985 | ||
2986 | if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | |
2987 | { | |
2988 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
2989 | _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | |
2990 | "Cannot set software breakpoint " | |
2991 | "at read-only address %s\n"), | |
2992 | bl->owner->number, | |
2993 | paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | |
2994 | return 1; | |
2995 | } | |
2996 | } | |
2997 | ||
2998 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
2999 | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
3000 | { | |
3001 | /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */ | |
3002 | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | |
3003 | || bl->section == NULL | |
3004 | || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | |
3005 | { | |
3006 | /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */ | |
3007 | try | |
3008 | { | |
3009 | int val; | |
3010 | ||
3011 | val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | |
3012 | if (val) | |
3013 | bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | |
3014 | } | |
3015 | catch (gdb_exception &e) | |
3016 | { | |
3017 | rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | |
3018 | bp_excpt = std::move (e); | |
3019 | } | |
3020 | } | |
3021 | else | |
3022 | { | |
3023 | /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | |
3024 | Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */ | |
3025 | if (!overlay_events_enabled) | |
3026 | { | |
3027 | /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, | |
3028 | so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA. | |
3029 | This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */ | |
3030 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
3031 | warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"), | |
3032 | bl->owner->number); | |
3033 | else | |
3034 | { | |
3035 | CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address, | |
3036 | bl->section); | |
3037 | /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */ | |
3038 | bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info; | |
3039 | bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr; | |
3040 | ||
3041 | /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */ | |
3042 | try | |
3043 | { | |
3044 | int val; | |
3045 | ||
3046 | bl->overlay_target_info.kind | |
3047 | = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | |
3048 | bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr; | |
3049 | val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | |
3050 | &bl->overlay_target_info); | |
3051 | if (val) | |
3052 | bp_excpt | |
3053 | = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | |
3054 | } | |
3055 | catch (gdb_exception &e) | |
3056 | { | |
3057 | rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | |
3058 | bp_excpt = std::move (e); | |
3059 | } | |
3060 | ||
3061 | if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) | |
3062 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3063 | "Overlay breakpoint %d " | |
3064 | "failed: in ROM?\n", | |
3065 | bl->owner->number); | |
3066 | } | |
3067 | } | |
3068 | /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */ | |
3069 | if (section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | |
3070 | { | |
3071 | /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */ | |
3072 | try | |
3073 | { | |
3074 | int val; | |
3075 | ||
3076 | val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | |
3077 | if (val) | |
3078 | bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR}; | |
3079 | } | |
3080 | catch (gdb_exception_error &e) | |
3081 | { | |
3082 | rethrow_on_target_close_error (e); | |
3083 | bp_excpt = std::move (e); | |
3084 | } | |
3085 | } | |
3086 | else | |
3087 | { | |
3088 | /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted. | |
3089 | No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */ | |
3090 | return 0; | |
3091 | } | |
3092 | } | |
3093 | ||
3094 | if (bp_excpt.reason != 0) | |
3095 | { | |
3096 | /* Can't set the breakpoint. */ | |
3097 | gdb_assert (bl->owner != nullptr); | |
3098 | ||
3099 | /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a | |
3100 | breakpoint in a shared library that has already been | |
3101 | removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload | |
3102 | event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement | |
3103 | breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the | |
3104 | breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target | |
3105 | doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic | |
3106 | errors as memory errors. */ | |
3107 | if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR | |
3108 | && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR | |
3109 | || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR) | |
3110 | && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
3111 | && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | |
3112 | || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | |
3113 | bl->address))) | |
3114 | { | |
3115 | bl->shlib_disabled = 1; | |
3116 | notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner); | |
3117 | if (!*disabled_breaks) | |
3118 | { | |
3119 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3120 | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n", | |
3121 | bl->owner->number); | |
3122 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3123 | "Temporarily disabling shared " | |
3124 | "library breakpoints:\n"); | |
3125 | } | |
3126 | *disabled_breaks = 1; | |
3127 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3128 | "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number); | |
3129 | return 0; | |
3130 | } | |
3131 | else | |
3132 | { | |
3133 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
3134 | { | |
3135 | *hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | |
3136 | *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL; | |
3137 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3138 | "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s", | |
3139 | bl->owner->number, | |
3140 | bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n"); | |
3141 | if (bp_excpt.message != NULL) | |
3142 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", | |
3143 | bp_excpt.what ()); | |
3144 | } | |
3145 | else | |
3146 | { | |
3147 | if (bp_excpt.message == NULL) | |
3148 | { | |
3149 | std::string message | |
3150 | = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO, | |
3151 | bl->gdbarch, bl->address); | |
3152 | ||
3153 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3154 | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n" | |
3155 | "%s\n", | |
3156 | bl->owner->number, message.c_str ()); | |
3157 | } | |
3158 | else | |
3159 | { | |
3160 | gdb_printf (tmp_error_stream, | |
3161 | "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n", | |
3162 | bl->owner->number, | |
3163 | bp_excpt.what ()); | |
3164 | } | |
3165 | } | |
3166 | return 1; | |
3167 | ||
3168 | } | |
3169 | } | |
3170 | else | |
3171 | bl->inserted = 1; | |
3172 | ||
3173 | return 0; | |
3174 | } | |
3175 | ||
3176 | else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | |
3177 | && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
3178 | { | |
3179 | int val; | |
3180 | ||
3181 | val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | |
3182 | ||
3183 | /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not | |
3184 | supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */ | |
3185 | if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | |
3186 | { | |
3187 | /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another | |
3188 | hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate | |
3189 | of this one. */ | |
3190 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3191 | if (loc != bl | |
3192 | && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access | |
3193 | && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)) | |
3194 | { | |
3195 | bl->duplicate = 1; | |
3196 | bl->inserted = 1; | |
3197 | bl->target_info = loc->target_info; | |
3198 | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | |
3199 | val = 0; | |
3200 | break; | |
3201 | } | |
3202 | ||
3203 | if (val == 1) | |
3204 | { | |
3205 | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access; | |
3206 | val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | |
3207 | ||
3208 | if (val) | |
3209 | /* Back to the original value. */ | |
3210 | bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read; | |
3211 | } | |
3212 | } | |
3213 | ||
3214 | bl->inserted = (val == 0); | |
3215 | } | |
3216 | ||
3217 | else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint) | |
3218 | { | |
3219 | int val; | |
3220 | ||
3221 | val = bl->owner->insert_location (bl); | |
3222 | if (val) | |
3223 | { | |
3224 | bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3225 | ||
3226 | if (val == 1) | |
3227 | warning (_("\ | |
3228 | Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\ | |
3229 | of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number); | |
3230 | else | |
3231 | warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number); | |
3232 | } | |
3233 | ||
3234 | bl->inserted = (val == 0); | |
3235 | ||
3236 | /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem | |
3237 | inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint, | |
3238 | so just return success. */ | |
3239 | return 0; | |
3240 | } | |
3241 | ||
3242 | return 0; | |
3243 | } | |
3244 | ||
3245 | /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be | |
3246 | deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference | |
3247 | PSPACE anymore. */ | |
3248 | ||
3249 | void | |
3250 | breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace) | |
3251 | { | |
3252 | /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */ | |
3253 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
3254 | if (b.pspace == pspace) | |
3255 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
3256 | ||
3257 | /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations | |
3258 | bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */ | |
3259 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3260 | if (loc->pspace == pspace) | |
3261 | { | |
3262 | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */ | |
3263 | loc->owner->unadd_location (*loc); | |
3264 | } | |
3265 | ||
3266 | /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the | |
3267 | removed locations above. */ | |
3268 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
3269 | } | |
3270 | ||
3271 | /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior. | |
3272 | Throws exception on any error. | |
3273 | A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted | |
3274 | again, so calling this function twice is safe. */ | |
3275 | void | |
3276 | insert_breakpoints (void) | |
3277 | { | |
3278 | for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | |
3279 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&bpt)) | |
3280 | { | |
3281 | watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (bpt); | |
3282 | ||
3283 | update_watchpoint (&w, false /* don't reparse. */); | |
3284 | } | |
3285 | ||
3286 | /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global | |
3287 | location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and | |
3288 | ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also, | |
3289 | update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software | |
3290 | breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint | |
3291 | auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new | |
3292 | locations. */ | |
3293 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | |
3294 | } | |
3295 | ||
3296 | /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the | |
3297 | target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using | |
3298 | always-inserted mode. */ | |
3299 | ||
3300 | static void | |
3301 | update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void) | |
3302 | { | |
3303 | int error_flag = 0; | |
3304 | int val = 0; | |
3305 | int disabled_breaks = 0; | |
3306 | int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | |
3307 | int hw_bp_details_reported = 0; | |
3308 | ||
3309 | string_file tmp_error_stream; | |
3310 | ||
3311 | /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | |
3312 | there was an error. */ | |
3313 | tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); | |
3314 | ||
3315 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
3316 | ||
3317 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3318 | { | |
3319 | /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware | |
3320 | breakpoints. */ | |
3321 | if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | |
3322 | continue; | |
3323 | ||
3324 | /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted | |
3325 | and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during | |
3326 | deletion of breakpoints. */ | |
3327 | if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update) | |
3328 | continue; | |
3329 | ||
3330 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | |
3331 | ||
3332 | /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | |
3333 | to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even | |
3334 | if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | |
3335 | insert breakpoints. */ | |
3336 | if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
3337 | && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) | |
3338 | continue; | |
3339 | ||
3340 | val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | |
3341 | &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported); | |
3342 | if (val) | |
3343 | error_flag = val; | |
3344 | } | |
3345 | ||
3346 | if (error_flag) | |
3347 | { | |
3348 | target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | |
3349 | error (("%s"), tmp_error_stream.c_str ()); | |
3350 | } | |
3351 | } | |
3352 | ||
3353 | /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */ | |
3354 | ||
3355 | static void | |
3356 | insert_breakpoint_locations (void) | |
3357 | { | |
3358 | int error_flag = 0; | |
3359 | int val = 0; | |
3360 | int disabled_breaks = 0; | |
3361 | int hw_breakpoint_error = 0; | |
3362 | int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0; | |
3363 | ||
3364 | string_file tmp_error_stream; | |
3365 | ||
3366 | /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if | |
3367 | there was an error. */ | |
3368 | tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n"); | |
3369 | ||
3370 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
3371 | ||
3372 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3373 | { | |
3374 | if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update)) | |
3375 | continue; | |
3376 | ||
3377 | /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if | |
3378 | the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location | |
3379 | has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ | |
3380 | if (bl->owner->thread != -1 | |
3381 | && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread)) | |
3382 | continue; | |
3383 | ||
3384 | /* Or inferior specific breakpoints if the inferior no longer | |
3385 | exists. */ | |
3386 | if (bl->owner->inferior != -1 | |
3387 | && !valid_global_inferior_id (bl->owner->inferior)) | |
3388 | continue; | |
3389 | ||
3390 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | |
3391 | ||
3392 | /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need | |
3393 | to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even | |
3394 | if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still | |
3395 | insert breakpoints. */ | |
3396 | if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
3397 | && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())) | |
3398 | continue; | |
3399 | ||
3400 | val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks, | |
3401 | &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already); | |
3402 | if (val) | |
3403 | error_flag = val; | |
3404 | } | |
3405 | ||
3406 | /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove | |
3407 | them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */ | |
3408 | for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | |
3409 | { | |
3410 | bool some_failed = false; | |
3411 | ||
3412 | if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (&bpt)) | |
3413 | continue; | |
3414 | ||
3415 | if (!breakpoint_enabled (&bpt)) | |
3416 | continue; | |
3417 | ||
3418 | if (bpt.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
3419 | continue; | |
3420 | ||
3421 | for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | |
3422 | if (!loc.inserted && should_be_inserted (&loc)) | |
3423 | { | |
3424 | some_failed = true; | |
3425 | break; | |
3426 | } | |
3427 | ||
3428 | if (some_failed) | |
3429 | { | |
3430 | for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | |
3431 | if (loc.inserted) | |
3432 | remove_breakpoint (&loc); | |
3433 | ||
3434 | hw_breakpoint_error = 1; | |
3435 | tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert " | |
3436 | "hardware watchpoint %d.\n", | |
3437 | bpt.number); | |
3438 | error_flag = -1; | |
3439 | } | |
3440 | } | |
3441 | ||
3442 | if (error_flag) | |
3443 | { | |
3444 | /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a | |
3445 | message about possibly exhausted resources. */ | |
3446 | if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already) | |
3447 | { | |
3448 | tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\ | |
3449 | You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n"); | |
3450 | } | |
3451 | target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | |
3452 | error (("%s"), tmp_error_stream.c_str ()); | |
3453 | } | |
3454 | } | |
3455 | ||
3456 | /* Used when the program stops. | |
3457 | Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem | |
3458 | removing a breakpoint location. */ | |
3459 | ||
3460 | int | |
3461 | remove_breakpoints (void) | |
3462 | { | |
3463 | int val = 0; | |
3464 | ||
3465 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3466 | if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner)) | |
3467 | val |= remove_breakpoint (bl); | |
3468 | ||
3469 | return val; | |
3470 | } | |
3471 | ||
3472 | /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to | |
3473 | that thread. */ | |
3474 | ||
3475 | static void | |
3476 | remove_threaded_breakpoints (thread_info *tp, | |
3477 | std::optional<ULONGEST> /* exit_code */, | |
3478 | int /* silent */) | |
3479 | { | |
3480 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
3481 | { | |
3482 | if (b.thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
3483 | { | |
3484 | gdb_printf (_("\ | |
3485 | Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"), | |
3486 | b.number, print_thread_id (tp)); | |
3487 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
3488 | } | |
3489 | } | |
3490 | } | |
3491 | ||
3492 | /* Called when inferior INF has been removed from GDB. Remove associated | |
3493 | per-inferior breakpoints. */ | |
3494 | ||
3495 | static void | |
3496 | remove_inferior_breakpoints (struct inferior *inf) | |
3497 | { | |
3498 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
3499 | { | |
3500 | if (b.inferior == inf->num && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
3501 | { | |
3502 | /* Tell the user the breakpoint has been deleted. But only for | |
3503 | breakpoints that would not normally have been deleted at the | |
3504 | next stop anyway. */ | |
3505 | if (b.disposition != disp_del | |
3506 | && b.disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
3507 | gdb_printf (_("\ | |
3508 | Inferior-specific breakpoint %d deleted - inferior %d has been removed.\n"), | |
3509 | b.number, inf->num); | |
3510 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
3511 | } | |
3512 | } | |
3513 | } | |
3514 | ||
3515 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
3516 | ||
3517 | void | |
3518 | remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf) | |
3519 | { | |
3520 | int val; | |
3521 | ||
3522 | breakpoint_debug_printf ("inf->num = %d", inf->num); | |
3523 | ||
3524 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
3525 | { | |
3526 | if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | |
3527 | continue; | |
3528 | ||
3529 | if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist) | |
3530 | { | |
3531 | val = remove_breakpoint (bl); | |
3532 | if (val != 0) | |
3533 | return; | |
3534 | } | |
3535 | } | |
3536 | } | |
3537 | ||
3538 | static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1; | |
3539 | ||
3540 | /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL. | |
3541 | If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated | |
3542 | from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented. | |
3543 | Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from | |
3544 | breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints | |
3545 | do not set the internal var bpnum. */ | |
3546 | static void | |
3547 | set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b) | |
3548 | { | |
3549 | if (internal) | |
3550 | b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | |
3551 | else | |
3552 | { | |
3553 | set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1); | |
3554 | b->number = breakpoint_count; | |
3555 | } | |
3556 | } | |
3557 | ||
3558 | /* Create a TYPE breakpoint on ADDRESS from an object file with GDBARCH. */ | |
3559 | ||
3560 | static struct breakpoint * | |
3561 | create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
3562 | CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type) | |
3563 | { | |
3564 | std::unique_ptr<internal_breakpoint> b | |
3565 | (new internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, address)); | |
3566 | ||
3567 | b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--; | |
3568 | ||
3569 | return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); | |
3570 | } | |
3571 | ||
3572 | /* Create a TYPE breakpoint on minimal symbol MSYM from an object file with | |
3573 | GDBARCH. */ | |
3574 | ||
3575 | static struct breakpoint * | |
3576 | create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
3577 | bound_minimal_symbol &msym, enum bptype type) | |
3578 | { | |
3579 | CORE_ADDR address; | |
3580 | ||
3581 | address = msym.value_address (); | |
3582 | ||
3583 | address = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr | |
3584 | (gdbarch, address, current_inferior ()->top_target ()); | |
3585 | ||
3586 | /* Note that we're not using gdbarch_addr_bits_remove here, because that's | |
3587 | related to addresses in $pc. We're getting the address from the | |
3588 | minimal symbol table. */ | |
3589 | ||
3590 | /* Is gdbarch_deprecated_function_start_offset needed here? Or is that dealt | |
3591 | with elsewhere? Needs testing on vax. */ | |
3592 | ||
3593 | if (gdbarch_skip_entrypoint_p (gdbarch)) | |
3594 | address = gdbarch_skip_entrypoint (gdbarch, address); | |
3595 | ||
3596 | return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, type); | |
3597 | } | |
3598 | ||
3599 | static const char *const longjmp_names[] = | |
3600 | { | |
3601 | "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp" | |
3602 | }; | |
3603 | #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names) | |
3604 | ||
3605 | /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */ | |
3606 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data | |
3607 | { | |
3608 | /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */ | |
3609 | bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym; | |
3610 | ||
3611 | /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */ | |
3612 | bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES]; | |
3613 | ||
3614 | /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */ | |
3615 | int longjmp_searched = 0; | |
3616 | ||
3617 | /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning | |
3618 | references. */ | |
3619 | std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes; | |
3620 | ||
3621 | /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */ | |
3622 | bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym; | |
3623 | ||
3624 | /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */ | |
3625 | bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym; | |
3626 | ||
3627 | /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */ | |
3628 | int exception_searched = 0; | |
3629 | ||
3630 | /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning | |
3631 | references. */ | |
3632 | std::vector<probe *> exception_probes; | |
3633 | }; | |
3634 | ||
3635 | static const registry<objfile>::key<breakpoint_objfile_data> | |
3636 | breakpoint_objfile_key; | |
3637 | ||
3638 | /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */ | |
3639 | static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found; | |
3640 | ||
3641 | /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */ | |
3642 | ||
3643 | static bool | |
3644 | msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym) | |
3645 | { | |
3646 | return msym == &msym_not_found; | |
3647 | } | |
3648 | ||
3649 | /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c. | |
3650 | Allocate the data if necessary. */ | |
3651 | ||
3652 | static struct breakpoint_objfile_data * | |
3653 | get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile) | |
3654 | { | |
3655 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | |
3656 | ||
3657 | bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile); | |
3658 | if (bp_objfile_data == NULL) | |
3659 | bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile); | |
3660 | return bp_objfile_data; | |
3661 | } | |
3662 | ||
3663 | static void | |
3664 | create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void) | |
3665 | { | |
3666 | const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event"; | |
3667 | ||
3668 | for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ()) | |
3669 | { | |
3670 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3671 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | |
3672 | CORE_ADDR addr; | |
3673 | ||
3674 | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3675 | ||
3676 | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym)) | |
3677 | continue; | |
3678 | ||
3679 | if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL) | |
3680 | { | |
3681 | bound_minimal_symbol m | |
3682 | = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (current_program_space, func_name, | |
3683 | objfile); | |
3684 | if (m.minsym == NULL) | |
3685 | { | |
3686 | /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */ | |
3687 | bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | |
3688 | continue; | |
3689 | } | |
3690 | bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m; | |
3691 | } | |
3692 | ||
3693 | addr = bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.value_address (); | |
3694 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr, | |
3695 | bp_overlay_event); | |
3696 | b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | |
3697 | ||
3698 | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto) | |
3699 | { | |
3700 | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
3701 | overlay_events_enabled = 1; | |
3702 | } | |
3703 | else | |
3704 | { | |
3705 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3706 | overlay_events_enabled = 0; | |
3707 | } | |
3708 | } | |
3709 | } | |
3710 | ||
3711 | /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe. Return | |
3712 | true if a breakpoint was installed. */ | |
3713 | ||
3714 | static bool | |
3715 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) | |
3716 | { | |
3717 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | |
3718 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data | |
3719 | = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3720 | ||
3721 | if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched) | |
3722 | { | |
3723 | std::vector<probe *> ret | |
3724 | = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp"); | |
3725 | ||
3726 | if (!ret.empty ()) | |
3727 | { | |
3728 | /* We are only interested in checking one element. */ | |
3729 | probe *p = ret[0]; | |
3730 | ||
3731 | if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) | |
3732 | { | |
3733 | /* We cannot use the probe interface here, | |
3734 | because it does not know how to evaluate | |
3735 | arguments. */ | |
3736 | ret.clear (); | |
3737 | } | |
3738 | } | |
3739 | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret; | |
3740 | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1; | |
3741 | } | |
3742 | ||
3743 | if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ()) | |
3744 | return false; | |
3745 | ||
3746 | for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes) | |
3747 | { | |
3748 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3749 | ||
3750 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | |
3751 | p->get_relocated_address (objfile), | |
3752 | bp_longjmp_master); | |
3753 | b->locspec = new_probe_location_spec ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp"); | |
3754 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3755 | } | |
3756 | ||
3757 | return true; | |
3758 | } | |
3759 | ||
3760 | /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names. | |
3761 | Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed. */ | |
3762 | ||
3763 | static bool | |
3764 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile) | |
3765 | { | |
3766 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | |
3767 | if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch)) | |
3768 | return false; | |
3769 | ||
3770 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data | |
3771 | = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3772 | unsigned int installed_bp = 0; | |
3773 | ||
3774 | for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++) | |
3775 | { | |
3776 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3777 | const char *func_name; | |
3778 | CORE_ADDR addr; | |
3779 | ||
3780 | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym)) | |
3781 | continue; | |
3782 | ||
3783 | func_name = longjmp_names[i]; | |
3784 | if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL) | |
3785 | { | |
3786 | bound_minimal_symbol m | |
3787 | = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (objfile->pspace (), func_name, | |
3788 | objfile); | |
3789 | if (m.minsym == NULL) | |
3790 | { | |
3791 | /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */ | |
3792 | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found; | |
3793 | continue; | |
3794 | } | |
3795 | bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m; | |
3796 | } | |
3797 | ||
3798 | addr = bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].value_address (); | |
3799 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master); | |
3800 | b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | |
3801 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3802 | installed_bp++; | |
3803 | } | |
3804 | ||
3805 | return installed_bp > 0; | |
3806 | } | |
3807 | ||
3808 | /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint. */ | |
3809 | ||
3810 | static void | |
3811 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void) | |
3812 | { | |
3813 | scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | |
3814 | ||
3815 | for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) | |
3816 | { | |
3817 | set_current_program_space (pspace); | |
3818 | ||
3819 | for (objfile *obj : pspace->objfiles ()) | |
3820 | { | |
3821 | /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below. */ | |
3822 | if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr) | |
3823 | continue; | |
3824 | ||
3825 | /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile. */ | |
3826 | if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (obj)) | |
3827 | continue; | |
3828 | ||
3829 | /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug | |
3830 | objfiles. */ | |
3831 | for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ()) | |
3832 | if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile)) | |
3833 | break; | |
3834 | } | |
3835 | } | |
3836 | } | |
3837 | ||
3838 | /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */ | |
3839 | static void | |
3840 | create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void) | |
3841 | { | |
3842 | const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()"; | |
3843 | ||
3844 | scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | |
3845 | scoped_restore_current_language save_language (language_cplus); | |
3846 | ||
3847 | for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces) | |
3848 | { | |
3849 | set_current_program_space (pspace); | |
3850 | ||
3851 | for (objfile *objfile : pspace->objfiles ()) | |
3852 | { | |
3853 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3854 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | |
3855 | ||
3856 | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3857 | ||
3858 | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym)) | |
3859 | continue; | |
3860 | ||
3861 | if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL) | |
3862 | { | |
3863 | bound_minimal_symbol m | |
3864 | = lookup_minimal_symbol (current_program_space, func_name, | |
3865 | objfile); | |
3866 | if (m.minsym == NULL || (m.minsym->type () != mst_text | |
3867 | && m.minsym->type () != mst_file_text)) | |
3868 | { | |
3869 | /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */ | |
3870 | bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | |
3871 | continue; | |
3872 | } | |
3873 | bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m; | |
3874 | } | |
3875 | ||
3876 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), | |
3877 | bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym, | |
3878 | bp_std_terminate_master); | |
3879 | b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | |
3880 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3881 | } | |
3882 | } | |
3883 | } | |
3884 | ||
3885 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a | |
3886 | probe. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */ | |
3887 | ||
3888 | static bool | |
3889 | create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile) | |
3890 | { | |
3891 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3892 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | |
3893 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | |
3894 | ||
3895 | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3896 | ||
3897 | /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */ | |
3898 | if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched) | |
3899 | { | |
3900 | std::vector<probe *> ret | |
3901 | = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind"); | |
3902 | ||
3903 | if (!ret.empty ()) | |
3904 | { | |
3905 | /* We are only interested in checking one element. */ | |
3906 | probe *p = ret[0]; | |
3907 | ||
3908 | if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ()) | |
3909 | { | |
3910 | /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does | |
3911 | not know how to evaluate arguments. */ | |
3912 | ret.clear (); | |
3913 | } | |
3914 | } | |
3915 | bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret; | |
3916 | bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1; | |
3917 | } | |
3918 | ||
3919 | if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ()) | |
3920 | return false; | |
3921 | ||
3922 | gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | |
3923 | ||
3924 | for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes) | |
3925 | { | |
3926 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, | |
3927 | p->get_relocated_address (objfile), | |
3928 | bp_exception_master); | |
3929 | b->locspec = new_probe_location_spec ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind"); | |
3930 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3931 | } | |
3932 | ||
3933 | return true; | |
3934 | } | |
3935 | ||
3936 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using | |
3937 | _Unwind_DebugHook. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */ | |
3938 | ||
3939 | static bool | |
3940 | create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile) | |
3941 | { | |
3942 | const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook"; | |
3943 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
3944 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | |
3945 | struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data; | |
3946 | ||
3947 | bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile); | |
3948 | ||
3949 | if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym)) | |
3950 | return false; | |
3951 | ||
3952 | gdbarch = objfile->arch (); | |
3953 | ||
3954 | if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL) | |
3955 | { | |
3956 | bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook | |
3957 | = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (objfile->pspace (), func_name, objfile); | |
3958 | if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL) | |
3959 | { | |
3960 | bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found; | |
3961 | return false; | |
3962 | } | |
3963 | ||
3964 | bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook; | |
3965 | } | |
3966 | ||
3967 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_objfile_data->exception_msym, | |
3968 | bp_exception_master); | |
3969 | b->locspec = new_explicit_location_spec_function (func_name); | |
3970 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
3971 | ||
3972 | return true; | |
3973 | } | |
3974 | ||
3975 | /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */ | |
3976 | ||
3977 | static void | |
3978 | create_exception_master_breakpoint (void) | |
3979 | { | |
3980 | for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ()) | |
3981 | { | |
3982 | /* Skip separate debug object. */ | |
3983 | if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink) | |
3984 | continue; | |
3985 | ||
3986 | /* Try a probe kind breakpoint. */ | |
3987 | if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (obj)) | |
3988 | continue; | |
3989 | ||
3990 | /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an | |
3991 | _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint. */ | |
3992 | for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ()) | |
3993 | if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile)) | |
3994 | break; | |
3995 | } | |
3996 | } | |
3997 | ||
3998 | /* Does B have a location spec? */ | |
3999 | ||
4000 | static bool | |
4001 | breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b) | |
4002 | { | |
4003 | return (b->locspec != nullptr && b->locspec->empty_p ()); | |
4004 | } | |
4005 | ||
4006 | void | |
4007 | update_breakpoints_after_exec (void) | |
4008 | { | |
4009 | /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the | |
4010 | INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by | |
4011 | writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The | |
4012 | "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not | |
4013 | do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking | |
4014 | breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that | |
4015 | here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete | |
4016 | breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */ | |
4017 | for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
4018 | if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space) | |
4019 | gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted); | |
4020 | ||
4021 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
4022 | { | |
4023 | if (b.pspace != current_program_space) | |
4024 | continue; | |
4025 | ||
4026 | /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */ | |
4027 | if (b.type == bp_shlib_event) | |
4028 | { | |
4029 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4030 | continue; | |
4031 | } | |
4032 | ||
4033 | /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */ | |
4034 | if (b.type == bp_jit_event) | |
4035 | { | |
4036 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4037 | continue; | |
4038 | } | |
4039 | ||
4040 | /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(), | |
4041 | as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */ | |
4042 | if (b.type == bp_thread_event || b.type == bp_overlay_event | |
4043 | || b.type == bp_longjmp_master || b.type == bp_std_terminate_master | |
4044 | || b.type == bp_exception_master) | |
4045 | { | |
4046 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4047 | continue; | |
4048 | } | |
4049 | ||
4050 | /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */ | |
4051 | if (b.type == bp_step_resume || b.type == bp_hp_step_resume) | |
4052 | { | |
4053 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4054 | continue; | |
4055 | } | |
4056 | ||
4057 | /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */ | |
4058 | if (b.type == bp_single_step) | |
4059 | { | |
4060 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4061 | continue; | |
4062 | } | |
4063 | ||
4064 | /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless | |
4065 | after an exec. */ | |
4066 | if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_longjmp_resume | |
4067 | || b.type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy | |
4068 | || b.type == bp_exception || b.type == bp_exception_resume) | |
4069 | { | |
4070 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4071 | continue; | |
4072 | } | |
4073 | ||
4074 | if (b.type == bp_catchpoint) | |
4075 | { | |
4076 | /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to | |
4077 | do anything at this point. In the future, if some of | |
4078 | the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add | |
4079 | a new method, and call this method from here. */ | |
4080 | continue; | |
4081 | } | |
4082 | ||
4083 | /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able | |
4084 | to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user | |
4085 | caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just | |
4086 | carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting | |
4087 | a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish | |
4088 | will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec. | |
4089 | ||
4090 | We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But | |
4091 | we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to | |
4092 | the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a | |
4093 | chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish | |
4094 | here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command | |
4095 | gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint. | |
4096 | We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish. | |
4097 | ||
4098 | In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know | |
4099 | it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?" | |
4100 | problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and | |
4101 | let finish_command delete it. | |
4102 | ||
4103 | (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's | |
4104 | momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees | |
4105 | the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's | |
4106 | address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the | |
4107 | solib breakpoints.) */ | |
4108 | ||
4109 | if (b.type == bp_finish) | |
4110 | { | |
4111 | continue; | |
4112 | } | |
4113 | ||
4114 | /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the | |
4115 | pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec() | |
4116 | a.out. */ | |
4117 | if (breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (&b)) | |
4118 | { | |
4119 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4120 | continue; | |
4121 | } | |
4122 | } | |
4123 | } | |
4124 | ||
4125 | int | |
4126 | detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid) | |
4127 | { | |
4128 | int val = 0; | |
4129 | scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid); | |
4130 | struct inferior *inf = current_inferior (); | |
4131 | ||
4132 | if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ()) | |
4133 | error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid")); | |
4134 | ||
4135 | /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */ | |
4136 | inferior_ptid = ptid; | |
4137 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
4138 | { | |
4139 | if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace) | |
4140 | continue; | |
4141 | ||
4142 | /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations | |
4143 | from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint | |
4144 | package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other and | |
4145 | bp_loc_software_watchpoint are only maintained at GDB side, | |
4146 | so there is no need to remove them. Moreover, removing these | |
4147 | would modify the breakpoint package's state. */ | |
4148 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other | |
4149 | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_watchpoint) | |
4150 | continue; | |
4151 | ||
4152 | if (bl->inserted) | |
4153 | val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | |
4154 | } | |
4155 | ||
4156 | return val; | |
4157 | } | |
4158 | ||
4159 | /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space. | |
4160 | Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork. | |
4161 | When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither | |
4162 | do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should | |
4163 | *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */ | |
4164 | ||
4165 | static int | |
4166 | remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason) | |
4167 | { | |
4168 | breakpoint_debug_printf ("%s due to %s", | |
4169 | breakpoint_location_address_str (bl).c_str (), | |
4170 | remove_bp_reason_str (reason)); | |
4171 | ||
4172 | int val; | |
4173 | ||
4174 | /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */ | |
4175 | gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | |
4176 | ||
4177 | /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | |
4178 | This should not ever happen. */ | |
4179 | gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | |
4180 | ||
4181 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
4182 | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4183 | { | |
4184 | /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard | |
4185 | trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a | |
4186 | bp_hardware_breakpoint. */ | |
4187 | ||
4188 | /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */ | |
4189 | if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off | |
4190 | || bl->section == NULL | |
4191 | || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section))) | |
4192 | { | |
4193 | /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */ | |
4194 | ||
4195 | /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we | |
4196 | know is set in a dynamic object that is marked | |
4197 | shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was | |
4198 | removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with | |
4199 | "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know | |
4200 | whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the | |
4201 | breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know | |
4202 | about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of | |
4203 | add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a | |
4204 | list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the | |
4205 | breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software | |
4206 | breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint | |
4207 | is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong | |
4208 | code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW | |
4209 | breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're | |
4210 | implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on | |
4211 | being able to modify the target's memory, and as such | |
4212 | they should always be removed. */ | |
4213 | if (bl->shlib_disabled | |
4214 | && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0 | |
4215 | && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info)) | |
4216 | val = 0; | |
4217 | else | |
4218 | val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | |
4219 | } | |
4220 | else | |
4221 | { | |
4222 | /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section. | |
4223 | Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */ | |
4224 | if (!overlay_events_enabled) | |
4225 | { | |
4226 | /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we | |
4227 | should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it. | |
4228 | */ | |
4229 | /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will | |
4230 | have already warned when we failed to insert it. */ | |
4231 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4232 | target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | |
4233 | &bl->overlay_target_info); | |
4234 | else | |
4235 | target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, | |
4236 | &bl->overlay_target_info, | |
4237 | reason); | |
4238 | } | |
4239 | /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA? | |
4240 | If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */ | |
4241 | if (bl->inserted) | |
4242 | { | |
4243 | /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to | |
4244 | remove the breakpoint if the section had been | |
4245 | unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We | |
4246 | don't know what the overlay manager might do. */ | |
4247 | ||
4248 | /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only | |
4249 | if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite | |
4250 | wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */ | |
4251 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
4252 | || section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | |
4253 | val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | |
4254 | else | |
4255 | val = 0; | |
4256 | } | |
4257 | else | |
4258 | { | |
4259 | /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */ | |
4260 | val = 0; | |
4261 | } | |
4262 | } | |
4263 | ||
4264 | /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in | |
4265 | a shared library that has already been removed, but we have | |
4266 | not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an | |
4267 | unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have | |
4268 | had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will | |
4269 | be set if the library/object has already been removed, but | |
4270 | the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after | |
4271 | "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints | |
4272 | always-inserted mode. */ | |
4273 | if (val | |
4274 | && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
4275 | && (bl->shlib_disabled | |
4276 | || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address) | |
4277 | || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace, | |
4278 | bl->address)))) | |
4279 | val = 0; | |
4280 | ||
4281 | if (val) | |
4282 | return val; | |
4283 | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | |
4284 | } | |
4285 | else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint) | |
4286 | { | |
4287 | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | |
4288 | bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | |
4289 | ||
4290 | /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */ | |
4291 | if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted) | |
4292 | warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."), | |
4293 | bl->owner->number); | |
4294 | } | |
4295 | else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint | |
4296 | && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | |
4297 | && !bl->duplicate) | |
4298 | { | |
4299 | val = bl->owner->remove_location (bl, reason); | |
4300 | if (val) | |
4301 | return val; | |
4302 | ||
4303 | bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT); | |
4304 | } | |
4305 | ||
4306 | return 0; | |
4307 | } | |
4308 | ||
4309 | static int | |
4310 | remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl) | |
4311 | { | |
4312 | /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */ | |
4313 | gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL); | |
4314 | ||
4315 | /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted. | |
4316 | This should not ever happen. */ | |
4317 | gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none); | |
4318 | ||
4319 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
4320 | ||
4321 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace); | |
4322 | ||
4323 | return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT); | |
4324 | } | |
4325 | ||
4326 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4327 | ||
4328 | void | |
4329 | mark_breakpoints_out (program_space *pspace) | |
4330 | { | |
4331 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
4332 | if (bl->pspace == pspace) | |
4333 | bl->inserted = 0; | |
4334 | } | |
4335 | ||
4336 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4337 | ||
4338 | void | |
4339 | breakpoint_init_inferior (inferior *inf, inf_context context) | |
4340 | { | |
4341 | /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's | |
4342 | nothing to do. */ | |
4343 | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (inf->arch ())) | |
4344 | return; | |
4345 | ||
4346 | mark_breakpoints_out (inf->pspace); | |
4347 | ||
4348 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
4349 | { | |
4350 | if (b.has_locations () && b.first_loc ().pspace != inf->pspace) | |
4351 | continue; | |
4352 | ||
4353 | switch (b.type) | |
4354 | { | |
4355 | case bp_call_dummy: | |
4356 | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | |
4357 | ||
4358 | /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will | |
4359 | cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get | |
4360 | rid of it. */ | |
4361 | ||
4362 | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | |
4363 | ||
4364 | /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */ | |
4365 | ||
4366 | case bp_shlib_event: | |
4367 | ||
4368 | /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may | |
4369 | have changed since the last time we ran the program. | |
4370 | Actually we may now be debugging against different target; | |
4371 | and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may | |
4372 | not be used in by the target. E.g., | |
4373 | ||
4374 | (gdb) file prog-linux | |
4375 | (gdb) run # native linux target | |
4376 | ... | |
4377 | (gdb) kill | |
4378 | (gdb) file prog-win.exe | |
4379 | (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver. | |
4380 | */ | |
4381 | ||
4382 | case bp_step_resume: | |
4383 | ||
4384 | /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */ | |
4385 | ||
4386 | case bp_single_step: | |
4387 | ||
4388 | /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */ | |
4389 | ||
4390 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4391 | break; | |
4392 | ||
4393 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
4394 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
4395 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
4396 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
4397 | { | |
4398 | watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | |
4399 | ||
4400 | /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */ | |
4401 | if (w.exp_valid_block != NULL) | |
4402 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
4403 | else | |
4404 | { | |
4405 | /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer | |
4406 | valid. New ones will be created in | |
4407 | update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted. | |
4408 | The next update_global_location_list call will | |
4409 | garbage collect them. */ | |
4410 | b.clear_locations (); | |
4411 | ||
4412 | if (context == inf_starting) | |
4413 | { | |
4414 | /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in | |
4415 | insert_breakpoints. */ | |
4416 | w.val.reset (nullptr); | |
4417 | w.val_valid = false; | |
4418 | } | |
4419 | } | |
4420 | } | |
4421 | break; | |
4422 | default: | |
4423 | break; | |
4424 | } | |
4425 | } | |
4426 | ||
4427 | /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */ | |
4428 | for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations) | |
4429 | decref_bp_location (&bl); | |
4430 | moribund_locations.clear (); | |
4431 | } | |
4432 | ||
4433 | /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the | |
4434 | target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if | |
4435 | we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space | |
4436 | match, not program space. */ | |
4437 | ||
4438 | /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint | |
4439 | exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an | |
4440 | ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a | |
4441 | permanent breakpoint. | |
4442 | - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we | |
4443 | actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints. | |
4444 | - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we | |
4445 | need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by | |
4446 | the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */ | |
4447 | ||
4448 | enum breakpoint_here | |
4449 | breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4450 | { | |
4451 | bool any_breakpoint_here = false; | |
4452 | ||
4453 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
4454 | { | |
4455 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
4456 | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4457 | continue; | |
4458 | ||
4459 | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */ | |
4460 | if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | |
4461 | || bl->permanent) | |
4462 | && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc)) | |
4463 | { | |
4464 | if (overlay_debugging | |
4465 | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | |
4466 | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | |
4467 | continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */ | |
4468 | else if (bl->permanent) | |
4469 | return permanent_breakpoint_here; | |
4470 | else | |
4471 | any_breakpoint_here = true; | |
4472 | } | |
4473 | } | |
4474 | ||
4475 | return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here; | |
4476 | } | |
4477 | ||
4478 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4479 | ||
4480 | int | |
4481 | breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace, | |
4482 | CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | |
4483 | { | |
4484 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
4485 | { | |
4486 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
4487 | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4488 | continue; | |
4489 | ||
4490 | if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner) | |
4491 | || bl->permanent) | |
4492 | && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace, | |
4493 | addr, len)) | |
4494 | { | |
4495 | if (overlay_debugging | |
4496 | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | |
4497 | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | |
4498 | { | |
4499 | /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */ | |
4500 | continue; | |
4501 | } | |
4502 | ||
4503 | return 1; | |
4504 | } | |
4505 | } | |
4506 | ||
4507 | return 0; | |
4508 | } | |
4509 | ||
4510 | /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */ | |
4511 | ||
4512 | int | |
4513 | moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4514 | { | |
4515 | for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) | |
4516 | if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc)) | |
4517 | return 1; | |
4518 | ||
4519 | return 0; | |
4520 | } | |
4521 | ||
4522 | /* Returns true iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space ASPACE. */ | |
4523 | ||
4524 | static bool | |
4525 | bp_location_inserted_here_p (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
4526 | const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4527 | { | |
4528 | if (bl->inserted | |
4529 | && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | |
4530 | aspace, pc)) | |
4531 | { | |
4532 | /* An unmapped overlay can't be a match. */ | |
4533 | return !(overlay_debugging | |
4534 | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | |
4535 | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)); | |
4536 | } | |
4537 | return false; | |
4538 | } | |
4539 | ||
4540 | /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */ | |
4541 | ||
4542 | int | |
4543 | breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4544 | { | |
4545 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | |
4546 | { | |
4547 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
4548 | && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4549 | continue; | |
4550 | ||
4551 | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | |
4552 | return 1; | |
4553 | } | |
4554 | return 0; | |
4555 | } | |
4556 | ||
4557 | /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint | |
4558 | inserted at PC. */ | |
4559 | ||
4560 | int | |
4561 | software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | |
4562 | CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4563 | { | |
4564 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | |
4565 | { | |
4566 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | |
4567 | continue; | |
4568 | ||
4569 | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | |
4570 | return 1; | |
4571 | } | |
4572 | ||
4573 | return 0; | |
4574 | } | |
4575 | ||
4576 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4577 | ||
4578 | int | |
4579 | hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | |
4580 | CORE_ADDR pc) | |
4581 | { | |
4582 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc)) | |
4583 | { | |
4584 | if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
4585 | continue; | |
4586 | ||
4587 | if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc)) | |
4588 | return 1; | |
4589 | } | |
4590 | ||
4591 | return 0; | |
4592 | } | |
4593 | ||
4594 | int | |
4595 | hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace, | |
4596 | CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len) | |
4597 | { | |
4598 | for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | |
4599 | { | |
4600 | if (bpt.type != bp_hardware_watchpoint | |
4601 | && bpt.type != bp_access_watchpoint) | |
4602 | continue; | |
4603 | ||
4604 | if (!breakpoint_enabled (&bpt)) | |
4605 | continue; | |
4606 | ||
4607 | for (bp_location &loc : bpt.locations ()) | |
4608 | if (loc.pspace->aspace.get () == aspace && loc.inserted) | |
4609 | { | |
4610 | CORE_ADDR l, h; | |
4611 | ||
4612 | /* Check for intersection. */ | |
4613 | l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc.address, addr); | |
4614 | h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc.address + loc.length, addr + len); | |
4615 | if (l < h) | |
4616 | return 1; | |
4617 | } | |
4618 | } | |
4619 | return 0; | |
4620 | } | |
4621 | ||
4622 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4623 | ||
4624 | bool | |
4625 | is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b) | |
4626 | { | |
4627 | return (b->type == bp_catchpoint); | |
4628 | } | |
4629 | ||
4630 | /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint. | |
4631 | Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */ | |
4632 | ||
4633 | void | |
4634 | bpstat_clear (bpstat **bsp) | |
4635 | { | |
4636 | bpstat *p; | |
4637 | bpstat *q; | |
4638 | ||
4639 | if (bsp == 0) | |
4640 | return; | |
4641 | p = *bsp; | |
4642 | while (p != NULL) | |
4643 | { | |
4644 | q = p->next; | |
4645 | delete p; | |
4646 | p = q; | |
4647 | } | |
4648 | *bsp = NULL; | |
4649 | } | |
4650 | ||
4651 | bpstat::bpstat (const bpstat &other) | |
4652 | : next (NULL), | |
4653 | bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at), | |
4654 | breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at), | |
4655 | commands (other.commands), | |
4656 | print (other.print), | |
4657 | stop (other.stop), | |
4658 | print_it (other.print_it) | |
4659 | { | |
4660 | if (other.old_val != NULL) | |
4661 | old_val = release_value (other.old_val->copy ()); | |
4662 | } | |
4663 | ||
4664 | /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that | |
4665 | is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */ | |
4666 | ||
4667 | bpstat * | |
4668 | bpstat_copy (bpstat *bs) | |
4669 | { | |
4670 | bpstat *p = nullptr; | |
4671 | bpstat *tmp; | |
4672 | bpstat *retval = nullptr; | |
4673 | ||
4674 | if (bs == NULL) | |
4675 | return bs; | |
4676 | ||
4677 | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
4678 | { | |
4679 | tmp = new bpstat (*bs); | |
4680 | ||
4681 | if (p == NULL) | |
4682 | /* This is the first thing in the chain. */ | |
4683 | retval = tmp; | |
4684 | else | |
4685 | p->next = tmp; | |
4686 | p = tmp; | |
4687 | } | |
4688 | p->next = NULL; | |
4689 | return retval; | |
4690 | } | |
4691 | ||
4692 | /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */ | |
4693 | ||
4694 | bpstat * | |
4695 | bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat *bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint) | |
4696 | { | |
4697 | if (bsp == NULL) | |
4698 | return NULL; | |
4699 | ||
4700 | for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | |
4701 | { | |
4702 | if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint) | |
4703 | return bsp; | |
4704 | } | |
4705 | return NULL; | |
4706 | } | |
4707 | ||
4708 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4709 | ||
4710 | bool | |
4711 | bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat *bsp, enum gdb_signal sig) | |
4712 | { | |
4713 | for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next) | |
4714 | { | |
4715 | if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL) | |
4716 | { | |
4717 | /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than | |
4718 | GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */ | |
4719 | if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | |
4720 | return true; | |
4721 | } | |
4722 | else | |
4723 | { | |
4724 | if (bsp->breakpoint_at->explains_signal (sig)) | |
4725 | return true; | |
4726 | } | |
4727 | } | |
4728 | ||
4729 | return false; | |
4730 | } | |
4731 | ||
4732 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4733 | ||
4734 | int | |
4735 | bpstat_num (bpstat **bsp, int *num) | |
4736 | { | |
4737 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
4738 | ||
4739 | if ((*bsp) == NULL) | |
4740 | return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */ | |
4741 | ||
4742 | /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a | |
4743 | single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the | |
4744 | same number more than once and this will look ugly. */ | |
4745 | b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at; | |
4746 | *bsp = (*bsp)->next; | |
4747 | if (b == NULL) | |
4748 | return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */ | |
4749 | ||
4750 | *num = b->number; /* We have its number */ | |
4751 | return 1; | |
4752 | } | |
4753 | ||
4754 | /* See breakpoint.h */ | |
4755 | ||
4756 | int | |
4757 | bpstat_locno (const bpstat *bs) | |
4758 | { | |
4759 | const struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
4760 | const struct bp_location *bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | |
4761 | ||
4762 | if (b != nullptr && b->has_multiple_locations ()) | |
4763 | { | |
4764 | int locno = 1; | |
4765 | ||
4766 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
4767 | { | |
4768 | if (bl == &loc) | |
4769 | return locno; | |
4770 | ||
4771 | ++locno; | |
4772 | } | |
4773 | ||
4774 | warning (_("location number not found for breakpoint %d address %s."), | |
4775 | b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address)); | |
4776 | } | |
4777 | ||
4778 | return 0; | |
4779 | } | |
4780 | ||
4781 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4782 | ||
4783 | void | |
4784 | print_num_locno (const bpstat *bs, struct ui_out *uiout) | |
4785 | { | |
4786 | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
4787 | ||
4788 | if (b == nullptr) | |
4789 | uiout->text (_("deleted breakpoint")); | |
4790 | else | |
4791 | { | |
4792 | uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number); | |
4793 | ||
4794 | int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | |
4795 | if (locno != 0) | |
4796 | uiout->message (".%pF", signed_field ("locno", locno)); | |
4797 | } | |
4798 | } | |
4799 | ||
4800 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
4801 | ||
4802 | void | |
4803 | bpstat_clear_actions (void) | |
4804 | { | |
4805 | bpstat *bs; | |
4806 | ||
4807 | if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid) | |
4808 | return; | |
4809 | ||
4810 | thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | |
4811 | for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
4812 | { | |
4813 | bs->commands = NULL; | |
4814 | bs->old_val.reset (nullptr); | |
4815 | } | |
4816 | } | |
4817 | ||
4818 | /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */ | |
4819 | ||
4820 | static void | |
4821 | breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void) | |
4822 | { | |
4823 | if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid) | |
4824 | { | |
4825 | struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | |
4826 | ||
4827 | /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not | |
4828 | interrupt the command list. When the call finishes | |
4829 | successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same | |
4830 | breakpoint as if nothing happened. */ | |
4831 | if (tp->control.in_infcall) | |
4832 | return; | |
4833 | } | |
4834 | ||
4835 | breakpoint_proceeded = 1; | |
4836 | } | |
4837 | ||
4838 | /* Return true iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent' | |
4839 | or its equivalent. */ | |
4840 | ||
4841 | static bool | |
4842 | command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd) | |
4843 | { | |
4844 | return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0); | |
4845 | } | |
4846 | ||
4847 | /* Sets the $_hit_bpnum and $_hit_locno to bpnum and locno. | |
4848 | A locno 0 is changed to 1 to e.g. let the user do | |
4849 | (gdb) disable $_hit_bpnum.$_hit_locno | |
4850 | for a single location breakpoint. */ | |
4851 | ||
4852 | static void | |
4853 | set_hit_convenience_vars (int bpnum, int locno) | |
4854 | { | |
4855 | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("_hit_bpnum"), bpnum); | |
4856 | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("_hit_locno"), | |
4857 | (locno > 0 ? locno : 1)); | |
4858 | } | |
4859 | ||
4860 | /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at | |
4861 | this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to | |
4862 | proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by | |
4863 | checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command. | |
4864 | ||
4865 | Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that | |
4866 | case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the | |
4867 | bpstat of the current thread. */ | |
4868 | ||
4869 | static bool | |
4870 | bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat **bsp) | |
4871 | { | |
4872 | bpstat *bs; | |
4873 | bool again = false; | |
4874 | ||
4875 | /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained | |
4876 | in bs->commands. */ | |
4877 | if (executing_breakpoint_commands) | |
4878 | return false; | |
4879 | ||
4880 | scoped_restore save_executing | |
4881 | = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1); | |
4882 | ||
4883 | scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat (); | |
4884 | ||
4885 | /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */ | |
4886 | bs = *bsp; | |
4887 | ||
4888 | /* The $_hit_* convenience variables are set before running the | |
4889 | commands of BS. In case we have several bs, after the loop, | |
4890 | we set again the variables to the first printed bpnum and locno. | |
4891 | For multiple breakpoints, this ensures the variables are set to the | |
4892 | breakpoint printed for the user. */ | |
4893 | int printed_hit_bpnum = -1; | |
4894 | int printed_hit_locno = -1; | |
4895 | ||
4896 | breakpoint_proceeded = 0; | |
4897 | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
4898 | { | |
4899 | struct command_line *cmd = NULL; | |
4900 | ||
4901 | /* Set the _hit_* convenience variables before running BS's commands. */ | |
4902 | { | |
4903 | const struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
4904 | if (b != nullptr) | |
4905 | { | |
4906 | int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | |
4907 | ||
4908 | set_hit_convenience_vars (b->number, locno); | |
4909 | if (printed_hit_locno == -1 && bs->print) | |
4910 | { | |
4911 | printed_hit_bpnum = b->number; | |
4912 | printed_hit_locno = locno; | |
4913 | } | |
4914 | } | |
4915 | } | |
4916 | ||
4917 | /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one. | |
4918 | ||
4919 | The command tree could legitimately contain commands like | |
4920 | 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which | |
4921 | frees the bpstat BS and its command tree. To make sure this doesn't | |
4922 | free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to | |
4923 | take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's | |
4924 | commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we | |
4925 | can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free | |
4926 | the tree when we're done. */ | |
4927 | counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands; | |
4928 | bs->commands = NULL; | |
4929 | if (ccmd != NULL) | |
4930 | cmd = ccmd.get (); | |
4931 | if (command_line_is_silent (cmd)) | |
4932 | { | |
4933 | /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */ | |
4934 | cmd = cmd->next; | |
4935 | } | |
4936 | ||
4937 | while (cmd != NULL) | |
4938 | { | |
4939 | execute_control_command (cmd); | |
4940 | /* After execute_control_command, if breakpoint_proceeded is true, | |
4941 | BS has been freed and cannot be accessed anymore. */ | |
4942 | ||
4943 | if (breakpoint_proceeded) | |
4944 | break; | |
4945 | else | |
4946 | cmd = cmd->next; | |
4947 | } | |
4948 | ||
4949 | if (breakpoint_proceeded) | |
4950 | { | |
4951 | if (current_ui->async) | |
4952 | /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still | |
4953 | running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for | |
4954 | us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */ | |
4955 | ; | |
4956 | else | |
4957 | /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns | |
4958 | we're already standing on the next breakpoint. | |
4959 | Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since | |
4960 | execute_command does not run breakpoint commands -- | |
4961 | only command_line_handler does, but that one is not | |
4962 | involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we | |
4963 | can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be | |
4964 | noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is | |
4965 | not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive | |
4966 | invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a | |
4967 | command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we | |
4968 | return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us | |
4969 | with the new stop_bpstat. */ | |
4970 | again = true; | |
4971 | break; | |
4972 | } | |
4973 | } | |
4974 | ||
4975 | /* Now that we have executed the commands of all bs, set the _hit_* | |
4976 | convenience variables to the printed values. */ | |
4977 | if (printed_hit_locno != -1) | |
4978 | set_hit_convenience_vars (printed_hit_bpnum, printed_hit_locno); | |
4979 | ||
4980 | return again; | |
4981 | } | |
4982 | ||
4983 | /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's | |
4984 | one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */ | |
4985 | ||
4986 | static thread_info * | |
4987 | get_bpstat_thread () | |
4988 | { | |
4989 | if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()) | |
4990 | return NULL; | |
4991 | ||
4992 | thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | |
4993 | if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing ()) | |
4994 | return NULL; | |
4995 | return tp; | |
4996 | } | |
4997 | ||
4998 | void | |
4999 | bpstat_do_actions (void) | |
5000 | { | |
5001 | auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions); | |
5002 | thread_info *tp; | |
5003 | ||
5004 | /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */ | |
5005 | while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL) | |
5006 | { | |
5007 | /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the | |
5008 | inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next | |
5009 | breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns | |
5010 | false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */ | |
5011 | if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat)) | |
5012 | break; | |
5013 | } | |
5014 | ||
5015 | cleanup_if_error.release (); | |
5016 | } | |
5017 | ||
5018 | /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */ | |
5019 | ||
5020 | static void | |
5021 | watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream) | |
5022 | { | |
5023 | if (val == NULL) | |
5024 | fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>")); | |
5025 | else | |
5026 | { | |
5027 | struct value_print_options opts; | |
5028 | get_user_print_options (&opts); | |
5029 | value_print (val, stream, &opts); | |
5030 | } | |
5031 | } | |
5032 | ||
5033 | /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if | |
5034 | debugging multiple threads. */ | |
5035 | ||
5036 | void | |
5037 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout) | |
5038 | { | |
5039 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
5040 | return; | |
5041 | ||
5042 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
5043 | ||
5044 | if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ()) | |
5045 | { | |
5046 | struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread (); | |
5047 | ||
5048 | uiout->text ("Thread "); | |
5049 | uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr)); | |
5050 | ||
5051 | const char *name = thread_name (thr); | |
5052 | if (name != NULL) | |
5053 | { | |
5054 | uiout->text (" \""); | |
5055 | uiout->field_string ("name", name); | |
5056 | uiout->text ("\""); | |
5057 | } | |
5058 | ||
5059 | uiout->text (" hit "); | |
5060 | } | |
5061 | } | |
5062 | ||
5063 | /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we | |
5064 | stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value | |
5065 | 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we | |
5066 | may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to | |
5067 | normal_stop(). */ | |
5068 | ||
5069 | static enum print_stop_action | |
5070 | print_bp_stop_message (bpstat *bs) | |
5071 | { | |
5072 | switch (bs->print_it) | |
5073 | { | |
5074 | case print_it_noop: | |
5075 | /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */ | |
5076 | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
5077 | ||
5078 | case print_it_done: | |
5079 | /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the | |
5080 | relevant messages. */ | |
5081 | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | |
5082 | ||
5083 | case print_it_normal: | |
5084 | { | |
5085 | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
5086 | ||
5087 | /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint | |
5088 | which has since been deleted. */ | |
5089 | if (b == NULL) | |
5090 | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
5091 | ||
5092 | /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */ | |
5093 | return b->print_it (bs); | |
5094 | } | |
5095 | ||
5096 | default: | |
5097 | internal_error (_("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value")); | |
5098 | } | |
5099 | } | |
5100 | ||
5101 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
5102 | ||
5103 | void | |
5104 | print_solib_event (bool is_catchpoint) | |
5105 | { | |
5106 | bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty (); | |
5107 | bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty (); | |
5108 | ||
5109 | if (!is_catchpoint) | |
5110 | { | |
5111 | if (any_added || any_deleted) | |
5112 | current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n")); | |
5113 | else | |
5114 | current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no " | |
5115 | "libraries added or removed)\n")); | |
5116 | } | |
5117 | ||
5118 | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
5119 | current_uiout->field_string ("reason", | |
5120 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT)); | |
5121 | ||
5122 | if (any_deleted) | |
5123 | { | |
5124 | current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded ")); | |
5125 | ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed"); | |
5126 | for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++) | |
5127 | { | |
5128 | const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix]; | |
5129 | ||
5130 | if (ix > 0) | |
5131 | current_uiout->text (" "); | |
5132 | current_uiout->field_string ("library", name); | |
5133 | current_uiout->text ("\n"); | |
5134 | } | |
5135 | } | |
5136 | ||
5137 | if (any_added) | |
5138 | { | |
5139 | current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded ")); | |
5140 | ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added"); | |
5141 | bool first = true; | |
5142 | for (solib *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs) | |
5143 | { | |
5144 | if (!first) | |
5145 | current_uiout->text (" "); | |
5146 | first = false; | |
5147 | current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->name); | |
5148 | current_uiout->text ("\n"); | |
5149 | } | |
5150 | } | |
5151 | } | |
5152 | ||
5153 | /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from | |
5154 | normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat | |
5155 | list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is | |
5156 | the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This | |
5157 | routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message | |
5158 | about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the | |
5159 | "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this | |
5160 | routine is one of: | |
5161 | ||
5162 | PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing. | |
5163 | PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent | |
5164 | code to print the location. An example is | |
5165 | "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by | |
5166 | the location. | |
5167 | PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need | |
5168 | to also print the location part of the message. | |
5169 | An example is the catch/throw messages, which | |
5170 | don't require a location appended to the end. | |
5171 | PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any | |
5172 | further info to be printed. */ | |
5173 | ||
5174 | enum print_stop_action | |
5175 | bpstat_print (bpstat *bs, target_waitkind kind) | |
5176 | { | |
5177 | enum print_stop_action val; | |
5178 | ||
5179 | /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop. | |
5180 | (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not. | |
5181 | That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken | |
5182 | with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */ | |
5183 | for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | |
5184 | { | |
5185 | val = print_bp_stop_message (bs); | |
5186 | if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY | |
5187 | || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC | |
5188 | || val == PRINT_NOTHING) | |
5189 | return val; | |
5190 | } | |
5191 | ||
5192 | /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint, | |
5193 | print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an | |
5194 | OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */ | |
5195 | if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED) | |
5196 | { | |
5197 | print_solib_event (false); | |
5198 | return PRINT_NOTHING; | |
5199 | } | |
5200 | ||
5201 | /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start | |
5202 | with and nothing was printed. */ | |
5203 | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
5204 | } | |
5205 | ||
5206 | /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */ | |
5207 | ||
5208 | static bool | |
5209 | breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp) | |
5210 | { | |
5211 | scoped_value_mark mark; | |
5212 | return value_true (exp->evaluate ()); | |
5213 | } | |
5214 | ||
5215 | /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */ | |
5216 | ||
5217 | bpstat::bpstat (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat ***bs_link_pointer) | |
5218 | : next (NULL), | |
5219 | bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)), | |
5220 | breakpoint_at (bl->owner), | |
5221 | commands (NULL), | |
5222 | print (0), | |
5223 | stop (0), | |
5224 | print_it (print_it_normal) | |
5225 | { | |
5226 | **bs_link_pointer = this; | |
5227 | *bs_link_pointer = &next; | |
5228 | } | |
5229 | ||
5230 | bpstat::bpstat () | |
5231 | : next (NULL), | |
5232 | breakpoint_at (NULL), | |
5233 | commands (NULL), | |
5234 | print (0), | |
5235 | stop (0), | |
5236 | print_it (print_it_normal) | |
5237 | { | |
5238 | } | |
5239 | \f | |
5240 | /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware | |
5241 | watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */ | |
5242 | ||
5243 | int | |
5244 | watchpoints_triggered (const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
5245 | { | |
5246 | bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint (); | |
5247 | CORE_ADDR addr; | |
5248 | ||
5249 | if (!stopped_by_watchpoint) | |
5250 | { | |
5251 | /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints | |
5252 | as not triggered. */ | |
5253 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
5254 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | |
5255 | { | |
5256 | watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | |
5257 | ||
5258 | w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | |
5259 | } | |
5260 | ||
5261 | return 0; | |
5262 | } | |
5263 | ||
5264 | if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr)) | |
5265 | { | |
5266 | /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where. | |
5267 | Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */ | |
5268 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
5269 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | |
5270 | { | |
5271 | watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | |
5272 | ||
5273 | w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown; | |
5274 | } | |
5275 | ||
5276 | return 1; | |
5277 | } | |
5278 | ||
5279 | /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints | |
5280 | affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not | |
5281 | triggered. */ | |
5282 | ||
5283 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
5284 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | |
5285 | { | |
5286 | watchpoint &w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (b); | |
5287 | ||
5288 | w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no; | |
5289 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
5290 | { | |
5291 | if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b)) | |
5292 | { | |
5293 | CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w.hw_wp_mask; | |
5294 | CORE_ADDR start = loc.address & w.hw_wp_mask; | |
5295 | ||
5296 | if (newaddr == start) | |
5297 | { | |
5298 | w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | |
5299 | break; | |
5300 | } | |
5301 | } | |
5302 | /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */ | |
5303 | else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range | |
5304 | (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc.address, | |
5305 | loc.length)) | |
5306 | { | |
5307 | w.watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | |
5308 | break; | |
5309 | } | |
5310 | } | |
5311 | } | |
5312 | ||
5313 | return 1; | |
5314 | } | |
5315 | ||
5316 | /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */ | |
5317 | enum wp_check_result | |
5318 | { | |
5319 | /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */ | |
5320 | WP_DELETED = 1, | |
5321 | ||
5322 | /* The value has changed. */ | |
5323 | WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2, | |
5324 | ||
5325 | /* The value has not changed. */ | |
5326 | WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3, | |
5327 | ||
5328 | /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */ | |
5329 | WP_IGNORE = 4, | |
5330 | }; | |
5331 | ||
5332 | #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1 | |
5333 | #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2 | |
5334 | ||
5335 | /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value | |
5336 | changed. */ | |
5337 | ||
5338 | static wp_check_result | |
5339 | watchpoint_check (bpstat *bs) | |
5340 | { | |
5341 | frame_info_ptr fr; | |
5342 | bool within_current_scope; | |
5343 | ||
5344 | /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */ | |
5345 | gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL); | |
5346 | watchpoint *b = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | |
5347 | ||
5348 | /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the | |
5349 | watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread | |
5350 | that was used to create the watchpoint. */ | |
5351 | if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b)) | |
5352 | return WP_IGNORE; | |
5353 | ||
5354 | if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL) | |
5355 | within_current_scope = true; | |
5356 | else | |
5357 | { | |
5358 | frame_info_ptr frame = get_current_frame (); | |
5359 | struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame); | |
5360 | CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame); | |
5361 | ||
5362 | /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're | |
5363 | still in the function but the stack frame has already been | |
5364 | invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local | |
5365 | variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating | |
5366 | the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further | |
5367 | checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current | |
5368 | frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other | |
5369 | frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and | |
5370 | frame_find_by_id could error out. */ | |
5371 | if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc)) | |
5372 | return WP_IGNORE; | |
5373 | ||
5374 | fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame); | |
5375 | within_current_scope = (fr != NULL); | |
5376 | ||
5377 | /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have | |
5378 | returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */ | |
5379 | if (within_current_scope) | |
5380 | { | |
5381 | struct symbol *function; | |
5382 | ||
5383 | function = get_frame_function (fr); | |
5384 | if (function == NULL | |
5385 | || !function->value_block ()->contains (b->exp_valid_block)) | |
5386 | within_current_scope = false; | |
5387 | } | |
5388 | ||
5389 | if (within_current_scope) | |
5390 | /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected | |
5391 | in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect | |
5392 | the user. */ | |
5393 | select_frame (fr); | |
5394 | } | |
5395 | ||
5396 | if (within_current_scope) | |
5397 | { | |
5398 | /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long* | |
5399 | time before we return to the command level and call | |
5400 | free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we | |
5401 | might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */ | |
5402 | ||
5403 | struct value *mark; | |
5404 | struct value *new_val; | |
5405 | ||
5406 | if (is_masked_watchpoint (b)) | |
5407 | /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from | |
5408 | stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered | |
5409 | a mask watchpoint. */ | |
5410 | return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | |
5411 | ||
5412 | mark = value_mark (); | |
5413 | fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val, | |
5414 | NULL, NULL, false); | |
5415 | ||
5416 | if (b->val_bitsize != 0) | |
5417 | new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val); | |
5418 | ||
5419 | /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because | |
5420 | the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just | |
5421 | the address of the array instead of its contents. This is | |
5422 | not what we want. */ | |
5423 | if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL) | |
5424 | || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (), | |
5425 | new_val))) | |
5426 | { | |
5427 | bs->old_val = b->val; | |
5428 | b->val = release_value (new_val); | |
5429 | b->val_valid = true; | |
5430 | if (new_val != NULL) | |
5431 | value_free_to_mark (mark); | |
5432 | return WP_VALUE_CHANGED; | |
5433 | } | |
5434 | else | |
5435 | { | |
5436 | /* Nothing changed. */ | |
5437 | value_free_to_mark (mark); | |
5438 | return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED; | |
5439 | } | |
5440 | } | |
5441 | else | |
5442 | { | |
5443 | /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because | |
5444 | if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when | |
5445 | we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains | |
5446 | garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two | |
5447 | garbage values, one before and one after the prologue). | |
5448 | So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and | |
5449 | watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal | |
5450 | the first value assigned). */ | |
5451 | /* We print all the stop information in | |
5452 | breakpointprint_it, but in this case, by the time we | |
5453 | call breakpoint->print_it this bp will be deleted | |
5454 | already. So we have no choice but print the information | |
5455 | here. */ | |
5456 | ||
5457 | SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | |
5458 | { | |
5459 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
5460 | ||
5461 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
5462 | uiout->field_string | |
5463 | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE)); | |
5464 | uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has " | |
5465 | "left the block in\n" | |
5466 | "which its expression is valid.\n", | |
5467 | signed_field ("wpnum", b->number)); | |
5468 | } | |
5469 | ||
5470 | /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */ | |
5471 | b->commands = NULL; | |
5472 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | |
5473 | ||
5474 | return WP_DELETED; | |
5475 | } | |
5476 | } | |
5477 | ||
5478 | /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting | |
5479 | breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should | |
5480 | stop, only if BL explains the stop. */ | |
5481 | ||
5482 | static bool | |
5483 | bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
5484 | const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
5485 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
5486 | { | |
5487 | struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | |
5488 | ||
5489 | /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */ | |
5490 | gdb_assert (b != NULL); | |
5491 | ||
5492 | return b->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | |
5493 | } | |
5494 | ||
5495 | /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we | |
5496 | should stop. If not, set BS->stop to false. */ | |
5497 | ||
5498 | static void | |
5499 | bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat *bs) | |
5500 | { | |
5501 | const struct bp_location *bl; | |
5502 | ||
5503 | /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */ | |
5504 | bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | |
5505 | gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | |
5506 | watchpoint *b = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | |
5507 | ||
5508 | bool must_check_value = false; | |
5509 | ||
5510 | if (b->type == bp_watchpoint) | |
5511 | /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the | |
5512 | watched value. */ | |
5513 | must_check_value = true; | |
5514 | else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes) | |
5515 | /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access) | |
5516 | and the target earlier reported an address watched by | |
5517 | this watchpoint. */ | |
5518 | must_check_value = true; | |
5519 | else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown | |
5520 | && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | |
5521 | /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could | |
5522 | not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's | |
5523 | value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without | |
5524 | a data address, we can't figure it out. */ | |
5525 | must_check_value = true; | |
5526 | ||
5527 | if (must_check_value) | |
5528 | { | |
5529 | wp_check_result e; | |
5530 | ||
5531 | try | |
5532 | { | |
5533 | e = watchpoint_check (bs); | |
5534 | } | |
5535 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | |
5536 | { | |
5537 | exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | |
5538 | "Error evaluating expression " | |
5539 | "for watchpoint %d\n", | |
5540 | b->number); | |
5541 | ||
5542 | SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS () | |
5543 | { | |
5544 | gdb_printf (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), | |
5545 | b->number); | |
5546 | } | |
5547 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b); | |
5548 | e = WP_DELETED; | |
5549 | } | |
5550 | ||
5551 | switch (e) | |
5552 | { | |
5553 | case WP_DELETED: | |
5554 | /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */ | |
5555 | bs->print_it = print_it_done; | |
5556 | /* Stop. */ | |
5557 | break; | |
5558 | case WP_IGNORE: | |
5559 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5560 | bs->stop = false; | |
5561 | break; | |
5562 | case WP_VALUE_CHANGED: | |
5563 | if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | |
5564 | { | |
5565 | /* There are two cases to consider here: | |
5566 | ||
5567 | 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads. | |
5568 | In that case, trust the target, and always report | |
5569 | the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though | |
5570 | reads don't cause value changes, the value may | |
5571 | have changed since the last time it was read, and | |
5572 | since we're not trapping writes, we will not see | |
5573 | those, and as such we should ignore our notion of | |
5574 | old value. | |
5575 | ||
5576 | 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both | |
5577 | reads and writes. There are two ways this may | |
5578 | happen: | |
5579 | ||
5580 | 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data | |
5581 | reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or | |
5582 | writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case | |
5583 | at the time we try to insert read watchpoints. | |
5584 | ||
5585 | 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read | |
5586 | watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write | |
5587 | watchpoint watching the same memory as this read | |
5588 | watchpoint. | |
5589 | ||
5590 | If we're watching memory writes as well as reads, | |
5591 | ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the | |
5592 | value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause | |
5593 | changes. This still gives false positives when | |
5594 | the program writes the same value to memory as | |
5595 | what there was already in memory (we will confuse | |
5596 | it for a read), but it's much better than | |
5597 | nothing. */ | |
5598 | ||
5599 | int other_write_watchpoint = 0; | |
5600 | ||
5601 | if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read) | |
5602 | { | |
5603 | for (breakpoint &other_b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
5604 | if (other_b.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | |
5605 | || other_b.type == bp_access_watchpoint) | |
5606 | { | |
5607 | watchpoint &other_w = | |
5608 | gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (other_b); | |
5609 | ||
5610 | if (other_w.watchpoint_triggered | |
5611 | == watch_triggered_yes) | |
5612 | { | |
5613 | other_write_watchpoint = 1; | |
5614 | break; | |
5615 | } | |
5616 | } | |
5617 | } | |
5618 | ||
5619 | if (other_write_watchpoint | |
5620 | || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access) | |
5621 | { | |
5622 | /* We're watching the same memory for writes, | |
5623 | and the value changed since the last time we | |
5624 | updated it, so this trap must be for a write. | |
5625 | Ignore it. */ | |
5626 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5627 | bs->stop = false; | |
5628 | } | |
5629 | } | |
5630 | break; | |
5631 | case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED: | |
5632 | if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint | |
5633 | || b->type == bp_watchpoint) | |
5634 | { | |
5635 | /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if | |
5636 | the value hasn't changed. */ | |
5637 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5638 | bs->stop = false; | |
5639 | } | |
5640 | /* Stop. */ | |
5641 | break; | |
5642 | default: | |
5643 | /* Can't happen. */ | |
5644 | break; | |
5645 | } | |
5646 | } | |
5647 | else /* !must_check_value */ | |
5648 | { | |
5649 | /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but | |
5650 | not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no | |
5651 | watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print | |
5652 | anything for this watchpoint. */ | |
5653 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5654 | bs->stop = false; | |
5655 | } | |
5656 | } | |
5657 | ||
5658 | /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop, | |
5659 | check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count) | |
5660 | of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this | |
5661 | breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */ | |
5662 | ||
5663 | static void | |
5664 | bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat *bs, thread_info *thread) | |
5665 | { | |
5666 | INFRUN_SCOPED_DEBUG_ENTER_EXIT; | |
5667 | ||
5668 | const struct bp_location *bl; | |
5669 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
5670 | /* Assume stop. */ | |
5671 | bool condition_result = true; | |
5672 | struct expression *cond; | |
5673 | ||
5674 | gdb_assert (bs->stop); | |
5675 | ||
5676 | /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */ | |
5677 | bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | |
5678 | gdb_assert (bl != NULL); | |
5679 | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
5680 | gdb_assert (b != NULL); | |
5681 | ||
5682 | infrun_debug_printf ("thread = %s, breakpoint %d.%d", | |
5683 | thread->ptid.to_string ().c_str (), | |
5684 | b->number, find_loc_num_by_location (bl)); | |
5685 | ||
5686 | /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we | |
5687 | need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a | |
5688 | breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */ | |
5689 | ||
5690 | if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id) | |
5691 | && b->frame_id != get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())) | |
5692 | { | |
5693 | infrun_debug_printf ("incorrect frame %s not %s, not stopping", | |
5694 | get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ()).to_string ().c_str (), | |
5695 | b->frame_id.to_string ().c_str ()); | |
5696 | bs->stop = false; | |
5697 | return; | |
5698 | } | |
5699 | ||
5700 | /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu | |
5701 | evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified | |
5702 | thread/task. */ | |
5703 | if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num) | |
5704 | || (b->inferior != -1 && b->inferior != thread->inf->num) | |
5705 | || (b->task != -1 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread))) | |
5706 | { | |
5707 | infrun_debug_printf ("incorrect thread or task, not stopping"); | |
5708 | bs->stop = false; | |
5709 | return; | |
5710 | } | |
5711 | ||
5712 | /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method | |
5713 | implemented. */ | |
5714 | bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b); | |
5715 | ||
5716 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
5717 | { | |
5718 | watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | |
5719 | ||
5720 | cond = w->cond_exp.get (); | |
5721 | } | |
5722 | else | |
5723 | cond = bl->cond.get (); | |
5724 | ||
5725 | if (cond != nullptr && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
5726 | { | |
5727 | bool within_current_scope = true; | |
5728 | ||
5729 | /* We use scoped_value_mark because it could be a long time | |
5730 | before we return to the command level and call | |
5731 | free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we | |
5732 | might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */ | |
5733 | scoped_value_mark mark; | |
5734 | ||
5735 | watchpoint *w = nullptr; | |
5736 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
5737 | w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | |
5738 | ||
5739 | /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that | |
5740 | the conditions will have the right context. Because we | |
5741 | use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's | |
5742 | variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start | |
5743 | of the inlined function; the current frame will be the | |
5744 | call site. */ | |
5745 | if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL) | |
5746 | select_frame (get_current_frame ()); | |
5747 | else | |
5748 | { | |
5749 | frame_info_ptr frame; | |
5750 | ||
5751 | /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular | |
5752 | instance of a local is being watched matters, so we | |
5753 | keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression | |
5754 | in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't | |
5755 | really matter which instantiation of the function | |
5756 | where the condition makes sense triggers the | |
5757 | watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch | |
5758 | global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to | |
5759 | global on all threads that call `func', or catch | |
5760 | writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single | |
5761 | thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in | |
5762 | the innermost frame that's executing where it makes | |
5763 | sense to evaluate the condition. It seems | |
5764 | intuitive. */ | |
5765 | frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block); | |
5766 | if (frame != NULL) | |
5767 | select_frame (frame); | |
5768 | else | |
5769 | within_current_scope = false; | |
5770 | } | |
5771 | if (within_current_scope) | |
5772 | { | |
5773 | try | |
5774 | { | |
5775 | scoped_restore reset_in_cond_eval | |
5776 | = make_scoped_restore (&thread->control.in_cond_eval, true); | |
5777 | condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond); | |
5778 | } | |
5779 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex) | |
5780 | { | |
5781 | int locno = bpstat_locno (bs); | |
5782 | if (locno != 0) | |
5783 | exception_fprintf | |
5784 | (gdb_stderr, ex, | |
5785 | "Error in testing condition for breakpoint %d.%d:\n", | |
5786 | b->number, locno); | |
5787 | else | |
5788 | exception_fprintf | |
5789 | (gdb_stderr, ex, | |
5790 | "Error in testing condition for breakpoint %d:\n", | |
5791 | b->number); | |
5792 | } | |
5793 | } | |
5794 | else | |
5795 | { | |
5796 | warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested " | |
5797 | "in the current scope")); | |
5798 | /* If we failed to set the right context for this | |
5799 | watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */ | |
5800 | } | |
5801 | /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */ | |
5802 | } | |
5803 | ||
5804 | if (cond != nullptr && !condition_result) | |
5805 | { | |
5806 | infrun_debug_printf ("condition_result = false, not stopping"); | |
5807 | bs->stop = false; | |
5808 | return; | |
5809 | } | |
5810 | else if (b->ignore_count > 0) | |
5811 | { | |
5812 | infrun_debug_printf ("ignore count %d, not stopping", | |
5813 | b->ignore_count); | |
5814 | b->ignore_count--; | |
5815 | bs->stop = false; | |
5816 | /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */ | |
5817 | ++(b->hit_count); | |
5818 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
5819 | return; | |
5820 | } | |
5821 | ||
5822 | if (bs->stop) | |
5823 | infrun_debug_printf ("stopping at this breakpoint"); | |
5824 | else | |
5825 | infrun_debug_printf ("not stopping at this breakpoint"); | |
5826 | } | |
5827 | ||
5828 | /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type | |
5829 | on the current target. */ | |
5830 | ||
5831 | static bool | |
5832 | need_moribund_for_location_type (const struct bp_location *loc) | |
5833 | { | |
5834 | return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
5835 | && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()) | |
5836 | || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
5837 | && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())); | |
5838 | } | |
5839 | ||
5840 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
5841 | ||
5842 | bpstat * | |
5843 | build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
5844 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
5845 | { | |
5846 | bpstat *bs_head = nullptr, **bs_link = &bs_head; | |
5847 | ||
5848 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
5849 | { | |
5850 | if (!breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | |
5851 | continue; | |
5852 | ||
5853 | for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | |
5854 | { | |
5855 | /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first | |
5856 | location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the | |
5857 | entire expression, not the individual locations. For | |
5858 | read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has | |
5859 | checked all locations already. */ | |
5860 | if (b.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && &bl != &b.first_loc ()) | |
5861 | break; | |
5862 | ||
5863 | if (!bl.enabled || bl.disabled_by_cond || bl.shlib_disabled) | |
5864 | continue; | |
5865 | ||
5866 | if (!bpstat_check_location (&bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws)) | |
5867 | continue; | |
5868 | ||
5869 | /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address | |
5870 | matches. */ | |
5871 | ||
5872 | bpstat *bs = new bpstat (&bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to | |
5873 | explain stop. */ | |
5874 | ||
5875 | /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not | |
5876 | actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint | |
5877 | evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */ | |
5878 | bs->stop = true; | |
5879 | bs->print = true; | |
5880 | ||
5881 | /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated | |
5882 | watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the | |
5883 | out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next | |
5884 | iteration. */ | |
5885 | if (b.type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b.related_breakpoint != &b) | |
5886 | { | |
5887 | watchpoint *w | |
5888 | = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b.related_breakpoint); | |
5889 | ||
5890 | w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes; | |
5891 | } | |
5892 | } | |
5893 | } | |
5894 | ||
5895 | /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */ | |
5896 | if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint () | |
5897 | || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()) | |
5898 | { | |
5899 | for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations) | |
5900 | { | |
5901 | if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr) | |
5902 | && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc)) | |
5903 | { | |
5904 | bpstat *bs = new bpstat (loc, &bs_link); | |
5905 | /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */ | |
5906 | bs->stop = false; | |
5907 | bs->print = false; | |
5908 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5909 | } | |
5910 | } | |
5911 | } | |
5912 | ||
5913 | return bs_head; | |
5914 | } | |
5915 | ||
5916 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
5917 | ||
5918 | bpstat * | |
5919 | bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace, | |
5920 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread, | |
5921 | const target_waitstatus &ws, | |
5922 | bpstat *stop_chain) | |
5923 | { | |
5924 | struct breakpoint *b = NULL; | |
5925 | /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */ | |
5926 | bpstat *bs_head = stop_chain; | |
5927 | bpstat *bs; | |
5928 | int need_remove_insert; | |
5929 | int removed_any; | |
5930 | ||
5931 | /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a | |
5932 | target stop, while being careful to not set the target running, | |
5933 | as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint | |
5934 | locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with | |
5935 | breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include | |
5936 | inferior function calls. */ | |
5937 | if (bs_head == NULL) | |
5938 | bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws); | |
5939 | ||
5940 | /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to | |
5941 | process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and | |
5942 | unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and | |
5943 | "catch unload". */ | |
5944 | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
5945 | { | |
5946 | if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event) | |
5947 | { | |
5948 | handle_solib_event (); | |
5949 | break; | |
5950 | } | |
5951 | } | |
5952 | ||
5953 | /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and | |
5954 | check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher | |
5955 | layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */ | |
5956 | ||
5957 | removed_any = 0; | |
5958 | ||
5959 | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
5960 | { | |
5961 | if (!bs->stop) | |
5962 | continue; | |
5963 | ||
5964 | b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
5965 | b->check_status (bs); | |
5966 | if (bs->stop) | |
5967 | { | |
5968 | bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread); | |
5969 | ||
5970 | if (bs->stop) | |
5971 | { | |
5972 | ++(b->hit_count); | |
5973 | ||
5974 | /* We will stop here. */ | |
5975 | if (b->disposition == disp_disable) | |
5976 | { | |
5977 | --(b->enable_count); | |
5978 | if (b->enable_count <= 0) | |
5979 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
5980 | removed_any = 1; | |
5981 | } | |
5982 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
5983 | if (b->silent) | |
5984 | bs->print = false; | |
5985 | bs->commands = b->commands; | |
5986 | if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands | |
5987 | ? bs->commands.get () : NULL)) | |
5988 | bs->print = false; | |
5989 | ||
5990 | b->after_condition_true (bs); | |
5991 | } | |
5992 | ||
5993 | } | |
5994 | ||
5995 | /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't | |
5996 | print. */ | |
5997 | if (!bs->stop || !bs->print) | |
5998 | bs->print_it = print_it_noop; | |
5999 | } | |
6000 | ||
6001 | /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may | |
6002 | not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are | |
6003 | watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get | |
6004 | done later. */ | |
6005 | need_remove_insert = 0; | |
6006 | if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head)) | |
6007 | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
6008 | if (!bs->stop | |
6009 | && bs->breakpoint_at | |
6010 | && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at)) | |
6011 | { | |
6012 | watchpoint *w | |
6013 | = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bs->breakpoint_at); | |
6014 | ||
6015 | update_watchpoint (w, false /* don't reparse. */); | |
6016 | need_remove_insert = 1; | |
6017 | } | |
6018 | ||
6019 | if (need_remove_insert) | |
6020 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
6021 | else if (removed_any) | |
6022 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
6023 | ||
6024 | return bs_head; | |
6025 | } | |
6026 | ||
6027 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
6028 | ||
6029 | bpstat * | |
6030 | bpstat_stop_status_nowatch (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
6031 | thread_info *thread, const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
6032 | { | |
6033 | gdb_assert (!target_stopped_by_watchpoint ()); | |
6034 | ||
6035 | /* Clear all watchpoints' 'watchpoint_triggered' value from a | |
6036 | previous stop to avoid confusing bpstat_stop_status. */ | |
6037 | watchpoints_triggered (ws); | |
6038 | ||
6039 | return bpstat_stop_status (aspace, bp_addr, thread, ws); | |
6040 | } | |
6041 | ||
6042 | static void | |
6043 | handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address) | |
6044 | { | |
6045 | struct gdbarch *gdbarch; | |
6046 | ||
6047 | infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event"); | |
6048 | ||
6049 | /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by | |
6050 | breakpoint_re_set. */ | |
6051 | target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | |
6052 | ||
6053 | gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ()); | |
6054 | /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`, | |
6055 | thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through | |
6056 | minimal symbol lookup. If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it | |
6057 | most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this | |
6058 | function needs to be updated too. */ | |
6059 | bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address); | |
6060 | gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr); | |
6061 | objfile *objfile = jit_bp_sym.objfile; | |
6062 | if (objfile->separate_debug_objfile_backlink) | |
6063 | objfile = objfile->separate_debug_objfile_backlink; | |
6064 | jit_event_handler (gdbarch, objfile); | |
6065 | ||
6066 | target_terminal::inferior (); | |
6067 | } | |
6068 | ||
6069 | /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */ | |
6070 | ||
6071 | /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */ | |
6072 | ||
6073 | struct bpstat_what | |
6074 | bpstat_what (bpstat *bs_head) | |
6075 | { | |
6076 | struct bpstat_what retval; | |
6077 | bpstat *bs; | |
6078 | ||
6079 | retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | |
6080 | retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE; | |
6081 | retval.is_longjmp = false; | |
6082 | ||
6083 | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
6084 | { | |
6085 | /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check | |
6086 | if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */ | |
6087 | enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | |
6088 | enum bptype bptype; | |
6089 | ||
6090 | if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL) | |
6091 | { | |
6092 | /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary | |
6093 | breakpoint which has since been deleted. */ | |
6094 | bptype = bp_none; | |
6095 | } | |
6096 | else | |
6097 | bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type; | |
6098 | ||
6099 | switch (bptype) | |
6100 | { | |
6101 | case bp_none: | |
6102 | break; | |
6103 | case bp_breakpoint: | |
6104 | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | |
6105 | case bp_single_step: | |
6106 | case bp_until: | |
6107 | case bp_finish: | |
6108 | case bp_shlib_event: | |
6109 | if (bs->stop) | |
6110 | { | |
6111 | if (bs->print) | |
6112 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | |
6113 | else | |
6114 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6115 | } | |
6116 | else | |
6117 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6118 | break; | |
6119 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
6120 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
6121 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
6122 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
6123 | if (bs->stop) | |
6124 | { | |
6125 | if (bs->print) | |
6126 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | |
6127 | else | |
6128 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6129 | } | |
6130 | else | |
6131 | { | |
6132 | /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping. | |
6133 | This requires no further action. */ | |
6134 | } | |
6135 | break; | |
6136 | case bp_longjmp: | |
6137 | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | |
6138 | case bp_exception: | |
6139 | if (bs->stop) | |
6140 | { | |
6141 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME; | |
6142 | retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception; | |
6143 | } | |
6144 | else | |
6145 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6146 | break; | |
6147 | case bp_longjmp_resume: | |
6148 | case bp_exception_resume: | |
6149 | if (bs->stop) | |
6150 | { | |
6151 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME; | |
6152 | retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume; | |
6153 | } | |
6154 | else | |
6155 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6156 | break; | |
6157 | case bp_step_resume: | |
6158 | if (bs->stop) | |
6159 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME; | |
6160 | else | |
6161 | { | |
6162 | /* It is for the wrong frame. */ | |
6163 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6164 | } | |
6165 | break; | |
6166 | case bp_hp_step_resume: | |
6167 | if (bs->stop) | |
6168 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME; | |
6169 | else | |
6170 | { | |
6171 | /* It is for the wrong frame. */ | |
6172 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6173 | } | |
6174 | break; | |
6175 | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | |
6176 | case bp_thread_event: | |
6177 | case bp_overlay_event: | |
6178 | case bp_longjmp_master: | |
6179 | case bp_std_terminate_master: | |
6180 | case bp_exception_master: | |
6181 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6182 | break; | |
6183 | case bp_catchpoint: | |
6184 | if (bs->stop) | |
6185 | { | |
6186 | if (bs->print) | |
6187 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY; | |
6188 | else | |
6189 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6190 | } | |
6191 | else | |
6192 | { | |
6193 | /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints. | |
6194 | For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */ | |
6195 | if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
6196 | || bs->bp_location_at->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
6197 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6198 | } | |
6199 | break; | |
6200 | case bp_jit_event: | |
6201 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6202 | break; | |
6203 | case bp_call_dummy: | |
6204 | /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | |
6205 | so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */ | |
6206 | retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY; | |
6207 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6208 | break; | |
6209 | case bp_std_terminate: | |
6210 | /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy), | |
6211 | so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */ | |
6212 | retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE; | |
6213 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6214 | break; | |
6215 | case bp_tracepoint: | |
6216 | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | |
6217 | case bp_static_tracepoint: | |
6218 | case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | |
6219 | /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and | |
6220 | if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered | |
6221 | out already. */ | |
6222 | internal_error (_("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered")); | |
6223 | break; | |
6224 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | |
6225 | /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */ | |
6226 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6227 | break; | |
6228 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | |
6229 | /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the | |
6230 | PC of the former breakpoint. */ | |
6231 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING; | |
6232 | break; | |
6233 | ||
6234 | case bp_dprintf: | |
6235 | if (bs->stop) | |
6236 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT; | |
6237 | else | |
6238 | this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE; | |
6239 | break; | |
6240 | ||
6241 | default: | |
6242 | internal_error (_("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype); | |
6243 | } | |
6244 | ||
6245 | retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action); | |
6246 | } | |
6247 | ||
6248 | return retval; | |
6249 | } | |
6250 | ||
6251 | void | |
6252 | bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat *bs_head) | |
6253 | { | |
6254 | bpstat *bs; | |
6255 | ||
6256 | for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
6257 | { | |
6258 | struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at; | |
6259 | ||
6260 | if (b == NULL) | |
6261 | continue; | |
6262 | switch (b->type) | |
6263 | { | |
6264 | case bp_jit_event: | |
6265 | handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address); | |
6266 | break; | |
6267 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | |
6268 | gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop | |
6269 | (gdb::checked_static_cast<code_breakpoint *> (b)); | |
6270 | break; | |
6271 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | |
6272 | gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop | |
6273 | (gdb::checked_static_cast<code_breakpoint *> (b)); | |
6274 | break; | |
6275 | } | |
6276 | } | |
6277 | } | |
6278 | ||
6279 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
6280 | ||
6281 | bool | |
6282 | bpstat_should_step () | |
6283 | { | |
6284 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
6285 | if (breakpoint_enabled (&b) | |
6286 | && b.type == bp_watchpoint | |
6287 | && b.has_locations ()) | |
6288 | return true; | |
6289 | ||
6290 | return false; | |
6291 | } | |
6292 | ||
6293 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
6294 | ||
6295 | bool | |
6296 | bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat *bs) | |
6297 | { | |
6298 | for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next) | |
6299 | if (bs->stop) | |
6300 | return true; | |
6301 | ||
6302 | return false; | |
6303 | } | |
6304 | ||
6305 | \f | |
6306 | ||
6307 | /* Compute a number of spaces suitable to indent the next line | |
6308 | so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column | |
6309 | named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */ | |
6310 | ||
6311 | static int | |
6312 | wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name) | |
6313 | { | |
6314 | int i, total_width, width, align; | |
6315 | const char *text; | |
6316 | ||
6317 | total_width = 0; | |
6318 | for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++) | |
6319 | { | |
6320 | if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0) | |
6321 | return total_width; | |
6322 | ||
6323 | total_width += width + 1; | |
6324 | } | |
6325 | ||
6326 | return 0; | |
6327 | } | |
6328 | ||
6329 | /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions | |
6330 | evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following: | |
6331 | ||
6332 | "host": Host evals condition. | |
6333 | "host or target": Host or Target evals condition. | |
6334 | "target": Target evals condition. | |
6335 | */ | |
6336 | ||
6337 | static const char * | |
6338 | bp_condition_evaluator (const breakpoint *b) | |
6339 | { | |
6340 | char host_evals = 0; | |
6341 | char target_evals = 0; | |
6342 | ||
6343 | if (!b) | |
6344 | return NULL; | |
6345 | ||
6346 | if (!is_breakpoint (b)) | |
6347 | return NULL; | |
6348 | ||
6349 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
6350 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
6351 | return condition_evaluation_host; | |
6352 | ||
6353 | for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | |
6354 | { | |
6355 | if (bl.cond_bytecode) | |
6356 | target_evals++; | |
6357 | else | |
6358 | host_evals++; | |
6359 | } | |
6360 | ||
6361 | if (host_evals && target_evals) | |
6362 | return condition_evaluation_both; | |
6363 | else if (target_evals) | |
6364 | return condition_evaluation_target; | |
6365 | else | |
6366 | return condition_evaluation_host; | |
6367 | } | |
6368 | ||
6369 | /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is | |
6370 | similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */ | |
6371 | ||
6372 | static const char * | |
6373 | bp_location_condition_evaluator (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
6374 | { | |
6375 | if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner)) | |
6376 | return NULL; | |
6377 | ||
6378 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
6379 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
6380 | return condition_evaluation_host; | |
6381 | ||
6382 | if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode) | |
6383 | return condition_evaluation_target; | |
6384 | else | |
6385 | return condition_evaluation_host; | |
6386 | } | |
6387 | ||
6388 | /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */ | |
6389 | ||
6390 | static void | |
6391 | print_breakpoint_location (const breakpoint *b, const bp_location *loc) | |
6392 | { | |
6393 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
6394 | ||
6395 | scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace; | |
6396 | ||
6397 | if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled) | |
6398 | loc = NULL; | |
6399 | ||
6400 | if (loc != NULL) | |
6401 | set_current_program_space (loc->pspace); | |
6402 | ||
6403 | if (b->display_canonical) | |
6404 | uiout->field_string ("what", b->locspec->to_string ()); | |
6405 | else if (loc && loc->symtab) | |
6406 | { | |
6407 | const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol; | |
6408 | ||
6409 | if (sym) | |
6410 | { | |
6411 | uiout->text ("in "); | |
6412 | uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), | |
6413 | function_name_style.style ()); | |
6414 | uiout->text (" "); | |
6415 | uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what")); | |
6416 | uiout->text ("at "); | |
6417 | } | |
6418 | uiout->field_string ("file", | |
6419 | symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab), | |
6420 | file_name_style.style ()); | |
6421 | uiout->text (":"); | |
6422 | ||
6423 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6424 | uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab)); | |
6425 | ||
6426 | uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number, | |
6427 | line_number_style.style ()); | |
6428 | } | |
6429 | else if (loc) | |
6430 | { | |
6431 | string_file stb; | |
6432 | ||
6433 | print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb, | |
6434 | demangle, ""); | |
6435 | uiout->field_stream ("at", stb); | |
6436 | } | |
6437 | else | |
6438 | { | |
6439 | /* Internal breakpoints don't have a locspec string, but can become | |
6440 | pending if the shared library the breakpoint is in is unloaded. | |
6441 | For most internal breakpoint types though, after unloading the | |
6442 | shared library, the breakpoint will be deleted and never recreated | |
6443 | (see internal_breakpoint::re_set). But for two internal | |
6444 | breakpoint types bp_shlib_event and bp_thread_event this is not | |
6445 | true. Usually we don't expect the libraries that contain these | |
6446 | breakpoints to ever be unloaded, but a buggy inferior might do | |
6447 | such a thing, in which case GDB should be prepared to handle this | |
6448 | case. | |
6449 | ||
6450 | If these two breakpoint types become pending then there will be no | |
6451 | locspec string. */ | |
6452 | gdb_assert (b->locspec != nullptr | |
6453 | || (!user_breakpoint_p (b) | |
6454 | && (b->type == bp_shlib_event | |
6455 | || b->type == bp_thread_event))); | |
6456 | const char *locspec_str | |
6457 | = (b->locspec != nullptr ? b->locspec->to_string () : ""); | |
6458 | uiout->field_string ("pending", locspec_str); | |
6459 | } | |
6460 | ||
6461 | if (loc && is_breakpoint (b) | |
6462 | && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target | |
6463 | && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both) | |
6464 | { | |
6465 | uiout->text (" ("); | |
6466 | uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by", | |
6467 | bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc)); | |
6468 | uiout->text (")"); | |
6469 | } | |
6470 | } | |
6471 | ||
6472 | static const char * | |
6473 | bptype_string (enum bptype type) | |
6474 | { | |
6475 | struct ep_type_description | |
6476 | { | |
6477 | enum bptype type; | |
6478 | const char *description; | |
6479 | }; | |
6480 | static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] = | |
6481 | { | |
6482 | {bp_none, "?deleted?"}, | |
6483 | {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"}, | |
6484 | {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"}, | |
6485 | {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"}, | |
6486 | {bp_until, "until"}, | |
6487 | {bp_finish, "finish"}, | |
6488 | {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"}, | |
6489 | {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"}, | |
6490 | {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"}, | |
6491 | {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"}, | |
6492 | {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"}, | |
6493 | {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"}, | |
6494 | {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"}, | |
6495 | {bp_exception, "exception"}, | |
6496 | {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"}, | |
6497 | {bp_step_resume, "step resume"}, | |
6498 | {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"}, | |
6499 | {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"}, | |
6500 | {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"}, | |
6501 | {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"}, | |
6502 | {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"}, | |
6503 | {bp_thread_event, "thread events"}, | |
6504 | {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"}, | |
6505 | {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"}, | |
6506 | {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"}, | |
6507 | {bp_exception_master, "exception master"}, | |
6508 | {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"}, | |
6509 | {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"}, | |
6510 | {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"}, | |
6511 | {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"}, | |
6512 | {bp_static_marker_tracepoint, "static marker tracepoint"}, | |
6513 | {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"}, | |
6514 | {bp_jit_event, "jit events"}, | |
6515 | {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"}, | |
6516 | {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"}, | |
6517 | }; | |
6518 | ||
6519 | if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0]))) | |
6520 | || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type)) | |
6521 | internal_error (_("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."), | |
6522 | (int) type); | |
6523 | ||
6524 | return bptypes[(int) type].description; | |
6525 | } | |
6526 | ||
6527 | /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value. | |
6528 | For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */ | |
6529 | ||
6530 | static void | |
6531 | output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout, | |
6532 | const char *field_name, | |
6533 | const std::vector<int> &inf_nums, | |
6534 | int mi_only) | |
6535 | { | |
6536 | int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p (); | |
6537 | ||
6538 | /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | |
6539 | there are several. Always display them for MI. */ | |
6540 | if (!is_mi && mi_only) | |
6541 | return; | |
6542 | ||
6543 | ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name); | |
6544 | ||
6545 | for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++) | |
6546 | { | |
6547 | if (is_mi) | |
6548 | { | |
6549 | char mi_group[10]; | |
6550 | ||
6551 | xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]); | |
6552 | uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group); | |
6553 | } | |
6554 | else | |
6555 | { | |
6556 | if (i == 0) | |
6557 | uiout->text (" inf "); | |
6558 | else | |
6559 | uiout->text (", "); | |
6560 | ||
6561 | uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i])); | |
6562 | } | |
6563 | } | |
6564 | } | |
6565 | ||
6566 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
6567 | ||
6568 | bool fix_breakpoint_script_output_globally = false; | |
6569 | ||
6570 | /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations | |
6571 | instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint | |
6572 | info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of | |
6573 | catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation | |
6574 | detail. Returns true if RAW_LOC is false and if the breakpoint's | |
6575 | print_one method did something; false otherwise. */ | |
6576 | ||
6577 | static bool | |
6578 | print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b, | |
6579 | struct bp_location *loc, | |
6580 | int loc_number, | |
6581 | const bp_location **last_loc, | |
6582 | int allflag, bool raw_loc) | |
6583 | { | |
6584 | struct command_line *l; | |
6585 | static char bpenables[] = "nynny"; | |
6586 | ||
6587 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
6588 | bool header_of_multiple = false; | |
6589 | bool part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL); | |
6590 | struct value_print_options opts; | |
6591 | ||
6592 | get_user_print_options (&opts); | |
6593 | ||
6594 | gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0); | |
6595 | /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of | |
6596 | breakpoints with single disabled location. */ | |
6597 | if (loc == NULL | |
6598 | && (b->has_locations () | |
6599 | && (b->has_multiple_locations () | |
6600 | || !b->first_loc ().enabled || b->first_loc ().disabled_by_cond))) | |
6601 | header_of_multiple = true; | |
6602 | ||
6603 | if (loc == NULL && b->has_locations ()) | |
6604 | loc = &b->first_loc (); | |
6605 | ||
6606 | annotate_record (); | |
6607 | ||
6608 | /* 1 */ | |
6609 | annotate_field (0); | |
6610 | if (part_of_multiple) | |
6611 | uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number); | |
6612 | else | |
6613 | uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number); | |
6614 | ||
6615 | /* 2 */ | |
6616 | annotate_field (1); | |
6617 | if (part_of_multiple) | |
6618 | uiout->field_skip ("type"); | |
6619 | else | |
6620 | uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type)); | |
6621 | ||
6622 | /* 3 */ | |
6623 | annotate_field (2); | |
6624 | if (part_of_multiple) | |
6625 | uiout->field_skip ("disp"); | |
6626 | else | |
6627 | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition)); | |
6628 | ||
6629 | /* 4 */ | |
6630 | annotate_field (3); | |
6631 | if (part_of_multiple) | |
6632 | { | |
6633 | /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid | |
6634 | condition, display "N*" on the CLI, where "*" refers to a | |
6635 | footnote below the table. For MI, simply display a "N" | |
6636 | without a footnote. On the CLI, for enabled locations whose | |
6637 | breakpoint is disabled, display "y-". */ | |
6638 | auto get_enable_state = [uiout, loc] () -> const char * | |
6639 | { | |
6640 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6641 | { | |
6642 | if (loc->disabled_by_cond) | |
6643 | return "N"; | |
6644 | else if (!loc->enabled) | |
6645 | return "n"; | |
6646 | else | |
6647 | return "y"; | |
6648 | } | |
6649 | else | |
6650 | { | |
6651 | if (loc->disabled_by_cond) | |
6652 | return "N*"; | |
6653 | else if (!loc->enabled) | |
6654 | return "n"; | |
6655 | else if (!breakpoint_enabled (loc->owner)) | |
6656 | return "y-"; | |
6657 | else | |
6658 | return "y"; | |
6659 | } | |
6660 | }; | |
6661 | uiout->field_string ("enabled", get_enable_state ()); | |
6662 | } | |
6663 | else | |
6664 | uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]); | |
6665 | ||
6666 | /* 5 and 6 */ | |
6667 | bool result = false; | |
6668 | if (!raw_loc && b->print_one (last_loc)) | |
6669 | result = true; | |
6670 | else | |
6671 | { | |
6672 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
6673 | { | |
6674 | watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | |
6675 | ||
6676 | /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns | |
6677 | not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect | |
6678 | is relatively readable). */ | |
6679 | if (opts.addressprint) | |
6680 | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | |
6681 | annotate_field (5); | |
6682 | uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string.get ()); | |
6683 | } | |
6684 | else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) | |
6685 | || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) | |
6686 | { | |
6687 | if (opts.addressprint) | |
6688 | { | |
6689 | annotate_field (4); | |
6690 | if (header_of_multiple) | |
6691 | uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>", | |
6692 | metadata_style.style ()); | |
6693 | else if (!b->has_locations () || loc->shlib_disabled) | |
6694 | uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>", | |
6695 | metadata_style.style ()); | |
6696 | else | |
6697 | uiout->field_core_addr ("addr", | |
6698 | loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | |
6699 | } | |
6700 | annotate_field (5); | |
6701 | if (!header_of_multiple) | |
6702 | print_breakpoint_location (b, loc); | |
6703 | if (b->has_locations ()) | |
6704 | *last_loc = &b->first_loc (); | |
6705 | } | |
6706 | } | |
6707 | ||
6708 | if (loc != nullptr && !header_of_multiple && !loc->shlib_disabled) | |
6709 | { | |
6710 | std::vector<int> inf_nums; | |
6711 | int mi_only = 1; | |
6712 | ||
6713 | for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | |
6714 | { | |
6715 | if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace) | |
6716 | inf_nums.push_back (inf->num); | |
6717 | } | |
6718 | ||
6719 | /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless | |
6720 | there are several. Always display for MI. */ | |
6721 | if (allflag | |
6722 | || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
6723 | && (program_spaces.size () > 1 | |
6724 | || number_of_inferiors () > 1) | |
6725 | /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in | |
6726 | moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */ | |
6727 | && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint)) | |
6728 | mi_only = 0; | |
6729 | output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only); | |
6730 | } | |
6731 | ||
6732 | /* In the MI output, each location of a thread or task specific | |
6733 | breakpoint includes the relevant thread or task ID. This is done for | |
6734 | backwards compatibility reasons. | |
6735 | ||
6736 | For the CLI output, the thread/task information is printed on a | |
6737 | separate line, see the 'stop only in thread' and 'stop only in task' | |
6738 | output below. */ | |
6739 | if (part_of_multiple && uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6740 | { | |
6741 | if (b->thread != -1) | |
6742 | uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); | |
6743 | else if (b->task != -1) | |
6744 | uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task); | |
6745 | else if (b->inferior != -1) | |
6746 | uiout->field_signed ("inferior", b->inferior); | |
6747 | } | |
6748 | ||
6749 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6750 | ||
6751 | if (!part_of_multiple) | |
6752 | b->print_one_detail (uiout); | |
6753 | ||
6754 | if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id)) | |
6755 | { | |
6756 | annotate_field (6); | |
6757 | uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at "); | |
6758 | /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside | |
6759 | the frame ID. */ | |
6760 | uiout->field_core_addr ("frame", | |
6761 | b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr); | |
6762 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6763 | } | |
6764 | ||
6765 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string) | |
6766 | { | |
6767 | annotate_field (7); | |
6768 | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
6769 | uiout->text ("\ttrace only if "); | |
6770 | else | |
6771 | uiout->text ("\tstop only if "); | |
6772 | uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string.get ()); | |
6773 | ||
6774 | /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition | |
6775 | evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */ | |
6776 | if (is_breakpoint (b) | |
6777 | && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () | |
6778 | == condition_evaluation_target) | |
6779 | { | |
6780 | uiout->message (" (%pF evals)", | |
6781 | string_field ("evaluated-by", | |
6782 | bp_condition_evaluator (b))); | |
6783 | } | |
6784 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6785 | } | |
6786 | ||
6787 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1) | |
6788 | { | |
6789 | /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */ | |
6790 | uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread "); | |
6791 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6792 | uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread); | |
6793 | else | |
6794 | { | |
6795 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread); | |
6796 | ||
6797 | uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr)); | |
6798 | } | |
6799 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6800 | } | |
6801 | ||
6802 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->task != -1) | |
6803 | { | |
6804 | uiout->text ("\tstop only in task "); | |
6805 | uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task); | |
6806 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6807 | } | |
6808 | ||
6809 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->inferior != -1) | |
6810 | { | |
6811 | uiout->text ("\tstop only in inferior "); | |
6812 | uiout->field_signed ("inferior", b->inferior); | |
6813 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
6814 | } | |
6815 | ||
6816 | if (!part_of_multiple) | |
6817 | { | |
6818 | if (b->hit_count) | |
6819 | { | |
6820 | /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */ | |
6821 | if (is_catchpoint (b)) | |
6822 | uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint"); | |
6823 | else if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
6824 | uiout->text ("\ttracepoint"); | |
6825 | else | |
6826 | uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint"); | |
6827 | uiout->text (" already hit "); | |
6828 | uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); | |
6829 | if (b->hit_count == 1) | |
6830 | uiout->text (" time\n"); | |
6831 | else | |
6832 | uiout->text (" times\n"); | |
6833 | } | |
6834 | else | |
6835 | { | |
6836 | /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */ | |
6837 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6838 | uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count); | |
6839 | } | |
6840 | } | |
6841 | ||
6842 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count) | |
6843 | { | |
6844 | annotate_field (8); | |
6845 | uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n", | |
6846 | signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count)); | |
6847 | } | |
6848 | ||
6849 | /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once" | |
6850 | behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and | |
6851 | disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */ | |
6852 | if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1) | |
6853 | { | |
6854 | annotate_field (8); | |
6855 | uiout->text ("\tdisable after "); | |
6856 | /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts | |
6857 | are distinct, and have additive effect. */ | |
6858 | if (b->ignore_count) | |
6859 | uiout->text ("additional "); | |
6860 | else | |
6861 | uiout->text ("next "); | |
6862 | uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count); | |
6863 | uiout->text (" hits\n"); | |
6864 | } | |
6865 | ||
6866 | if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b)) | |
6867 | { | |
6868 | tracepoint *tp = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | |
6869 | ||
6870 | if (tp->traceframe_usage) | |
6871 | { | |
6872 | uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage "); | |
6873 | uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage); | |
6874 | uiout->text (" bytes\n"); | |
6875 | } | |
6876 | } | |
6877 | ||
6878 | l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL; | |
6879 | if (!part_of_multiple && l) | |
6880 | { | |
6881 | annotate_field (9); | |
6882 | ||
6883 | bool use_fixed_output = | |
6884 | (uiout->test_flags (fix_breakpoint_script_output) | |
6885 | || fix_breakpoint_script_output_globally); | |
6886 | ||
6887 | std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter; | |
6888 | std::optional<ui_out_emit_list> list_emitter; | |
6889 | ||
6890 | if (use_fixed_output) | |
6891 | list_emitter.emplace (uiout, "script"); | |
6892 | else | |
6893 | tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "script"); | |
6894 | ||
6895 | print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4); | |
6896 | } | |
6897 | ||
6898 | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
6899 | { | |
6900 | tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (b); | |
6901 | ||
6902 | if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count) | |
6903 | { | |
6904 | annotate_field (10); | |
6905 | uiout->text ("\tpass count "); | |
6906 | uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count); | |
6907 | uiout->text (" \n"); | |
6908 | } | |
6909 | ||
6910 | /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is | |
6911 | pending. */ | |
6912 | if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled) | |
6913 | { | |
6914 | annotate_field (11); | |
6915 | ||
6916 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
6917 | uiout->field_string ("installed", | |
6918 | loc->inserted ? "y" : "n"); | |
6919 | else | |
6920 | { | |
6921 | if (loc->inserted) | |
6922 | uiout->text ("\t"); | |
6923 | else | |
6924 | uiout->text ("\tnot "); | |
6925 | uiout->text ("installed on target\n"); | |
6926 | } | |
6927 | } | |
6928 | } | |
6929 | ||
6930 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple) | |
6931 | { | |
6932 | if (is_watchpoint (b)) | |
6933 | { | |
6934 | watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (b); | |
6935 | ||
6936 | uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string.get ()); | |
6937 | } | |
6938 | else if (b->locspec != nullptr) | |
6939 | { | |
6940 | const char *str = b->locspec->to_string (); | |
6941 | if (str != nullptr) | |
6942 | uiout->field_string ("original-location", str); | |
6943 | } | |
6944 | } | |
6945 | ||
6946 | return result; | |
6947 | } | |
6948 | ||
6949 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
6950 | ||
6951 | bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false; | |
6952 | ||
6953 | static void | |
6954 | print_one_breakpoint (breakpoint *b, const bp_location **last_loc, int allflag) | |
6955 | { | |
6956 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
6957 | bool use_fixed_output | |
6958 | = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output) | |
6959 | || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally); | |
6960 | ||
6961 | std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (std::in_place, uiout, | |
6962 | "bkpt"); | |
6963 | bool printed = print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, | |
6964 | allflag, false); | |
6965 | ||
6966 | /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations | |
6967 | are outside. */ | |
6968 | if (!use_fixed_output) | |
6969 | bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset (); | |
6970 | ||
6971 | /* If this breakpoint has custom print function, | |
6972 | it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual | |
6973 | locations, if any. */ | |
6974 | if (!printed || allflag) | |
6975 | { | |
6976 | /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we | |
6977 | print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's | |
6978 | hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled" | |
6979 | situation. | |
6980 | ||
6981 | Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations | |
6982 | internally, that's not a property exposed to users. | |
6983 | ||
6984 | Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with | |
6985 | breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property | |
6986 | exposed to users. We do however display the internal | |
6987 | breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */ | |
6988 | if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | |
6989 | && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b) | |
6990 | || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b)) | |
6991 | && (allflag | |
6992 | || (b->has_locations () | |
6993 | && (b->has_multiple_locations () | |
6994 | || !b->first_loc ().enabled | |
6995 | || b->first_loc ().disabled_by_cond)))) | |
6996 | { | |
6997 | std::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list; | |
6998 | ||
6999 | /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid | |
7000 | MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a | |
7001 | list. */ | |
7002 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output) | |
7003 | locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations"); | |
7004 | ||
7005 | int n = 1; | |
7006 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
7007 | { | |
7008 | ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL); | |
7009 | print_one_breakpoint_location (b, &loc, n, last_loc, | |
7010 | allflag, allflag); | |
7011 | n++; | |
7012 | } | |
7013 | } | |
7014 | } | |
7015 | } | |
7016 | ||
7017 | static int | |
7018 | breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b) | |
7019 | { | |
7020 | int print_address_bits = 0; | |
7021 | ||
7022 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
7023 | { | |
7024 | if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (&loc)) | |
7025 | continue; | |
7026 | ||
7027 | int addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc.gdbarch); | |
7028 | if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | |
7029 | print_address_bits = addr_bit; | |
7030 | } | |
7031 | ||
7032 | return print_address_bits; | |
7033 | } | |
7034 | ||
7035 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
7036 | ||
7037 | void | |
7038 | print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b) | |
7039 | { | |
7040 | const bp_location *dummy_loc = nullptr; | |
7041 | print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0); | |
7042 | } | |
7043 | ||
7044 | /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is | |
7045 | internal or momentary. */ | |
7046 | ||
7047 | int | |
7048 | user_breakpoint_p (const breakpoint *b) | |
7049 | { | |
7050 | return b->number > 0; | |
7051 | } | |
7052 | ||
7053 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
7054 | ||
7055 | int | |
7056 | pending_breakpoint_p (const breakpoint *b) | |
7057 | { | |
7058 | return !b->has_locations (); | |
7059 | } | |
7060 | ||
7061 | /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints). | |
7062 | ||
7063 | If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as | |
7064 | understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this | |
7065 | list are then printed. | |
7066 | ||
7067 | If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints. | |
7068 | ||
7069 | If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the | |
7070 | ones for which it returns true. | |
7071 | ||
7072 | Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */ | |
7073 | ||
7074 | static int | |
7075 | breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal, | |
7076 | bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | |
7077 | { | |
7078 | const bp_location *last_loc = nullptr; | |
7079 | int nr_printable_breakpoints; | |
7080 | struct value_print_options opts; | |
7081 | int print_address_bits = 0; | |
7082 | int print_type_col_width = 14; | |
7083 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
7084 | bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false; | |
7085 | ||
7086 | get_user_print_options (&opts); | |
7087 | ||
7088 | /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size | |
7089 | required for address fields. */ | |
7090 | nr_printable_breakpoints = 0; | |
7091 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7092 | { | |
7093 | /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */ | |
7094 | if (filter && !filter (&b)) | |
7095 | continue; | |
7096 | ||
7097 | /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to | |
7098 | accept. Skip the others. */ | |
7099 | if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') | |
7100 | { | |
7101 | if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b.number) | |
7102 | continue; | |
7103 | if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b.number)) | |
7104 | continue; | |
7105 | } | |
7106 | ||
7107 | if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
7108 | { | |
7109 | int addr_bit, type_len; | |
7110 | ||
7111 | addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (&b); | |
7112 | if (addr_bit > print_address_bits) | |
7113 | print_address_bits = addr_bit; | |
7114 | ||
7115 | type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b.type)); | |
7116 | if (type_len > print_type_col_width) | |
7117 | print_type_col_width = type_len; | |
7118 | ||
7119 | nr_printable_breakpoints++; | |
7120 | } | |
7121 | } | |
7122 | ||
7123 | { | |
7124 | ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout, | |
7125 | opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5, | |
7126 | nr_printable_breakpoints, | |
7127 | "BreakpointTable"); | |
7128 | ||
7129 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7130 | annotate_breakpoints_headers (); | |
7131 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7132 | annotate_field (0); | |
7133 | uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */ | |
7134 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7135 | annotate_field (1); | |
7136 | uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */ | |
7137 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7138 | annotate_field (2); | |
7139 | uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */ | |
7140 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7141 | annotate_field (3); | |
7142 | uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */ | |
7143 | if (opts.addressprint) | |
7144 | { | |
7145 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7146 | annotate_field (4); | |
7147 | if (print_address_bits <= 32) | |
7148 | uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | |
7149 | else | |
7150 | uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */ | |
7151 | } | |
7152 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7153 | annotate_field (5); | |
7154 | uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */ | |
7155 | uiout->table_body (); | |
7156 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0) | |
7157 | annotate_breakpoints_table (); | |
7158 | ||
7159 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7160 | { | |
7161 | QUIT; | |
7162 | /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */ | |
7163 | if (filter && !filter (&b)) | |
7164 | continue; | |
7165 | ||
7166 | /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to | |
7167 | accept. Skip the others. */ | |
7168 | ||
7169 | if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0') | |
7170 | { | |
7171 | if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */ | |
7172 | { | |
7173 | if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b.number) | |
7174 | continue; | |
7175 | } | |
7176 | else /* all others */ | |
7177 | { | |
7178 | if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b.number)) | |
7179 | continue; | |
7180 | } | |
7181 | } | |
7182 | /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the | |
7183 | show_internal is set. */ | |
7184 | if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
7185 | { | |
7186 | print_one_breakpoint (&b, &last_loc, show_internal); | |
7187 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
7188 | if (loc.disabled_by_cond) | |
7189 | has_disabled_by_cond_location = true; | |
7190 | } | |
7191 | } | |
7192 | } | |
7193 | ||
7194 | if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0) | |
7195 | { | |
7196 | /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report | |
7197 | empty list. */ | |
7198 | if (!filter) | |
7199 | { | |
7200 | if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0') | |
7201 | uiout->message ("No breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, " | |
7202 | "or catchpoints.\n"); | |
7203 | else | |
7204 | uiout->message ("No breakpoint, watchpoint, tracepoint, " | |
7205 | "or catchpoint matching '%s'.\n", bp_num_list); | |
7206 | } | |
7207 | } | |
7208 | else | |
7209 | { | |
7210 | if (last_loc && !server_command) | |
7211 | set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address); | |
7212 | ||
7213 | if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
7214 | uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this " | |
7215 | "location.\n")); | |
7216 | } | |
7217 | ||
7218 | /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when | |
7219 | there have been breakpoints? */ | |
7220 | annotate_breakpoints_table_end (); | |
7221 | ||
7222 | return nr_printable_breakpoints; | |
7223 | } | |
7224 | ||
7225 | /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally | |
7226 | compatible with the breakpoint list. */ | |
7227 | ||
7228 | static void | |
7229 | default_collect_info (void) | |
7230 | { | |
7231 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
7232 | ||
7233 | /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a | |
7234 | message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's | |
7235 | not wanted. */ | |
7236 | if (default_collect.empty ()) | |
7237 | return; | |
7238 | ||
7239 | /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect | |
7240 | actions. */ | |
7241 | uiout->text ("default collect "); | |
7242 | uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect); | |
7243 | uiout->text (" \n"); | |
7244 | } | |
7245 | ||
7246 | static void | |
7247 | info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
7248 | { | |
7249 | breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL); | |
7250 | ||
7251 | default_collect_info (); | |
7252 | } | |
7253 | ||
7254 | static void | |
7255 | info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
7256 | { | |
7257 | int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint); | |
7258 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
7259 | ||
7260 | if (num_printed == 0) | |
7261 | { | |
7262 | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | |
7263 | uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n"); | |
7264 | else | |
7265 | uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | |
7266 | } | |
7267 | } | |
7268 | ||
7269 | static void | |
7270 | maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
7271 | { | |
7272 | breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL); | |
7273 | ||
7274 | default_collect_info (); | |
7275 | } | |
7276 | ||
7277 | static bool | |
7278 | breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b, | |
7279 | struct program_space *pspace, | |
7280 | CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section) | |
7281 | { | |
7282 | for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | |
7283 | { | |
7284 | if (bl.pspace == pspace | |
7285 | && bl.address == pc | |
7286 | && (!overlay_debugging || bl.section == section)) | |
7287 | return true; | |
7288 | } | |
7289 | return false; | |
7290 | } | |
7291 | ||
7292 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
7293 | ||
7294 | void | |
7295 | describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
7296 | struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | |
7297 | struct obj_section *section, int thread) | |
7298 | { | |
7299 | int others = 0; | |
7300 | ||
7301 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7302 | others += (user_breakpoint_p (&b) | |
7303 | && breakpoint_has_pc (&b, pspace, pc, section)); | |
7304 | ||
7305 | if (others > 0) | |
7306 | { | |
7307 | if (others == 1) | |
7308 | gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoint ")); | |
7309 | else /* if (others == ???) */ | |
7310 | gdb_printf (_("Note: breakpoints ")); | |
7311 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7312 | if (user_breakpoint_p (&b) | |
7313 | && breakpoint_has_pc (&b, pspace, pc, section)) | |
7314 | { | |
7315 | others--; | |
7316 | gdb_printf ("%d", b.number); | |
7317 | if (b.thread == -1 && thread != -1) | |
7318 | gdb_printf (" (all threads)"); | |
7319 | else if (b.thread != -1) | |
7320 | { | |
7321 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b.thread); | |
7322 | gdb_printf (" (thread %s)", print_thread_id (thr)); | |
7323 | } | |
7324 | else if (b.task != -1) | |
7325 | gdb_printf (" (task %d)", b.task); | |
7326 | gdb_printf ("%s%s ", | |
7327 | ((b.enable_state == bp_disabled | |
7328 | || b.enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | |
7329 | ? " (disabled)" | |
7330 | : ""), | |
7331 | (others > 1) ? "," | |
7332 | : ((others == 1) ? " and" : "")); | |
7333 | } | |
7334 | current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"), | |
7335 | styled_string (address_style.style (), | |
7336 | paddress (gdbarch, pc))); | |
7337 | } | |
7338 | } | |
7339 | \f | |
7340 | ||
7341 | /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC. | |
7342 | For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are | |
7343 | irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to | |
7344 | other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either). | |
7345 | ||
7346 | More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are | |
7347 | not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location | |
7348 | address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types | |
7349 | to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address | |
7350 | zero. */ | |
7351 | ||
7352 | static bool | |
7353 | bl_address_is_meaningful (const bp_location *loc) | |
7354 | { | |
7355 | return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other; | |
7356 | } | |
7357 | ||
7358 | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns | |
7359 | true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */ | |
7360 | ||
7361 | static bool | |
7362 | watchpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | |
7363 | const struct bp_location *loc2) | |
7364 | { | |
7365 | watchpoint *w1 = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (loc1->owner); | |
7366 | watchpoint *w2 = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (loc2->owner); | |
7367 | ||
7368 | /* Both of them must exist. */ | |
7369 | gdb_assert (w1 != NULL); | |
7370 | gdb_assert (w2 != NULL); | |
7371 | ||
7372 | /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware, | |
7373 | then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at | |
7374 | the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when | |
7375 | the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to | |
7376 | true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the | |
7377 | other watchpoint. */ | |
7378 | if ((w1->cond_exp | |
7379 | && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address, | |
7380 | loc1->length, | |
7381 | loc1->watchpoint_type, | |
7382 | w1->cond_exp.get ())) | |
7383 | || (w2->cond_exp | |
7384 | && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address, | |
7385 | loc2->length, | |
7386 | loc2->watchpoint_type, | |
7387 | w2->cond_exp.get ()))) | |
7388 | return false; | |
7389 | ||
7390 | /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In | |
7391 | case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does | |
7392 | support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint | |
7393 | watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered | |
7394 | duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will | |
7395 | become hw_access locations later. */ | |
7396 | return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type | |
7397 | && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace | |
7398 | && loc1->address == loc2->address | |
7399 | && loc1->length == loc2->length); | |
7400 | } | |
7401 | ||
7402 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
7403 | ||
7404 | int | |
7405 | breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1, | |
7406 | const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2) | |
7407 | { | |
7408 | return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
7409 | || aspace1 == aspace2) | |
7410 | && addr1 == addr2); | |
7411 | } | |
7412 | ||
7413 | /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by | |
7414 | {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1 | |
7415 | matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address | |
7416 | space doesn't really matter. */ | |
7417 | ||
7418 | static bool | |
7419 | breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1, | |
7420 | CORE_ADDR addr1, | |
7421 | int len1, const address_space *aspace2, | |
7422 | CORE_ADDR addr2) | |
7423 | { | |
7424 | return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
7425 | || aspace1 == aspace2) | |
7426 | && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1); | |
7427 | } | |
7428 | ||
7429 | /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be | |
7430 | a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE | |
7431 | matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global | |
7432 | breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */ | |
7433 | ||
7434 | static bool | |
7435 | breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl, | |
7436 | const address_space *aspace, | |
7437 | CORE_ADDR addr) | |
7438 | { | |
7439 | return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | |
7440 | aspace, addr) | |
7441 | || (bl->length | |
7442 | && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | |
7443 | bl->address, bl->length, | |
7444 | aspace, addr))); | |
7445 | } | |
7446 | ||
7447 | /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps | |
7448 | breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a | |
7449 | match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address | |
7450 | space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space | |
7451 | doesn't really matter. */ | |
7452 | ||
7453 | static bool | |
7454 | breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl, | |
7455 | const address_space *aspace, | |
7456 | CORE_ADDR addr, int len) | |
7457 | { | |
7458 | if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (current_inferior ()->arch ()) | |
7459 | || bl->pspace->aspace.get () == aspace) | |
7460 | { | |
7461 | int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1; | |
7462 | ||
7463 | if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len)) | |
7464 | return 1; | |
7465 | } | |
7466 | return 0; | |
7467 | } | |
7468 | ||
7469 | /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly. | |
7470 | Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns | |
7471 | true, otherwise returns false. */ | |
7472 | ||
7473 | static bool | |
7474 | tracepoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | |
7475 | const struct bp_location *loc2) | |
7476 | { | |
7477 | if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | |
7478 | /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint | |
7479 | locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as | |
7480 | different locations. */ | |
7481 | return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner); | |
7482 | else | |
7483 | return false; | |
7484 | } | |
7485 | ||
7486 | /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses | |
7487 | (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent | |
7488 | the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software | |
7489 | breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match, | |
7490 | otherwise they don't. */ | |
7491 | ||
7492 | static bool | |
7493 | breakpoint_locations_match (const struct bp_location *loc1, | |
7494 | const struct bp_location *loc2, | |
7495 | bool sw_hw_bps_match) | |
7496 | { | |
7497 | int hw_point1, hw_point2; | |
7498 | ||
7499 | /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */ | |
7500 | gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL); | |
7501 | gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL); | |
7502 | ||
7503 | hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner); | |
7504 | hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner); | |
7505 | ||
7506 | if (hw_point1 != hw_point2) | |
7507 | return false; | |
7508 | else if (hw_point1) | |
7509 | return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | |
7510 | else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner)) | |
7511 | return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2); | |
7512 | else | |
7513 | /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged | |
7514 | breakpoints. Keep this in sync with | |
7515 | bp_location_ptr_is_less_than. */ | |
7516 | return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace.get (), | |
7517 | loc1->address, | |
7518 | loc2->pspace->aspace.get (), | |
7519 | loc2->address) | |
7520 | && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match) | |
7521 | && loc1->length == loc2->length); | |
7522 | } | |
7523 | ||
7524 | static void | |
7525 | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr, | |
7526 | int bnum, bool have_bnum) | |
7527 | { | |
7528 | /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom | |
7529 | is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */ | |
7530 | char astr1[64]; | |
7531 | char astr2[64]; | |
7532 | ||
7533 | strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8)); | |
7534 | strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8)); | |
7535 | if (have_bnum) | |
7536 | warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."), | |
7537 | bnum, astr1, astr2); | |
7538 | else | |
7539 | warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2); | |
7540 | } | |
7541 | ||
7542 | /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural | |
7543 | constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address. | |
7544 | Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most | |
7545 | targets, this function is simply the identity function. */ | |
7546 | ||
7547 | static CORE_ADDR | |
7548 | adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
7549 | CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype, | |
7550 | struct program_space *pspace) | |
7551 | { | |
7552 | gdb_assert (pspace != nullptr); | |
7553 | ||
7554 | if (bptype == bp_watchpoint | |
7555 | || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint | |
7556 | || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint | |
7557 | || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint | |
7558 | || bptype == bp_catchpoint) | |
7559 | { | |
7560 | /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not | |
7561 | have their addresses modified. */ | |
7562 | return bpaddr; | |
7563 | } | |
7564 | else if (bptype == bp_single_step) | |
7565 | { | |
7566 | /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses | |
7567 | modified. If there's any architectural constrain that | |
7568 | applies to this address, then it should have already been | |
7569 | taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the | |
7570 | first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g., | |
7571 | Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */ | |
7572 | return bpaddr; | |
7573 | } | |
7574 | else | |
7575 | { | |
7576 | CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr; | |
7577 | ||
7578 | /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement | |
7579 | of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */ | |
7580 | if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch)) | |
7581 | { | |
7582 | /* Targets that implement this adjustment function will likely | |
7583 | inspect either the symbol table, target memory at BPADDR, or | |
7584 | even state registers, so ensure a suitable thread (and its | |
7585 | associated program space) are currently selected. */ | |
7586 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
7587 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (pspace); | |
7588 | adjusted_bpaddr | |
7589 | = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr); | |
7590 | } | |
7591 | ||
7592 | adjusted_bpaddr | |
7593 | = gdbarch_remove_non_address_bits_breakpoint (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr); | |
7594 | ||
7595 | /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter | |
7596 | a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment | |
7597 | is required. */ | |
7598 | if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr) | |
7599 | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, false); | |
7600 | ||
7601 | return adjusted_bpaddr; | |
7602 | } | |
7603 | } | |
7604 | ||
7605 | static bp_loc_type | |
7606 | bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type) | |
7607 | { | |
7608 | switch (type) | |
7609 | { | |
7610 | case bp_breakpoint: | |
7611 | case bp_single_step: | |
7612 | case bp_until: | |
7613 | case bp_finish: | |
7614 | case bp_longjmp: | |
7615 | case bp_longjmp_resume: | |
7616 | case bp_longjmp_call_dummy: | |
7617 | case bp_exception: | |
7618 | case bp_exception_resume: | |
7619 | case bp_step_resume: | |
7620 | case bp_hp_step_resume: | |
7621 | case bp_watchpoint_scope: | |
7622 | case bp_call_dummy: | |
7623 | case bp_std_terminate: | |
7624 | case bp_shlib_event: | |
7625 | case bp_thread_event: | |
7626 | case bp_overlay_event: | |
7627 | case bp_jit_event: | |
7628 | case bp_longjmp_master: | |
7629 | case bp_std_terminate_master: | |
7630 | case bp_exception_master: | |
7631 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | |
7632 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return: | |
7633 | case bp_dprintf: | |
7634 | return bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | |
7635 | ||
7636 | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | |
7637 | return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | |
7638 | ||
7639 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
7640 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
7641 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
7642 | return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint; | |
7643 | ||
7644 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
7645 | return bp_loc_software_watchpoint; | |
7646 | ||
7647 | case bp_tracepoint: | |
7648 | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | |
7649 | case bp_static_tracepoint: | |
7650 | case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | |
7651 | return bp_loc_tracepoint; | |
7652 | ||
7653 | case bp_catchpoint: | |
7654 | return bp_loc_other; | |
7655 | ||
7656 | default: | |
7657 | internal_error (_("unknown breakpoint type")); | |
7658 | } | |
7659 | } | |
7660 | ||
7661 | bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type) | |
7662 | { | |
7663 | this->owner = owner; | |
7664 | this->cond_bytecode = NULL; | |
7665 | this->shlib_disabled = 0; | |
7666 | this->enabled = 1; | |
7667 | this->disabled_by_cond = false; | |
7668 | ||
7669 | this->loc_type = type; | |
7670 | ||
7671 | if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
7672 | || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
7673 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this); | |
7674 | ||
7675 | incref (); | |
7676 | } | |
7677 | ||
7678 | bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner) | |
7679 | : bp_location::bp_location (owner, | |
7680 | bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type)) | |
7681 | { | |
7682 | } | |
7683 | ||
7684 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
7685 | ||
7686 | std::string | |
7687 | bp_location::to_string () const | |
7688 | { | |
7689 | string_file stb; | |
7690 | ui_out_redirect_pop redir (current_uiout, &stb); | |
7691 | print_breakpoint_location (this->owner, this); | |
7692 | return stb.release (); | |
7693 | } | |
7694 | ||
7695 | /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0, | |
7696 | destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */ | |
7697 | ||
7698 | static void | |
7699 | decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp) | |
7700 | { | |
7701 | bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp); | |
7702 | *blp = NULL; | |
7703 | } | |
7704 | ||
7705 | /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */ | |
7706 | ||
7707 | static breakpoint * | |
7708 | add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b) | |
7709 | { | |
7710 | /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of | |
7711 | breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */ | |
7712 | ||
7713 | breakpoint_chain.push_back (*b.release ()); | |
7714 | ||
7715 | return &breakpoint_chain.back (); | |
7716 | } | |
7717 | ||
7718 | /* Initialize loc->function_name. */ | |
7719 | ||
7720 | static void | |
7721 | set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc) | |
7722 | { | |
7723 | gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL); | |
7724 | ||
7725 | if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint | |
7726 | || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | |
7727 | || is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | |
7728 | { | |
7729 | const char *function_name; | |
7730 | ||
7731 | if (loc->msymbol != NULL | |
7732 | && (loc->msymbol->type () == mst_text_gnu_ifunc | |
7733 | || loc->msymbol->type () == mst_data_gnu_ifunc)) | |
7734 | { | |
7735 | struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | |
7736 | ||
7737 | function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name (); | |
7738 | ||
7739 | if (b->type == bp_breakpoint | |
7740 | && b->has_single_location () | |
7741 | && b->related_breakpoint == b) | |
7742 | { | |
7743 | /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not | |
7744 | mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */ | |
7745 | b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver; | |
7746 | /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return | |
7747 | breakpoint. */ | |
7748 | loc->related_address = loc->address; | |
7749 | } | |
7750 | } | |
7751 | else | |
7752 | find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL); | |
7753 | ||
7754 | if (function_name) | |
7755 | loc->function_name = make_unique_xstrdup (function_name); | |
7756 | } | |
7757 | } | |
7758 | ||
7759 | /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */ | |
7760 | struct gdbarch * | |
7761 | get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal) | |
7762 | { | |
7763 | if (sal.section) | |
7764 | return sal.section->objfile->arch (); | |
7765 | if (sal.symtab) | |
7766 | return sal.symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()->arch (); | |
7767 | ||
7768 | return NULL; | |
7769 | } | |
7770 | ||
7771 | /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint | |
7772 | if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which | |
7773 | initiated the operation. */ | |
7774 | ||
7775 | void | |
7776 | set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame) | |
7777 | { | |
7778 | int thread = tp->global_num; | |
7779 | ||
7780 | /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step, | |
7781 | we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled | |
7782 | longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary | |
7783 | clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */ | |
7784 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
7785 | if (b.pspace == current_program_space | |
7786 | && (b.type == bp_longjmp_master | |
7787 | || b.type == bp_exception_master)) | |
7788 | { | |
7789 | bptype type = b.type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception; | |
7790 | /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again | |
7791 | after their removal. */ | |
7792 | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, type, 1, thread); | |
7793 | } | |
7794 | ||
7795 | tp->initiating_frame = frame; | |
7796 | } | |
7797 | ||
7798 | /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */ | |
7799 | void | |
7800 | delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread) | |
7801 | { | |
7802 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
7803 | if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_exception) | |
7804 | { | |
7805 | if (b.thread == thread) | |
7806 | { | |
7807 | gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | |
7808 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
7809 | } | |
7810 | } | |
7811 | } | |
7812 | ||
7813 | void | |
7814 | delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread) | |
7815 | { | |
7816 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
7817 | if (b.type == bp_longjmp || b.type == bp_exception) | |
7818 | { | |
7819 | if (b.thread == thread) | |
7820 | { | |
7821 | gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | |
7822 | b.disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | |
7823 | } | |
7824 | } | |
7825 | } | |
7826 | ||
7827 | /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for | |
7828 | INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return | |
7829 | pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp | |
7830 | breakpoints. */ | |
7831 | ||
7832 | struct breakpoint * | |
7833 | set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void) | |
7834 | { | |
7835 | breakpoint *retval = nullptr; | |
7836 | ||
7837 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7838 | if (b.pspace == current_program_space && b.type == bp_longjmp_master) | |
7839 | { | |
7840 | int thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; | |
7841 | breakpoint *new_b | |
7842 | = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy, | |
7843 | 1, thread); | |
7844 | ||
7845 | /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */ | |
7846 | ||
7847 | gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b); | |
7848 | if (retval == NULL) | |
7849 | retval = new_b; | |
7850 | new_b->related_breakpoint = retval; | |
7851 | while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint) | |
7852 | retval = retval->related_breakpoint; | |
7853 | retval->related_breakpoint = new_b; | |
7854 | } | |
7855 | ||
7856 | return retval; | |
7857 | } | |
7858 | ||
7859 | /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for | |
7860 | TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame | |
7861 | stack. | |
7862 | ||
7863 | If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard | |
7864 | dummy frames. In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will | |
7865 | be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where | |
7866 | unwinding is possible. */ | |
7867 | ||
7868 | void | |
7869 | check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp) | |
7870 | { | |
7871 | /* We would need to delete breakpoints other than the current one while | |
7872 | iterating, so all_breakpoints_safe is not sufficient to make that safe. | |
7873 | Save all breakpoints to delete in that set and delete them at the end. */ | |
7874 | gdb::unordered_set<breakpoint *> to_delete; | |
7875 | ||
7876 | for (struct breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7877 | { | |
7878 | if (b.type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b.thread == tp->global_num) | |
7879 | { | |
7880 | gdb_assert (b.inferior == -1); | |
7881 | struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b.related_breakpoint; | |
7882 | ||
7883 | /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints | |
7884 | chained off b->related_breakpoint. */ | |
7885 | while (dummy_b != &b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy) | |
7886 | dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint; | |
7887 | ||
7888 | /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing | |
7889 | more to do. Or, if the dummy frame associated with the | |
7890 | bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this | |
7891 | bp_call_dummy in place. */ | |
7892 | if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy | |
7893 | || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL) | |
7894 | continue; | |
7895 | ||
7896 | /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be | |
7897 | because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to | |
7898 | the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is | |
7899 | broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy | |
7900 | frame. | |
7901 | ||
7902 | Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped. If it looks | |
7903 | like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has | |
7904 | been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an | |
7905 | unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently | |
7906 | broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy | |
7907 | frame. | |
7908 | ||
7909 | It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but | |
7910 | that is not safe. There is no guarantee that the stack frames | |
7911 | we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the | |
7912 | original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used. See | |
7913 | the comments on frame_id_inner for more details. */ | |
7914 | bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false; | |
7915 | for (frame_info_ptr fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; ) | |
7916 | { | |
7917 | frame_info_ptr prev = get_prev_frame (fi); | |
7918 | if (prev == nullptr) | |
7919 | { | |
7920 | /* FI is the last stack frame. Why did this frame not | |
7921 | unwind further? */ | |
7922 | auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi); | |
7923 | if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON | |
7924 | && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST) | |
7925 | unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true; | |
7926 | } | |
7927 | fi = prev; | |
7928 | } | |
7929 | if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly) | |
7930 | continue; | |
7931 | ||
7932 | dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp); | |
7933 | ||
7934 | for (breakpoint *related_breakpoint = b.related_breakpoint; | |
7935 | related_breakpoint != &b; | |
7936 | related_breakpoint = related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint) | |
7937 | to_delete.insert (b.related_breakpoint); | |
7938 | ||
7939 | to_delete.insert (&b); | |
7940 | } | |
7941 | } | |
7942 | ||
7943 | for (breakpoint *b : to_delete) | |
7944 | delete_breakpoint (b); | |
7945 | } | |
7946 | ||
7947 | void | |
7948 | enable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | |
7949 | { | |
7950 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7951 | if (b.type == bp_overlay_event) | |
7952 | { | |
7953 | b.enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
7954 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
7955 | overlay_events_enabled = 1; | |
7956 | } | |
7957 | } | |
7958 | ||
7959 | void | |
7960 | disable_overlay_breakpoints (void) | |
7961 | { | |
7962 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
7963 | if (b.type == bp_overlay_event) | |
7964 | { | |
7965 | b.enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
7966 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
7967 | overlay_events_enabled = 0; | |
7968 | } | |
7969 | } | |
7970 | ||
7971 | /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate | |
7972 | master breakpoint. */ | |
7973 | void | |
7974 | set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | |
7975 | { | |
7976 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
7977 | if (b.pspace == current_program_space | |
7978 | && b.type == bp_std_terminate_master) | |
7979 | { | |
7980 | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (&b, bp_std_terminate, 1, | |
7981 | inferior_thread ()->global_num); | |
7982 | } | |
7983 | } | |
7984 | ||
7985 | /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */ | |
7986 | void | |
7987 | delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void) | |
7988 | { | |
7989 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
7990 | if (b.type == bp_std_terminate) | |
7991 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
7992 | } | |
7993 | ||
7994 | struct breakpoint * | |
7995 | create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | |
7996 | { | |
7997 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
7998 | ||
7999 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event); | |
8000 | ||
8001 | b->enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
8002 | /* locspec has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */ | |
8003 | b->locspec = new_address_location_spec (b->first_loc ().address, NULL, 0); | |
8004 | ||
8005 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
8006 | ||
8007 | return b; | |
8008 | } | |
8009 | ||
8010 | struct lang_and_radix | |
8011 | { | |
8012 | enum language lang; | |
8013 | int radix; | |
8014 | }; | |
8015 | ||
8016 | /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */ | |
8017 | ||
8018 | struct breakpoint * | |
8019 | create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | |
8020 | { | |
8021 | return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event); | |
8022 | } | |
8023 | ||
8024 | /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */ | |
8025 | ||
8026 | void | |
8027 | remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void) | |
8028 | { | |
8029 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
8030 | if (b.type == bp_jit_event | |
8031 | && b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | |
8032 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
8033 | } | |
8034 | ||
8035 | void | |
8036 | remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void) | |
8037 | { | |
8038 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
8039 | if (b.type == bp_shlib_event | |
8040 | && b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | |
8041 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
8042 | } | |
8043 | ||
8044 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
8045 | ||
8046 | void | |
8047 | remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void) | |
8048 | { | |
8049 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
8050 | if (b.type == bp_shlib_event | |
8051 | && b.first_loc ().pspace == current_program_space) | |
8052 | b.disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop; | |
8053 | } | |
8054 | ||
8055 | /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint / | |
8056 | create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which | |
8057 | INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */ | |
8058 | ||
8059 | static struct breakpoint * | |
8060 | create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address, | |
8061 | enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | |
8062 | { | |
8063 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
8064 | ||
8065 | b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event); | |
8066 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode); | |
8067 | return b; | |
8068 | } | |
8069 | ||
8070 | struct breakpoint * | |
8071 | create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | |
8072 | { | |
8073 | return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
8074 | } | |
8075 | ||
8076 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
8077 | ||
8078 | struct breakpoint * | |
8079 | create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address) | |
8080 | { | |
8081 | struct breakpoint *b; | |
8082 | ||
8083 | /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert | |
8084 | locations. */ | |
8085 | b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT); | |
8086 | if (!b->first_loc ().inserted) | |
8087 | { | |
8088 | delete_breakpoint (b); | |
8089 | return NULL; | |
8090 | } | |
8091 | return b; | |
8092 | } | |
8093 | ||
8094 | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon | |
8095 | notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | |
8096 | disabled ones can just stay disabled. | |
8097 | ||
8098 | When STILL_IN_USE is true, SOLIB hasn't really been unmapped from | |
8099 | the inferior. In this case, don't disable anything. | |
8100 | ||
8101 | When SILENT is false notify the user if any breakpoints are disabled, | |
8102 | otherwise, still disable the breakpoints, but don't tell the user. */ | |
8103 | ||
8104 | static void | |
8105 | disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (program_space *pspace, const solib &solib, | |
8106 | bool still_in_use, bool silent) | |
8107 | { | |
8108 | if (still_in_use) | |
8109 | return; | |
8110 | ||
8111 | bool disabled_shlib_breaks = false; | |
8112 | ||
8113 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8114 | { | |
8115 | bool bp_modified = false; | |
8116 | ||
8117 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
8118 | { | |
8119 | if (pspace != loc.pspace || loc.shlib_disabled) | |
8120 | continue; | |
8121 | ||
8122 | if (loc.loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
8123 | && loc.loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
8124 | && !is_tracepoint (&b)) | |
8125 | continue; | |
8126 | ||
8127 | if (!solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc.address)) | |
8128 | continue; | |
8129 | ||
8130 | loc.shlib_disabled = 1; | |
8131 | ||
8132 | /* At this point, we don't know whether the shared library | |
8133 | was unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the | |
8134 | inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to uninsert | |
8135 | quietly, in case the library was indeed unmapped. | |
8136 | ||
8137 | The test gdb.base/nostdlib.exp when run on AArch64 | |
8138 | GNU/Linux using glibc will cause the dynamic linker to be | |
8139 | unloaded from the inferior, but the linker will never be | |
8140 | unmapped. Additionally, at the time the dynamic linker | |
8141 | is unloaded the inferior will be stopped within the | |
8142 | dynamic linker. | |
8143 | ||
8144 | If we clear the inserted flag here then GDB will fail to | |
8145 | remove the internal breakpoints from the dynamic linker | |
8146 | leading to unexpected SIGTRAPs. */ | |
8147 | ||
8148 | bp_modified = true; | |
8149 | ||
8150 | if (!disabled_shlib_breaks && !silent && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
8151 | { | |
8152 | target_terminal::ours_for_output (); | |
8153 | warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints " | |
8154 | "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""), | |
8155 | solib.name.c_str ()); | |
8156 | disabled_shlib_breaks = true; | |
8157 | } | |
8158 | } | |
8159 | ||
8160 | if (bp_modified) | |
8161 | notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | |
8162 | } | |
8163 | } | |
8164 | ||
8165 | /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon | |
8166 | notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints, | |
8167 | disabled ones can just stay disabled. */ | |
8168 | ||
8169 | static void | |
8170 | disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | |
8171 | { | |
8172 | /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually | |
8173 | managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file. | |
8174 | Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in | |
8175 | response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules | |
8176 | shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global | |
8177 | location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user | |
8178 | aren't handled here -- they're already handled in | |
8179 | disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's | |
8180 | solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not | |
8181 | OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the | |
8182 | main objfile). */ | |
8183 | if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0 | |
8184 | || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0) | |
8185 | return; | |
8186 | ||
8187 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8188 | { | |
8189 | bool bp_modified = false; | |
8190 | ||
8191 | if (!is_breakpoint (&b) && !is_tracepoint (&b)) | |
8192 | continue; | |
8193 | ||
8194 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
8195 | { | |
8196 | CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc.address; | |
8197 | ||
8198 | if (loc.loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
8199 | && loc.loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint) | |
8200 | continue; | |
8201 | ||
8202 | if (loc.shlib_disabled != 0) | |
8203 | continue; | |
8204 | ||
8205 | if (objfile->pspace () != loc.pspace) | |
8206 | continue; | |
8207 | ||
8208 | if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile)) | |
8209 | { | |
8210 | loc.shlib_disabled = 1; | |
8211 | /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was | |
8212 | unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the | |
8213 | inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to | |
8214 | uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed | |
8215 | unmapped. */ | |
8216 | ||
8217 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (&loc); | |
8218 | ||
8219 | bp_modified = true; | |
8220 | } | |
8221 | } | |
8222 | ||
8223 | if (bp_modified) | |
8224 | notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | |
8225 | } | |
8226 | } | |
8227 | ||
8228 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
8229 | ||
8230 | breakpoint::breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, enum bptype bptype, | |
8231 | bool temp, const char *cond_string_) | |
8232 | : type (bptype), | |
8233 | disposition (temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch), | |
8234 | gdbarch (gdbarch_), | |
8235 | language (current_language->la_language), | |
8236 | input_radix (::input_radix), | |
8237 | cond_string (cond_string_ != nullptr | |
8238 | ? make_unique_xstrdup (cond_string_) | |
8239 | : nullptr), | |
8240 | related_breakpoint (this) | |
8241 | { | |
8242 | } | |
8243 | ||
8244 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
8245 | ||
8246 | catchpoint::catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp, | |
8247 | const char *cond_string) | |
8248 | : breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_catchpoint, temp, cond_string) | |
8249 | { | |
8250 | add_dummy_location (this, current_program_space); | |
8251 | ||
8252 | pspace = current_program_space; | |
8253 | } | |
8254 | ||
8255 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
8256 | ||
8257 | void | |
8258 | catchpoint::re_set (program_space *filter_pspace) | |
8259 | { | |
8260 | /* All catchpoints are associated with a specific program_space. */ | |
8261 | gdb_assert (pspace != nullptr); | |
8262 | ||
8263 | /* If only a single program space changed, and it's not the program space | |
8264 | for which this catchpoint applies, then there's nothing to do. */ | |
8265 | if (filter_pspace != nullptr && filter_pspace != pspace) | |
8266 | return; | |
8267 | ||
8268 | /* Catchpoints have a single dummy location. */ | |
8269 | gdb_assert (locations ().size () == 1); | |
8270 | bp_location &bl = m_locations.front (); | |
8271 | ||
8272 | if (cond_string == nullptr) | |
8273 | { | |
8274 | /* It shouldn't be possible to have a parsed condition expression | |
8275 | cached on this location if the catchpoint doesn't have a condition | |
8276 | string set. */ | |
8277 | gdb_assert (bl.cond == nullptr); | |
8278 | ||
8279 | /* Nothing to re-compute, and the catchpoint cannot change. */ | |
8280 | return; | |
8281 | } | |
8282 | ||
8283 | bool previous_disabled_by_cond = bl.disabled_by_cond; | |
8284 | ||
8285 | /* Start by marking the location disabled and discarding the previously | |
8286 | computed condition expression. Now if we get an exception, even if | |
8287 | it's a quit exception, we'll leave the location disabled and there | |
8288 | will be no (possibly invalid) expression cached. */ | |
8289 | bl.disabled_by_cond = true; | |
8290 | bl.cond = nullptr; | |
8291 | ||
8292 | const char *s = cond_string.get (); | |
8293 | try | |
8294 | { | |
8295 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (pspace); | |
8296 | ||
8297 | bl.cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl.address, block_for_pc (bl.address), | |
8298 | nullptr); | |
8299 | bl.disabled_by_cond = false; | |
8300 | } | |
8301 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
8302 | { | |
8303 | /* Any exception thrown must be from either the parse_exp_1 or | |
8304 | earlier in the try block. As such the following two asserts | |
8305 | should be true. */ | |
8306 | gdb_assert (bl.disabled_by_cond); | |
8307 | gdb_assert (bl.cond == nullptr); | |
8308 | } | |
8309 | ||
8310 | if (previous_disabled_by_cond != bl.disabled_by_cond) | |
8311 | notify_breakpoint_modified (this); | |
8312 | } | |
8313 | ||
8314 | /* Notify interpreters and observers that breakpoint B was created. */ | |
8315 | ||
8316 | static void | |
8317 | notify_breakpoint_created (breakpoint *b) | |
8318 | { | |
8319 | interps_notify_breakpoint_created (b); | |
8320 | gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b); | |
8321 | } | |
8322 | ||
8323 | breakpoint * | |
8324 | install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll) | |
8325 | { | |
8326 | breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg)); | |
8327 | set_breakpoint_number (internal, b); | |
8328 | if (is_tracepoint (b)) | |
8329 | set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count); | |
8330 | if (!internal) | |
8331 | mention (b); | |
8332 | ||
8333 | notify_breakpoint_created (b); | |
8334 | ||
8335 | if (update_gll) | |
8336 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
8337 | ||
8338 | return b; | |
8339 | } | |
8340 | ||
8341 | static int | |
8342 | hw_breakpoint_used_count (void) | |
8343 | { | |
8344 | int i = 0; | |
8345 | ||
8346 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8347 | if (b.type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | |
8348 | for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | |
8349 | { | |
8350 | /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than | |
8351 | one register. */ | |
8352 | i += b.resources_needed (&bl); | |
8353 | } | |
8354 | ||
8355 | return i; | |
8356 | } | |
8357 | ||
8358 | /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware | |
8359 | watchpoint. */ | |
8360 | ||
8361 | static int | |
8362 | hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b) | |
8363 | { | |
8364 | int i = 0; | |
8365 | ||
8366 | if (!breakpoint_enabled (b)) | |
8367 | return 0; | |
8368 | ||
8369 | for (bp_location &bl : b->locations ()) | |
8370 | { | |
8371 | /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than | |
8372 | one register. */ | |
8373 | i += b->resources_needed (&bl); | |
8374 | } | |
8375 | ||
8376 | return i; | |
8377 | } | |
8378 | ||
8379 | /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of | |
8380 | type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED | |
8381 | the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other | |
8382 | types _not_ TYPE. */ | |
8383 | ||
8384 | static int | |
8385 | hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except, | |
8386 | enum bptype type, int *other_type_used) | |
8387 | { | |
8388 | int i = 0; | |
8389 | ||
8390 | *other_type_used = 0; | |
8391 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8392 | { | |
8393 | if (&b == except) | |
8394 | continue; | |
8395 | if (!breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | |
8396 | continue; | |
8397 | ||
8398 | if (b.type == type) | |
8399 | i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b); | |
8400 | else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (&b)) | |
8401 | *other_type_used = 1; | |
8402 | } | |
8403 | ||
8404 | return i; | |
8405 | } | |
8406 | ||
8407 | void | |
8408 | disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void) | |
8409 | { | |
8410 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8411 | if (is_watchpoint (&b) && breakpoint_enabled (&b)) | |
8412 | { | |
8413 | b.enable_state = bp_call_disabled; | |
8414 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
8415 | } | |
8416 | } | |
8417 | ||
8418 | void | |
8419 | enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void) | |
8420 | { | |
8421 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8422 | if (is_watchpoint (&b) && b.enable_state == bp_call_disabled) | |
8423 | { | |
8424 | b.enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
8425 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
8426 | } | |
8427 | } | |
8428 | ||
8429 | void | |
8430 | disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void) | |
8431 | { | |
8432 | current_program_space->executing_startup = 1; | |
8433 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
8434 | } | |
8435 | ||
8436 | void | |
8437 | enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void) | |
8438 | { | |
8439 | current_program_space->executing_startup = 0; | |
8440 | breakpoint_re_set (); | |
8441 | } | |
8442 | ||
8443 | /* Allocate a new momentary breakpoint. */ | |
8444 | ||
8445 | template<typename... Arg> | |
8446 | static momentary_breakpoint * | |
8447 | new_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, enum bptype type, | |
8448 | Arg&&... args) | |
8449 | { | |
8450 | if (type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception) | |
8451 | return new longjmp_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | |
8452 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
8453 | else | |
8454 | return new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, | |
8455 | std::forward<Arg> (args)...); | |
8456 | } | |
8457 | ||
8458 | /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by | |
8459 | SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that | |
8460 | frame. */ | |
8461 | ||
8462 | breakpoint_up | |
8463 | set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal, | |
8464 | struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type) | |
8465 | { | |
8466 | /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or | |
8467 | tail-called one. */ | |
8468 | gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id)); | |
8469 | ||
8470 | std::unique_ptr<momentary_breakpoint> b | |
8471 | (new_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, type, sal.pspace, frame_id, | |
8472 | inferior_thread ()->global_num)); | |
8473 | ||
8474 | b->add_location (sal); | |
8475 | ||
8476 | breakpoint_up bp (add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b))); | |
8477 | ||
8478 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
8479 | ||
8480 | return bp; | |
8481 | } | |
8482 | ||
8483 | /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG. | |
8484 | The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its | |
8485 | breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */ | |
8486 | ||
8487 | static struct breakpoint * | |
8488 | momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig, | |
8489 | enum bptype type, | |
8490 | int loc_enabled, | |
8491 | int thread) | |
8492 | { | |
8493 | std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> copy | |
8494 | (new_momentary_breakpoint (orig->gdbarch, type, orig->pspace, | |
8495 | orig->frame_id, thread)); | |
8496 | const bp_location &orig_loc = orig->first_loc (); | |
8497 | bp_location *copy_loc = copy->allocate_location (); | |
8498 | copy->add_location (*copy_loc); | |
8499 | set_breakpoint_location_function (copy_loc); | |
8500 | ||
8501 | copy_loc->gdbarch = orig_loc.gdbarch; | |
8502 | copy_loc->requested_address = orig_loc.requested_address; | |
8503 | copy_loc->address = orig_loc.address; | |
8504 | copy_loc->section = orig_loc.section; | |
8505 | copy_loc->pspace = orig_loc.pspace; | |
8506 | copy_loc->probe = orig_loc.probe; | |
8507 | copy_loc->line_number = orig_loc.line_number; | |
8508 | copy_loc->symtab = orig_loc.symtab; | |
8509 | copy_loc->enabled = loc_enabled; | |
8510 | ||
8511 | breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (copy)); | |
8512 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
8513 | return b; | |
8514 | } | |
8515 | ||
8516 | /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if | |
8517 | ORIG is NULL. */ | |
8518 | ||
8519 | struct breakpoint * | |
8520 | clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig) | |
8521 | { | |
8522 | /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */ | |
8523 | if (orig == NULL) | |
8524 | return NULL; | |
8525 | ||
8526 | return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, 0, | |
8527 | orig->thread); | |
8528 | } | |
8529 | ||
8530 | breakpoint_up | |
8531 | set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc, | |
8532 | enum bptype type) | |
8533 | { | |
8534 | struct symtab_and_line sal; | |
8535 | ||
8536 | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | |
8537 | sal.pc = pc; | |
8538 | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | |
8539 | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | |
8540 | ||
8541 | return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type); | |
8542 | } | |
8543 | \f | |
8544 | ||
8545 | /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */ | |
8546 | ||
8547 | static void | |
8548 | mention (const breakpoint *b) | |
8549 | { | |
8550 | b->print_mention (); | |
8551 | current_uiout->text ("\n"); | |
8552 | } | |
8553 | \f | |
8554 | ||
8555 | static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc); | |
8556 | ||
8557 | /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on". | |
8558 | ||
8559 | If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware | |
8560 | breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint | |
8561 | address is in read-only memory. | |
8562 | ||
8563 | - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only. | |
8564 | We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint. | |
8565 | ||
8566 | - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This | |
8567 | means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the | |
8568 | memory map changed, so we undo. | |
8569 | */ | |
8570 | ||
8571 | static void | |
8572 | handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl) | |
8573 | { | |
8574 | if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints | |
8575 | && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint | |
8576 | && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint | |
8577 | || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)) | |
8578 | { | |
8579 | /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use | |
8580 | location types we've just set here, the only possible problem | |
8581 | is that memory map has changed during running program, but | |
8582 | it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */ | |
8583 | mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address); | |
8584 | ||
8585 | if (mr != nullptr) | |
8586 | { | |
8587 | enum bp_loc_type new_type; | |
8588 | ||
8589 | if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW) | |
8590 | new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint; | |
8591 | else | |
8592 | new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint; | |
8593 | ||
8594 | if (new_type != bl->loc_type) | |
8595 | { | |
8596 | static bool said = false; | |
8597 | ||
8598 | bl->loc_type = new_type; | |
8599 | if (!said) | |
8600 | { | |
8601 | gdb_printf (_("Note: automatically using " | |
8602 | "hardware breakpoints for " | |
8603 | "read-only addresses.\n")); | |
8604 | said = true; | |
8605 | } | |
8606 | } | |
8607 | } | |
8608 | } | |
8609 | } | |
8610 | ||
8611 | bp_location * | |
8612 | code_breakpoint::add_location (const symtab_and_line &sal) | |
8613 | { | |
8614 | CORE_ADDR adjusted_address; | |
8615 | struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | |
8616 | ||
8617 | if (loc_gdbarch == NULL) | |
8618 | loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | |
8619 | ||
8620 | /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location. | |
8621 | Once we call allocate_location(), that mostly uninitialized | |
8622 | location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the | |
8623 | breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do | |
8624 | not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and | |
8625 | location that's only been partially initialized. */ | |
8626 | adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch, | |
8627 | sal.pc, type, | |
8628 | sal.pspace); | |
8629 | ||
8630 | /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */ | |
8631 | bp_location *new_loc = this->allocate_location (); | |
8632 | ||
8633 | new_loc->requested_address = sal.pc; | |
8634 | new_loc->address = adjusted_address; | |
8635 | new_loc->pspace = sal.pspace; | |
8636 | new_loc->probe.prob = sal.prob; | |
8637 | new_loc->probe.objfile = sal.objfile; | |
8638 | gdb_assert (new_loc->pspace != NULL); | |
8639 | new_loc->section = sal.section; | |
8640 | new_loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch; | |
8641 | new_loc->line_number = sal.line; | |
8642 | new_loc->symtab = sal.symtab; | |
8643 | new_loc->symbol = sal.symbol; | |
8644 | new_loc->msymbol = sal.msymbol; | |
8645 | ||
8646 | breakpoint::add_location (*new_loc); | |
8647 | ||
8648 | set_breakpoint_location_function (new_loc); | |
8649 | ||
8650 | /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the | |
8651 | code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect | |
8652 | that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program, | |
8653 | thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing | |
8654 | the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a | |
8655 | SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the | |
8656 | instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies | |
8657 | with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the | |
8658 | breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB | |
8659 | breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed. | |
8660 | (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint, | |
8661 | it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint | |
8662 | instruction.) */ | |
8663 | if (bp_loc_is_permanent (new_loc)) | |
8664 | new_loc->permanent = 1; | |
8665 | ||
8666 | return new_loc; | |
8667 | } | |
8668 | \f | |
8669 | ||
8670 | /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint, | |
8671 | return false otherwise. */ | |
8672 | ||
8673 | static bool | |
8674 | bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc) | |
8675 | { | |
8676 | gdb_assert (loc != NULL); | |
8677 | ||
8678 | /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software | |
8679 | watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from | |
8680 | the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to. | |
8681 | gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read | |
8682 | memory. */ | |
8683 | if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)) | |
8684 | return false; | |
8685 | ||
8686 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
8687 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace); | |
8688 | return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address); | |
8689 | } | |
8690 | ||
8691 | /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current | |
8692 | settings of the dprintf style options. */ | |
8693 | ||
8694 | static void | |
8695 | update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b) | |
8696 | { | |
8697 | gdb_assert (b->type == bp_dprintf); | |
8698 | gdb_assert (b->extra_string != nullptr); | |
8699 | ||
8700 | const char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string.get (); | |
8701 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> printf_line = nullptr; | |
8702 | ||
8703 | /* Trying to create a dprintf breakpoint without a format and args | |
8704 | string should be detected at creation time. */ | |
8705 | gdb_assert (dprintf_args != nullptr); | |
8706 | ||
8707 | dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | |
8708 | ||
8709 | /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't | |
8710 | insist on it. */ | |
8711 | if (*dprintf_args == ',') | |
8712 | ++dprintf_args; | |
8713 | dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args); | |
8714 | ||
8715 | if (*dprintf_args != '"') | |
8716 | error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'.")); | |
8717 | ||
8718 | if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0) | |
8719 | printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | |
8720 | else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0) | |
8721 | { | |
8722 | if (dprintf_function.empty ()) | |
8723 | error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call")); | |
8724 | ||
8725 | if (!dprintf_channel.empty ()) | |
8726 | printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)", | |
8727 | dprintf_function.c_str (), | |
8728 | dprintf_channel.c_str (), | |
8729 | dprintf_args); | |
8730 | else | |
8731 | printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)", | |
8732 | dprintf_function.c_str (), | |
8733 | dprintf_args); | |
8734 | } | |
8735 | else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0) | |
8736 | { | |
8737 | if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | |
8738 | printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args); | |
8739 | else | |
8740 | { | |
8741 | warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf")); | |
8742 | printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args); | |
8743 | } | |
8744 | } | |
8745 | else | |
8746 | internal_error (_("Invalid dprintf style.")); | |
8747 | ||
8748 | gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL); | |
8749 | ||
8750 | /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */ | |
8751 | struct command_line *printf_cmd_line | |
8752 | = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line.release ()); | |
8753 | breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line, | |
8754 | command_lines_deleter ())); | |
8755 | } | |
8756 | ||
8757 | /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect | |
8758 | current style settings. */ | |
8759 | ||
8760 | static void | |
8761 | update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty, | |
8762 | struct cmd_list_element *c) | |
8763 | { | |
8764 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
8765 | if (b.type == bp_dprintf) | |
8766 | update_dprintf_command_list (&b); | |
8767 | } | |
8768 | ||
8769 | code_breakpoint::code_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch_, | |
8770 | enum bptype type_, | |
8771 | gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | |
8772 | location_spec_up &&locspec_, | |
8773 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_, | |
8774 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_, | |
8775 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_, | |
8776 | enum bpdisp disposition_, | |
8777 | int thread_, int task_, int inferior_, | |
8778 | int ignore_count_, | |
8779 | int from_tty, | |
8780 | int enabled_, unsigned flags, | |
8781 | int display_canonical_) | |
8782 | : breakpoint (gdbarch_, type_) | |
8783 | { | |
8784 | int i; | |
8785 | ||
8786 | if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | |
8787 | { | |
8788 | int target_resources_ok; | |
8789 | ||
8790 | i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | |
8791 | target_resources_ok = | |
8792 | target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | |
8793 | i + 1, 0); | |
8794 | if (target_resources_ok == 0) | |
8795 | error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | |
8796 | else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | |
8797 | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | |
8798 | } | |
8799 | ||
8800 | gdb_assert (!sals.empty ()); | |
8801 | ||
8802 | /* At most one of thread, task, or inferior can be set on any breakpoint. */ | |
8803 | gdb_assert (((thread == -1 ? 0 : 1) | |
8804 | + (task == -1 ? 0 : 1) | |
8805 | + (inferior == -1 ? 0 : 1)) <= 1); | |
8806 | ||
8807 | thread = thread_; | |
8808 | task = task_; | |
8809 | inferior = inferior_; | |
8810 | ||
8811 | cond_string = std::move (cond_string_); | |
8812 | extra_string = std::move (extra_string_); | |
8813 | ignore_count = ignore_count_; | |
8814 | enable_state = enabled_ ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | |
8815 | disposition = disposition_; | |
8816 | ||
8817 | if (type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
8818 | || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | |
8819 | { | |
8820 | auto *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (this); | |
8821 | struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | |
8822 | ||
8823 | if (strace_marker_p (this)) | |
8824 | { | |
8825 | /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we wouldn't | |
8826 | see a sal for it. */ | |
8827 | const char *p = &locspec_->to_string ()[3]; | |
8828 | const char *endp; | |
8829 | ||
8830 | p = skip_spaces (p); | |
8831 | ||
8832 | endp = skip_to_space (p); | |
8833 | ||
8834 | t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p); | |
8835 | ||
8836 | gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), | |
8837 | t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | |
8838 | } | |
8839 | else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sals[0].pc, &marker)) | |
8840 | { | |
8841 | t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); | |
8842 | ||
8843 | gdb_printf (_("Probed static tracepoint marker \"%s\"\n"), | |
8844 | t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | |
8845 | } | |
8846 | else | |
8847 | warning (_("Couldn't determine the static tracepoint marker to probe")); | |
8848 | } | |
8849 | ||
8850 | for (const auto &sal : sals) | |
8851 | { | |
8852 | if (from_tty) | |
8853 | { | |
8854 | struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | |
8855 | if (loc_gdbarch == nullptr) | |
8856 | loc_gdbarch = gdbarch; | |
8857 | ||
8858 | describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch, | |
8859 | sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread); | |
8860 | } | |
8861 | ||
8862 | bp_location *new_loc = add_location (sal); | |
8863 | if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0) | |
8864 | new_loc->inserted = 1; | |
8865 | ||
8866 | /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet. As locations | |
8867 | are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses. Let | |
8868 | the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers. */ | |
8869 | } | |
8870 | ||
8871 | /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the | |
8872 | command line, otherwise it's an error. */ | |
8873 | if (type == bp_dprintf) | |
8874 | update_dprintf_command_list (this); | |
8875 | else | |
8876 | gdb_assert (extra_string == nullptr); | |
8877 | ||
8878 | /* The order of the locations is now stable. Set the location | |
8879 | condition using the location's number. */ | |
8880 | int loc_num = 1; | |
8881 | for (bp_location &bl : locations ()) | |
8882 | { | |
8883 | if (cond_string != nullptr) | |
8884 | set_breakpoint_location_condition (cond_string.get (), &bl, | |
8885 | number, loc_num); | |
8886 | ||
8887 | ++loc_num; | |
8888 | } | |
8889 | ||
8890 | display_canonical = display_canonical_; | |
8891 | if (locspec_ != nullptr) | |
8892 | locspec = std::move (locspec_); | |
8893 | else | |
8894 | locspec = new_address_location_spec (this->first_loc ().address, NULL, 0); | |
8895 | filter = std::move (filter_); | |
8896 | } | |
8897 | ||
8898 | static void | |
8899 | create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
8900 | gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | |
8901 | location_spec_up &&locspec, | |
8902 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter, | |
8903 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | |
8904 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | |
8905 | enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | |
8906 | int thread, int task, int inferior, int ignore_count, | |
8907 | int from_tty, | |
8908 | int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags, | |
8909 | int display_canonical) | |
8910 | { | |
8911 | std::unique_ptr<code_breakpoint> b | |
8912 | = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, | |
8913 | type, | |
8914 | sals, | |
8915 | std::move (locspec), | |
8916 | std::move (filter), | |
8917 | std::move (cond_string), | |
8918 | std::move (extra_string), | |
8919 | disposition, | |
8920 | thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | |
8921 | from_tty, | |
8922 | enabled, flags, | |
8923 | display_canonical); | |
8924 | ||
8925 | install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); | |
8926 | } | |
8927 | ||
8928 | /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each | |
8929 | SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i] | |
8930 | value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be | |
8931 | used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where | |
8932 | SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded | |
8933 | function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify | |
8934 | separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so | |
8935 | we take just a single condition string. | |
8936 | ||
8937 | NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup | |
8938 | the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the | |
8939 | array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the | |
8940 | caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, | |
8941 | COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */ | |
8942 | ||
8943 | static void | |
8944 | create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
8945 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
8946 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | |
8947 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | |
8948 | enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition, | |
8949 | int thread, int task, int inferior, | |
8950 | int ignore_count, | |
8951 | int from_tty, | |
8952 | int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags) | |
8953 | { | |
8954 | if (canonical->pre_expanded) | |
8955 | gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1); | |
8956 | ||
8957 | for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals) | |
8958 | { | |
8959 | /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain | |
8960 | 'break', without arguments. */ | |
8961 | location_spec_up locspec | |
8962 | = (canonical->locspec != nullptr | |
8963 | ? canonical->locspec->clone () | |
8964 | : nullptr); | |
8965 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string | |
8966 | (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL); | |
8967 | ||
8968 | create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals, | |
8969 | std::move (locspec), | |
8970 | std::move (filter_string), | |
8971 | std::move (cond_string), | |
8972 | std::move (extra_string), | |
8973 | type, disposition, | |
8974 | thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | |
8975 | from_tty, enabled, internal, flags, | |
8976 | canonical->special_display); | |
8977 | } | |
8978 | } | |
8979 | ||
8980 | /* Parse LOCSPEC which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly | |
8981 | followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL | |
8982 | addresses found. LOCSPEC points to the end of the SAL (for | |
8983 | linespec locspecs). | |
8984 | ||
8985 | The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is | |
8986 | the caller's responsibility to free them. */ | |
8987 | ||
8988 | static void | |
8989 | parse_breakpoint_sals (location_spec *locspec, | |
8990 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
8991 | struct program_space *search_pspace) | |
8992 | { | |
8993 | if (locspec->type () == LINESPEC_LOCATION_SPEC) | |
8994 | { | |
8995 | const char *spec | |
8996 | = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | |
8997 | ||
8998 | if (spec == NULL) | |
8999 | { | |
9000 | /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default | |
9001 | breakpoint address. */ | |
9002 | if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | |
9003 | { | |
9004 | /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values | |
9005 | corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. | |
9006 | Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0 | |
9007 | as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise. | |
9008 | find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */ | |
9009 | symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); | |
9010 | CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc; | |
9011 | ||
9012 | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | |
9013 | ||
9014 | /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC" | |
9015 | where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So | |
9016 | make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from | |
9017 | trying to expand the list of sals to include all other | |
9018 | instances with the same symtab and line. */ | |
9019 | sal.pc = pc; | |
9020 | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | |
9021 | ||
9022 | struct linespec_sals lsal; | |
9023 | lsal.sals = {sal}; | |
9024 | lsal.canonical = NULL; | |
9025 | ||
9026 | canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | |
9027 | return; | |
9028 | } | |
9029 | else | |
9030 | error (_("No default breakpoint address now.")); | |
9031 | } | |
9032 | } | |
9033 | ||
9034 | /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the | |
9035 | current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default). | |
9036 | This should produce the results we want almost all of the | |
9037 | time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone. | |
9038 | ||
9039 | ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which | |
9040 | may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */ | |
9041 | symtab_and_line cursal | |
9042 | = get_current_source_symtab_and_line (current_program_space); | |
9043 | if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()) | |
9044 | { | |
9045 | const char *spec = NULL; | |
9046 | ||
9047 | if (locspec->type () == LINESPEC_LOCATION_SPEC) | |
9048 | spec = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | |
9049 | ||
9050 | if (!cursal.symtab | |
9051 | || (spec != NULL | |
9052 | && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL | |
9053 | && spec[1] != '[')) | |
9054 | { | |
9055 | decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | |
9056 | get_last_displayed_symtab (), | |
9057 | get_last_displayed_line (), | |
9058 | canonical, NULL, NULL); | |
9059 | return; | |
9060 | } | |
9061 | } | |
9062 | ||
9063 | decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | |
9064 | cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL); | |
9065 | } | |
9066 | ||
9067 | ||
9068 | /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be | |
9069 | inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */ | |
9070 | ||
9071 | static void | |
9072 | breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals) | |
9073 | { | |
9074 | for (auto &sal : sals) | |
9075 | resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | |
9076 | } | |
9077 | ||
9078 | /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For | |
9079 | instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will | |
9080 | likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can | |
9081 | only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a | |
9082 | multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of | |
9083 | it, etc. */ | |
9084 | ||
9085 | static void | |
9086 | check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
9087 | gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals) | |
9088 | { | |
9089 | for (const auto &sal : sals) | |
9090 | { | |
9091 | struct gdbarch *sarch; | |
9092 | ||
9093 | sarch = get_sal_arch (sal); | |
9094 | /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture | |
9095 | associated with SAL. */ | |
9096 | if (sarch == NULL) | |
9097 | sarch = gdbarch; | |
9098 | std::string msg; | |
9099 | if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg)) | |
9100 | error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"), | |
9101 | paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ()); | |
9102 | } | |
9103 | } | |
9104 | ||
9105 | /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */ | |
9106 | ||
9107 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> | |
9108 | decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p) | |
9109 | { | |
9110 | const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3]; | |
9111 | const char *endp; | |
9112 | ||
9113 | p = skip_spaces (p); | |
9114 | ||
9115 | endp = skip_to_space (p); | |
9116 | ||
9117 | std::string marker_str (p, endp - p); | |
9118 | ||
9119 | std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers | |
9120 | = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ()); | |
9121 | if (markers.empty ()) | |
9122 | error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), | |
9123 | marker_str.c_str ()); | |
9124 | ||
9125 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; | |
9126 | sals.reserve (markers.size ()); | |
9127 | ||
9128 | for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers) | |
9129 | { | |
9130 | symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0); | |
9131 | sal.pc = marker.address; | |
9132 | sals.push_back (sal); | |
9133 | } | |
9134 | ||
9135 | *arg_p = endp; | |
9136 | return sals; | |
9137 | } | |
9138 | ||
9139 | /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and | |
9140 | according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */ | |
9141 | ||
9142 | static const struct breakpoint_ops * | |
9143 | breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec_type (enum location_spec_type locspec_type, | |
9144 | bool is_tracepoint) | |
9145 | { | |
9146 | if (is_tracepoint) | |
9147 | { | |
9148 | if (locspec_type == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | |
9149 | return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops; | |
9150 | else | |
9151 | return &code_breakpoint_ops; | |
9152 | } | |
9153 | else | |
9154 | { | |
9155 | if (locspec_type == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | |
9156 | return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops; | |
9157 | else | |
9158 | return &code_breakpoint_ops; | |
9159 | } | |
9160 | } | |
9161 | ||
9162 | /* Return the program space to use as a filter when searching for locations | |
9163 | of a breakpoint specific to THREAD or INFERIOR. If THREAD and INFERIOR | |
9164 | are both -1, meaning all threads/inferiors, then this function returns | |
9165 | nullptr, indicating no program space filtering should be performed. | |
9166 | Otherwise, this function returns the program space for the inferior that | |
9167 | contains THREAD (when THREAD is not -1), or the program space for | |
9168 | INFERIOR (when INFERIOR is not -1). */ | |
9169 | ||
9170 | static struct program_space * | |
9171 | find_program_space_for_breakpoint (int thread, int inferior) | |
9172 | { | |
9173 | if (thread != -1) | |
9174 | { | |
9175 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1); | |
9176 | ||
9177 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | |
9178 | gdb_assert (thr != nullptr); | |
9179 | gdb_assert (thr->inf != nullptr); | |
9180 | return thr->inf->pspace; | |
9181 | } | |
9182 | else if (inferior != -1) | |
9183 | { | |
9184 | gdb_assert (thread == -1); | |
9185 | ||
9186 | struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_id (inferior); | |
9187 | gdb_assert (inf != nullptr); | |
9188 | ||
9189 | return inf->pspace; | |
9190 | } | |
9191 | ||
9192 | return nullptr; | |
9193 | } | |
9194 | ||
9195 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
9196 | ||
9197 | const struct breakpoint_ops * | |
9198 | breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec (const location_spec *locspec, | |
9199 | bool is_tracepoint) | |
9200 | { | |
9201 | if (locspec != nullptr) | |
9202 | return (breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec_type | |
9203 | (locspec->type (), is_tracepoint)); | |
9204 | return &code_breakpoint_ops; | |
9205 | } | |
9206 | ||
9207 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
9208 | ||
9209 | int | |
9210 | create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
9211 | location_spec *locspec, | |
9212 | const char *cond_string, | |
9213 | int thread, int inferior, | |
9214 | const char *extra_string, | |
9215 | bool force_condition, int parse_extra, | |
9216 | int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted, | |
9217 | int ignore_count, | |
9218 | enum auto_boolean pending_break_support, | |
9219 | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, | |
9220 | int from_tty, int enabled, int internal, | |
9221 | unsigned flags) | |
9222 | { | |
9223 | struct linespec_result canonical; | |
9224 | bool pending = false; | |
9225 | int task = -1; | |
9226 | int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count; | |
9227 | ||
9228 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | |
9229 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | |
9230 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || inferior == -1); | |
9231 | ||
9232 | /* If PARSE_EXTRA is true then the thread and inferior details will be | |
9233 | parsed from the EXTRA_STRING, the THREAD and INFERIOR arguments | |
9234 | should be -1. */ | |
9235 | gdb_assert (!parse_extra || thread == -1); | |
9236 | gdb_assert (!parse_extra || inferior == -1); | |
9237 | ||
9238 | gdb_assert (ops != NULL); | |
9239 | ||
9240 | /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */ | |
9241 | if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0') | |
9242 | extra_string = NULL; | |
9243 | ||
9244 | /* A bp_dprintf must always have an accompanying EXTRA_STRING containing | |
9245 | the dprintf format and arguments -- PARSE_EXTRA should always be false | |
9246 | in this case. | |
9247 | ||
9248 | For all other breakpoint types, EXTRA_STRING should be nullptr unless | |
9249 | PARSE_EXTRA is true. */ | |
9250 | gdb_assert ((type_wanted == bp_dprintf) | |
9251 | ? (extra_string != nullptr && !parse_extra) | |
9252 | : (extra_string == nullptr || parse_extra)); | |
9253 | ||
9254 | /* Will hold either copies of the similarly named function argument, or | |
9255 | will hold a modified version of the function argument, depending on | |
9256 | the value of PARSE_EXTRA. */ | |
9257 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy; | |
9258 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy; | |
9259 | ||
9260 | if (parse_extra) | |
9261 | { | |
9262 | /* Parse EXTRA_STRING splitting the parts out. */ | |
9263 | create_breakpoint_parse_arg_string (extra_string, &cond_string_copy, | |
9264 | &thread, &inferior, &task, | |
9265 | &extra_string_copy, | |
9266 | &force_condition); | |
9267 | ||
9268 | /* We could check that EXTRA_STRING_COPY is empty at this point -- it | |
9269 | should be, as we only get here for things that are not bp_dprintf, | |
9270 | however, we prefer to give the location spec parser a chance to | |
9271 | run first, this means the user will get errors about invalid | |
9272 | location spec instead of an error about garbage at the end of the | |
9273 | command line. | |
9274 | ||
9275 | We still do the EXTRA_STRING_COPY is empty check, just later in | |
9276 | this function. */ | |
9277 | ||
9278 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || thread > 0); | |
9279 | gdb_assert (task == -1 || task > 0); | |
9280 | gdb_assert (inferior == -1 || inferior > 0); | |
9281 | } | |
9282 | else | |
9283 | { | |
9284 | if (cond_string != nullptr) | |
9285 | cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string)); | |
9286 | if (extra_string != nullptr) | |
9287 | extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string)); | |
9288 | } | |
9289 | ||
9290 | /* Clear these. Updated values are now held in the *_copy locals. */ | |
9291 | cond_string = nullptr; | |
9292 | extra_string = nullptr; | |
9293 | ||
9294 | try | |
9295 | { | |
9296 | struct program_space *search_pspace | |
9297 | = find_program_space_for_breakpoint (thread, inferior); | |
9298 | ops->create_sals_from_location_spec (locspec, &canonical, | |
9299 | search_pspace); | |
9300 | } | |
9301 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
9302 | { | |
9303 | /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set | |
9304 | value. */ | |
9305 | if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | |
9306 | { | |
9307 | /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw | |
9308 | error. */ | |
9309 | ||
9310 | if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE) | |
9311 | throw; | |
9312 | ||
9313 | exception_print (gdb_stderr, e); | |
9314 | ||
9315 | /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user | |
9316 | selects no, then simply return the error code. */ | |
9317 | if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO | |
9318 | && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "), | |
9319 | bptype_string (type_wanted))) | |
9320 | return 0; | |
9321 | ||
9322 | /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting | |
9323 | a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending | |
9324 | breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint | |
9325 | is defaulted on behalf of the user. */ | |
9326 | pending = true; | |
9327 | } | |
9328 | else | |
9329 | throw; | |
9330 | } | |
9331 | ||
9332 | /* Only bp_dprintf breakpoints should have anything in EXTRA_STRING_COPY | |
9333 | by this point. For all other breakpoints this indicates an error. We | |
9334 | could place this check earlier in the function, but we prefer to see | |
9335 | errors from the location spec parser before we see this error message. */ | |
9336 | if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf && extra_string_copy.get () != nullptr) | |
9337 | error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), extra_string_copy.get ()); | |
9338 | ||
9339 | if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ()) | |
9340 | return 0; | |
9341 | ||
9342 | /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses | |
9343 | are ok for the target. */ | |
9344 | if (!pending) | |
9345 | { | |
9346 | for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) | |
9347 | breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals); | |
9348 | } | |
9349 | ||
9350 | /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */ | |
9351 | if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint) | |
9352 | { | |
9353 | for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals) | |
9354 | check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals); | |
9355 | } | |
9356 | ||
9357 | /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any | |
9358 | breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each | |
9359 | breakpoint. */ | |
9360 | if (!pending) | |
9361 | { | |
9362 | /* Check the validity of the condition. We should error out if the | |
9363 | condition is invalid at all of the locations and if it is not | |
9364 | forced. In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this check is done when | |
9365 | parsing the EXTRA_STRING. */ | |
9366 | if (cond_string_copy.get () != nullptr && !force_condition) | |
9367 | { | |
9368 | int num_failures = 0; | |
9369 | const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; | |
9370 | for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals) | |
9371 | { | |
9372 | const char *cond = cond_string_copy.get (); | |
9373 | try | |
9374 | { | |
9375 | parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0); | |
9376 | /* One success is sufficient to keep going. */ | |
9377 | break; | |
9378 | } | |
9379 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &) | |
9380 | { | |
9381 | num_failures++; | |
9382 | /* If this is the last sal, error out. */ | |
9383 | if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ()) | |
9384 | throw; | |
9385 | } | |
9386 | } | |
9387 | } | |
9388 | ||
9389 | ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical, | |
9390 | std::move (cond_string_copy), | |
9391 | std::move (extra_string_copy), | |
9392 | type_wanted, | |
9393 | tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch, | |
9394 | thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | |
9395 | from_tty, enabled, internal, flags); | |
9396 | } | |
9397 | else | |
9398 | { | |
9399 | std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (gdbarch, | |
9400 | type_wanted); | |
9401 | b->locspec = locspec->clone (); | |
9402 | ||
9403 | /* Create a private copy of the condition string. */ | |
9404 | b->cond_string = std::move (cond_string_copy); | |
9405 | ||
9406 | b->thread = thread; | |
9407 | b->task = task; | |
9408 | b->inferior = inferior; | |
9409 | ||
9410 | /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */ | |
9411 | b->extra_string = std::move (extra_string_copy); | |
9412 | ||
9413 | b->ignore_count = ignore_count; | |
9414 | b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch; | |
9415 | b->condition_not_parsed = 1; | |
9416 | b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled; | |
9417 | ||
9418 | if (b->type == bp_dprintf) | |
9419 | update_dprintf_command_list (b.get ()); | |
9420 | ||
9421 | install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0); | |
9422 | } | |
9423 | ||
9424 | if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1) | |
9425 | { | |
9426 | warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the " | |
9427 | "\"%ps\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."), | |
9428 | styled_string (command_style.style (), "delete")); | |
9429 | prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count; | |
9430 | } | |
9431 | ||
9432 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
9433 | ||
9434 | return 1; | |
9435 | } | |
9436 | ||
9437 | /* Set a breakpoint. | |
9438 | ARG is a string describing breakpoint address, | |
9439 | condition, and thread. | |
9440 | FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on, | |
9441 | and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG | |
9442 | and BP_TEMPFLAG. */ | |
9443 | ||
9444 | static void | |
9445 | break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty) | |
9446 | { | |
9447 | int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG; | |
9448 | enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG | |
9449 | ? bp_hardware_breakpoint | |
9450 | : bp_breakpoint); | |
9451 | ||
9452 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
9453 | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops | |
9454 | = breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec (locspec.get (), | |
9455 | false /* is_tracepoint */); | |
9456 | ||
9457 | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
9458 | locspec.get (), | |
9459 | NULL, | |
9460 | -1 /* thread */, -1 /* inferior */, | |
9461 | arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | |
9462 | tempflag, type_wanted, | |
9463 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
9464 | pending_break_support, | |
9465 | ops, | |
9466 | from_tty, | |
9467 | 1 /* enabled */, | |
9468 | 0 /* internal */, | |
9469 | 0); | |
9470 | } | |
9471 | ||
9472 | /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */ | |
9473 | ||
9474 | void | |
9475 | resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal) | |
9476 | { | |
9477 | CORE_ADDR pc; | |
9478 | ||
9479 | if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | |
9480 | { | |
9481 | if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc)) | |
9482 | error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."), | |
9483 | sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab)); | |
9484 | sal->pc = pc; | |
9485 | ||
9486 | /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line | |
9487 | number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */ | |
9488 | if (sal->explicit_line) | |
9489 | skip_prologue_sal (sal); | |
9490 | } | |
9491 | ||
9492 | if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL) | |
9493 | { | |
9494 | const struct blockvector *bv; | |
9495 | const struct block *b; | |
9496 | struct symbol *sym; | |
9497 | ||
9498 | bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, | |
9499 | sal->symtab->compunit ()); | |
9500 | if (bv != NULL) | |
9501 | { | |
9502 | sym = b->linkage_function (); | |
9503 | if (sym != NULL) | |
9504 | sal->section | |
9505 | = sym->obj_section (sal->symtab->compunit ()->objfile ()); | |
9506 | else | |
9507 | { | |
9508 | /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll | |
9509 | just have to look harder. This case can be executed | |
9510 | if we have line numbers but no functions (as can | |
9511 | happen in assembly source). */ | |
9512 | ||
9513 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
9514 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace); | |
9515 | ||
9516 | bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc); | |
9517 | if (msym.minsym) | |
9518 | sal->section = msym.obj_section (); | |
9519 | } | |
9520 | } | |
9521 | } | |
9522 | } | |
9523 | ||
9524 | void | |
9525 | break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9526 | { | |
9527 | break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty); | |
9528 | } | |
9529 | ||
9530 | void | |
9531 | tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9532 | { | |
9533 | break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty); | |
9534 | } | |
9535 | ||
9536 | static void | |
9537 | hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9538 | { | |
9539 | break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty); | |
9540 | } | |
9541 | ||
9542 | static void | |
9543 | thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9544 | { | |
9545 | break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty); | |
9546 | } | |
9547 | ||
9548 | /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but | |
9549 | with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command, | |
9550 | built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command | |
9551 | line. */ | |
9552 | ||
9553 | static void | |
9554 | dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9555 | { | |
9556 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
9557 | ||
9558 | /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location; | |
9559 | the next character must be ','. */ | |
9560 | if (arg == nullptr || arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0') | |
9561 | error (_("Format string required")); | |
9562 | else | |
9563 | { | |
9564 | /* Skip the comma. */ | |
9565 | ++arg; | |
9566 | } | |
9567 | ||
9568 | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
9569 | locspec.get (), | |
9570 | NULL, -1, -1, | |
9571 | arg, false, 0 /* parse arg */, | |
9572 | 0, bp_dprintf, | |
9573 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
9574 | pending_break_support, | |
9575 | &code_breakpoint_ops, | |
9576 | from_tty, | |
9577 | 1 /* enabled */, | |
9578 | 0 /* internal */, | |
9579 | 0); | |
9580 | } | |
9581 | ||
9582 | static void | |
9583 | agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9584 | { | |
9585 | error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target")); | |
9586 | } | |
9587 | ||
9588 | /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9589 | ||
9590 | int | |
9591 | ranged_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
9592 | const address_space *aspace, | |
9593 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
9594 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
9595 | { | |
9596 | if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | |
9597 | || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | |
9598 | return 0; | |
9599 | ||
9600 | return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), | |
9601 | bl->address, bl->length, aspace, | |
9602 | bp_addr); | |
9603 | } | |
9604 | ||
9605 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9606 | ||
9607 | int | |
9608 | ranged_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
9609 | { | |
9610 | return target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | |
9611 | } | |
9612 | ||
9613 | /* Implement the "print_it" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9614 | ||
9615 | enum print_stop_action | |
9616 | ranged_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
9617 | { | |
9618 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
9619 | ||
9620 | gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | |
9621 | ||
9622 | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */ | |
9623 | gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | |
9624 | ||
9625 | annotate_breakpoint (number); | |
9626 | ||
9627 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | |
9628 | ||
9629 | if (disposition == disp_del) | |
9630 | uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint "); | |
9631 | else | |
9632 | uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint "); | |
9633 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
9634 | { | |
9635 | uiout->field_string ("reason", | |
9636 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | |
9637 | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); | |
9638 | } | |
9639 | print_num_locno (bs, uiout); | |
9640 | uiout->text (", "); | |
9641 | ||
9642 | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | |
9643 | } | |
9644 | ||
9645 | /* Implement the "print_one" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9646 | ||
9647 | bool | |
9648 | ranged_breakpoint::print_one (const bp_location **last_loc) const | |
9649 | { | |
9650 | struct value_print_options opts; | |
9651 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
9652 | ||
9653 | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */ | |
9654 | gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | |
9655 | ||
9656 | get_user_print_options (&opts); | |
9657 | ||
9658 | if (opts.addressprint) | |
9659 | /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later | |
9660 | by ranged_breakpoint::print_one_detail. */ | |
9661 | uiout->field_skip ("addr"); | |
9662 | annotate_field (5); | |
9663 | print_breakpoint_location (this, &this->first_loc ()); | |
9664 | *last_loc = &this->first_loc (); | |
9665 | ||
9666 | return true; | |
9667 | } | |
9668 | ||
9669 | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9670 | ||
9671 | void | |
9672 | ranged_breakpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | |
9673 | { | |
9674 | CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end; | |
9675 | const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | |
9676 | string_file stb; | |
9677 | ||
9678 | address_start = bl.address; | |
9679 | address_end = address_start + bl.length - 1; | |
9680 | ||
9681 | uiout->text ("\taddress range: "); | |
9682 | stb.printf ("[%s, %s]", | |
9683 | print_core_address (bl.gdbarch, address_start), | |
9684 | print_core_address (bl.gdbarch, address_end)); | |
9685 | uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb); | |
9686 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
9687 | } | |
9688 | ||
9689 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9690 | ||
9691 | void | |
9692 | ranged_breakpoint::print_mention () const | |
9693 | { | |
9694 | const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | |
9695 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
9696 | ||
9697 | gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | |
9698 | ||
9699 | uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."), | |
9700 | number, paddress (bl.gdbarch, bl.address), | |
9701 | paddress (bl.gdbarch, bl.address + bl.length - 1)); | |
9702 | } | |
9703 | ||
9704 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9705 | ||
9706 | void | |
9707 | ranged_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
9708 | { | |
9709 | gdb_printf (fp, "break-range %s, %s", | |
9710 | locspec->to_string (), | |
9711 | locspec_range_end->to_string ()); | |
9712 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
9713 | } | |
9714 | ||
9715 | /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be | |
9716 | placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if | |
9717 | the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the | |
9718 | last instruction of the given line. */ | |
9719 | ||
9720 | static CORE_ADDR | |
9721 | find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal) | |
9722 | { | |
9723 | CORE_ADDR end; | |
9724 | ||
9725 | /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise, | |
9726 | find the address of the end of the given location. */ | |
9727 | if (sal.explicit_pc) | |
9728 | end = sal.pc; | |
9729 | else | |
9730 | { | |
9731 | int ret; | |
9732 | CORE_ADDR start; | |
9733 | ||
9734 | ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end); | |
9735 | if (!ret) | |
9736 | error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | |
9737 | ||
9738 | /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */ | |
9739 | end--; | |
9740 | } | |
9741 | ||
9742 | return end; | |
9743 | } | |
9744 | ||
9745 | /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */ | |
9746 | ||
9747 | static void | |
9748 | break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
9749 | { | |
9750 | const char *arg_start; | |
9751 | struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end; | |
9752 | int bp_count, can_use_bp, length; | |
9753 | CORE_ADDR end; | |
9754 | ||
9755 | /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */ | |
9756 | if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0) | |
9757 | error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints.")); | |
9758 | ||
9759 | bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | |
9760 | bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers (); | |
9761 | can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | |
9762 | bp_count, 0); | |
9763 | if (can_use_bp < 0) | |
9764 | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | |
9765 | ||
9766 | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | |
9767 | if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0') | |
9768 | error(_("No address range specified.")); | |
9769 | ||
9770 | arg_start = arg; | |
9771 | location_spec_up start_locspec | |
9772 | = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
9773 | parse_breakpoint_sals (start_locspec.get (), &canonical_start, nullptr); | |
9774 | ||
9775 | if (arg[0] != ',') | |
9776 | error (_("Too few arguments.")); | |
9777 | else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ()) | |
9778 | error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range.")); | |
9779 | ||
9780 | const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0]; | |
9781 | ||
9782 | if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1 | |
9783 | || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1) | |
9784 | error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | |
9785 | ||
9786 | const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0]; | |
9787 | std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | |
9788 | ||
9789 | arg++; /* Skip the comma. */ | |
9790 | arg = skip_spaces (arg); | |
9791 | ||
9792 | /* Parse the end location specification. */ | |
9793 | ||
9794 | arg_start = arg; | |
9795 | ||
9796 | /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using | |
9797 | parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start | |
9798 | location spec's symtab and line as the default symtab and line | |
9799 | for the end of the range. This makes it possible to have ranges | |
9800 | like "foo.c:27, +14", where +14 means 14 lines from the start | |
9801 | location spec. */ | |
9802 | location_spec_up end_locspec | |
9803 | = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
9804 | decode_line_full (end_locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | |
9805 | sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line, | |
9806 | &canonical_end, NULL, NULL); | |
9807 | ||
9808 | if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ()) | |
9809 | error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range.")); | |
9810 | ||
9811 | const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0]; | |
9812 | if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1 | |
9813 | || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1) | |
9814 | error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations.")); | |
9815 | ||
9816 | const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0]; | |
9817 | ||
9818 | end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end); | |
9819 | if (sal_start.pc > end) | |
9820 | error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start.")); | |
9821 | ||
9822 | length = end - sal_start.pc + 1; | |
9823 | if (length < 0) | |
9824 | /* Length overflowed. */ | |
9825 | error (_("Address range too large.")); | |
9826 | else if (length == 1) | |
9827 | { | |
9828 | /* This range is simple enough to be handled by | |
9829 | the `hbreak' command. */ | |
9830 | hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1); | |
9831 | ||
9832 | return; | |
9833 | } | |
9834 | ||
9835 | /* Now set up the breakpoint and install it. */ | |
9836 | ||
9837 | std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> br | |
9838 | (new ranged_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
9839 | sal_start, length, | |
9840 | std::move (start_locspec), | |
9841 | std::move (end_locspec))); | |
9842 | ||
9843 | install_breakpoint (false, std::move (br), true); | |
9844 | } | |
9845 | ||
9846 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
9847 | ||
9848 | watchpoint::~watchpoint () | |
9849 | { | |
9850 | /* Make sure to unlink the destroyed watchpoint from the related | |
9851 | breakpoint ring. */ | |
9852 | ||
9853 | breakpoint *bpt = this; | |
9854 | while (bpt->related_breakpoint != this) | |
9855 | bpt = bpt->related_breakpoint; | |
9856 | ||
9857 | bpt->related_breakpoint = this->related_breakpoint; | |
9858 | } | |
9859 | ||
9860 | /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero | |
9861 | means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for | |
9862 | some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return | |
9863 | zero. */ | |
9864 | ||
9865 | static bool | |
9866 | watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp) | |
9867 | { | |
9868 | return exp->op->constant_p (); | |
9869 | } | |
9870 | ||
9871 | /* Implement the "re_set" method for watchpoints. */ | |
9872 | ||
9873 | void | |
9874 | watchpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | |
9875 | { | |
9876 | /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global | |
9877 | variables, or it can be on local variables. | |
9878 | ||
9879 | Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even | |
9880 | persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables | |
9881 | from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries | |
9882 | are loaded and unloaded. | |
9883 | ||
9884 | Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result | |
9885 | of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local | |
9886 | and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint, | |
9887 | but unloading of a shared library will make the expression | |
9888 | invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still | |
9889 | re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user. | |
9890 | ||
9891 | Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if | |
9892 | watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the | |
9893 | watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact, | |
9894 | I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case. | |
9895 | ||
9896 | If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then | |
9897 | exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it. | |
9898 | ||
9899 | Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be | |
9900 | reevaluated again when enabled. */ | |
9901 | update_watchpoint (this, true /* reparse */); | |
9902 | } | |
9903 | ||
9904 | /* Implement the "insert" method for hardware watchpoints. */ | |
9905 | ||
9906 | int | |
9907 | watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | |
9908 | { | |
9909 | int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; | |
9910 | ||
9911 | return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | |
9912 | cond_exp.get ()); | |
9913 | } | |
9914 | ||
9915 | /* Implement the "remove" method for hardware watchpoints. */ | |
9916 | ||
9917 | int | |
9918 | watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | |
9919 | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | |
9920 | { | |
9921 | int length = exact ? 1 : bl->length; | |
9922 | ||
9923 | return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type, | |
9924 | cond_exp.get ()); | |
9925 | } | |
9926 | ||
9927 | int | |
9928 | watchpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
9929 | const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
9930 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
9931 | { | |
9932 | struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner; | |
9933 | ||
9934 | /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the | |
9935 | reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on | |
9936 | some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction | |
9937 | in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has | |
9938 | been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger | |
9939 | (did not match the data address). */ | |
9940 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b) | |
9941 | && watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no) | |
9942 | return 0; | |
9943 | ||
9944 | return 1; | |
9945 | } | |
9946 | ||
9947 | void | |
9948 | watchpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | |
9949 | { | |
9950 | bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs); | |
9951 | } | |
9952 | ||
9953 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for hardware | |
9954 | watchpoints. */ | |
9955 | ||
9956 | int | |
9957 | watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
9958 | { | |
9959 | int length = exact? 1 : bl->length; | |
9960 | ||
9961 | return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length); | |
9962 | } | |
9963 | ||
9964 | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for hardware | |
9965 | watchpoints. */ | |
9966 | ||
9967 | bool | |
9968 | watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const | |
9969 | { | |
9970 | /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */ | |
9971 | return type == bp_watchpoint || type == bp_hardware_watchpoint; | |
9972 | } | |
9973 | ||
9974 | enum print_stop_action | |
9975 | watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
9976 | { | |
9977 | enum print_stop_action result; | |
9978 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
9979 | ||
9980 | gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL); | |
9981 | ||
9982 | annotate_watchpoint (this->number); | |
9983 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | |
9984 | ||
9985 | string_file stb; | |
9986 | ||
9987 | std::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter; | |
9988 | switch (this->type) | |
9989 | { | |
9990 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
9991 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
9992 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
9993 | uiout->field_string | |
9994 | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
9995 | mention (this); | |
9996 | tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | |
9997 | uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | |
9998 | watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); | |
9999 | uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | |
10000 | uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | |
10001 | watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | |
10002 | uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | |
10003 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
10004 | /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */ | |
10005 | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
10006 | break; | |
10007 | ||
10008 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10009 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10010 | uiout->field_string | |
10011 | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10012 | mention (this); | |
10013 | tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | |
10014 | uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | |
10015 | watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | |
10016 | uiout->field_stream ("value", stb); | |
10017 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
10018 | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
10019 | break; | |
10020 | ||
10021 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10022 | if (bs->old_val != NULL) | |
10023 | { | |
10024 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10025 | uiout->field_string | |
10026 | ("reason", | |
10027 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10028 | mention (this); | |
10029 | tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | |
10030 | uiout->text ("\nOld value = "); | |
10031 | watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb); | |
10032 | uiout->field_stream ("old", stb); | |
10033 | uiout->text ("\nNew value = "); | |
10034 | } | |
10035 | else | |
10036 | { | |
10037 | mention (this); | |
10038 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10039 | uiout->field_string | |
10040 | ("reason", | |
10041 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10042 | tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value"); | |
10043 | uiout->text ("\nValue = "); | |
10044 | } | |
10045 | watchpoint_value_print (val.get (), &stb); | |
10046 | uiout->field_stream ("new", stb); | |
10047 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
10048 | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
10049 | break; | |
10050 | default: | |
10051 | result = PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
10052 | } | |
10053 | ||
10054 | return result; | |
10055 | } | |
10056 | ||
10057 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for hardware watchpoints. */ | |
10058 | ||
10059 | void | |
10060 | watchpoint::print_mention () const | |
10061 | { | |
10062 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
10063 | const char *tuple_name; | |
10064 | ||
10065 | switch (type) | |
10066 | { | |
10067 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
10068 | uiout->text ("Watchpoint "); | |
10069 | tuple_name = "wpt"; | |
10070 | break; | |
10071 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
10072 | uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint "); | |
10073 | tuple_name = "wpt"; | |
10074 | break; | |
10075 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10076 | uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint "); | |
10077 | tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; | |
10078 | break; | |
10079 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10080 | uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | |
10081 | tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; | |
10082 | break; | |
10083 | default: | |
10084 | internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | |
10085 | } | |
10086 | ||
10087 | ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); | |
10088 | uiout->field_signed ("number", number); | |
10089 | uiout->text (": "); | |
10090 | uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); | |
10091 | } | |
10092 | ||
10093 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for watchpoints. */ | |
10094 | ||
10095 | void | |
10096 | watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
10097 | { | |
10098 | switch (type) | |
10099 | { | |
10100 | case bp_watchpoint: | |
10101 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
10102 | gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); | |
10103 | break; | |
10104 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10105 | gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); | |
10106 | break; | |
10107 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10108 | gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); | |
10109 | break; | |
10110 | default: | |
10111 | internal_error (_("Invalid watchpoint type.")); | |
10112 | } | |
10113 | ||
10114 | gdb_printf (fp, " %s", exp_string.get ()); | |
10115 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
10116 | } | |
10117 | ||
10118 | /* Implement the "explains_signal" method for watchpoints. */ | |
10119 | ||
10120 | bool | |
10121 | watchpoint::explains_signal (enum gdb_signal sig) | |
10122 | { | |
10123 | /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than | |
10124 | GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */ | |
10125 | if (type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | |
10126 | return false; | |
10127 | ||
10128 | return true; | |
10129 | } | |
10130 | ||
10131 | struct masked_watchpoint : public watchpoint | |
10132 | { | |
10133 | using watchpoint::watchpoint; | |
10134 | ||
10135 | int insert_location (struct bp_location *) override; | |
10136 | int remove_location (struct bp_location *, | |
10137 | enum remove_bp_reason reason) override; | |
10138 | int resources_needed (const struct bp_location *) override; | |
10139 | bool works_in_software_mode () const override; | |
10140 | enum print_stop_action print_it (const bpstat *bs) const override; | |
10141 | void print_one_detail (struct ui_out *) const override; | |
10142 | void print_mention () const override; | |
10143 | void print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const override; | |
10144 | }; | |
10145 | ||
10146 | /* Implement the "insert" method for masked hardware watchpoints. */ | |
10147 | ||
10148 | int | |
10149 | masked_watchpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | |
10150 | { | |
10151 | return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, | |
10152 | bl->watchpoint_type); | |
10153 | } | |
10154 | ||
10155 | /* Implement the "remove" method for masked hardware watchpoints. */ | |
10156 | ||
10157 | int | |
10158 | masked_watchpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | |
10159 | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | |
10160 | { | |
10161 | return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, hw_wp_mask, | |
10162 | bl->watchpoint_type); | |
10163 | } | |
10164 | ||
10165 | /* Implement the "resources_needed" method for masked hardware | |
10166 | watchpoints. */ | |
10167 | ||
10168 | int | |
10169 | masked_watchpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
10170 | { | |
10171 | return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, hw_wp_mask); | |
10172 | } | |
10173 | ||
10174 | /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" method for masked hardware | |
10175 | watchpoints. */ | |
10176 | ||
10177 | bool | |
10178 | masked_watchpoint::works_in_software_mode () const | |
10179 | { | |
10180 | return false; | |
10181 | } | |
10182 | ||
10183 | /* Implement the "print_it" method for masked hardware | |
10184 | watchpoints. */ | |
10185 | ||
10186 | enum print_stop_action | |
10187 | masked_watchpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
10188 | { | |
10189 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
10190 | ||
10191 | /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */ | |
10192 | gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | |
10193 | ||
10194 | annotate_watchpoint (this->number); | |
10195 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | |
10196 | ||
10197 | switch (this->type) | |
10198 | { | |
10199 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
10200 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10201 | uiout->field_string | |
10202 | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10203 | break; | |
10204 | ||
10205 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10206 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10207 | uiout->field_string | |
10208 | ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10209 | break; | |
10210 | ||
10211 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10212 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
10213 | uiout->field_string | |
10214 | ("reason", | |
10215 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER)); | |
10216 | break; | |
10217 | default: | |
10218 | internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | |
10219 | } | |
10220 | ||
10221 | mention (this); | |
10222 | uiout->text (_("\n\ | |
10223 | Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\ | |
10224 | address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n")); | |
10225 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
10226 | ||
10227 | /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */ | |
10228 | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
10229 | } | |
10230 | ||
10231 | /* Implement the "print_one_detail" method for masked hardware | |
10232 | watchpoints. */ | |
10233 | ||
10234 | void | |
10235 | masked_watchpoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | |
10236 | { | |
10237 | /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */ | |
10238 | gdb_assert (this->has_single_location ()); | |
10239 | ||
10240 | uiout->text ("\tmask "); | |
10241 | uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", this->first_loc ().gdbarch, hw_wp_mask); | |
10242 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
10243 | } | |
10244 | ||
10245 | /* Implement the "print_mention" method for masked hardware | |
10246 | watchpoints. */ | |
10247 | ||
10248 | void | |
10249 | masked_watchpoint::print_mention () const | |
10250 | { | |
10251 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
10252 | const char *tuple_name; | |
10253 | ||
10254 | switch (type) | |
10255 | { | |
10256 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
10257 | uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint "); | |
10258 | tuple_name = "wpt"; | |
10259 | break; | |
10260 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10261 | uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint "); | |
10262 | tuple_name = "hw-rwpt"; | |
10263 | break; | |
10264 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10265 | uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint "); | |
10266 | tuple_name = "hw-awpt"; | |
10267 | break; | |
10268 | default: | |
10269 | internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | |
10270 | } | |
10271 | ||
10272 | ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name); | |
10273 | uiout->field_signed ("number", number); | |
10274 | uiout->text (": "); | |
10275 | uiout->field_string ("exp", exp_string.get ()); | |
10276 | } | |
10277 | ||
10278 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for masked hardware | |
10279 | watchpoints. */ | |
10280 | ||
10281 | void | |
10282 | masked_watchpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
10283 | { | |
10284 | switch (type) | |
10285 | { | |
10286 | case bp_hardware_watchpoint: | |
10287 | gdb_printf (fp, "watch"); | |
10288 | break; | |
10289 | case bp_read_watchpoint: | |
10290 | gdb_printf (fp, "rwatch"); | |
10291 | break; | |
10292 | case bp_access_watchpoint: | |
10293 | gdb_printf (fp, "awatch"); | |
10294 | break; | |
10295 | default: | |
10296 | internal_error (_("Invalid hardware watchpoint type.")); | |
10297 | } | |
10298 | ||
10299 | gdb_printf (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", exp_string.get (), | |
10300 | phex (hw_wp_mask)); | |
10301 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
10302 | } | |
10303 | ||
10304 | /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */ | |
10305 | ||
10306 | static bool | |
10307 | is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b) | |
10308 | { | |
10309 | return dynamic_cast<const masked_watchpoint *> (b) != nullptr; | |
10310 | } | |
10311 | ||
10312 | /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write, | |
10313 | hw_read: watch read, | |
10314 | hw_access: watch access (read or write) */ | |
10315 | static void | |
10316 | watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty, | |
10317 | bool just_location, bool internal) | |
10318 | { | |
10319 | struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL; | |
10320 | const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL; | |
10321 | struct value *result; | |
10322 | int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0; | |
10323 | const char *exp_start = NULL; | |
10324 | const char *exp_end = NULL; | |
10325 | const char *tok, *end_tok; | |
10326 | int toklen = -1; | |
10327 | const char *cond_start = NULL; | |
10328 | const char *cond_end = NULL; | |
10329 | enum bptype bp_type; | |
10330 | int thread = -1; | |
10331 | int inferior = -1; | |
10332 | /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for | |
10333 | the hardware watchpoint. */ | |
10334 | bool use_mask = false; | |
10335 | CORE_ADDR mask = 0; | |
10336 | int task = -1; | |
10337 | ||
10338 | /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */ | |
10339 | if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0') | |
10340 | { | |
10341 | const char *value_start; | |
10342 | ||
10343 | exp_end = arg + strlen (arg); | |
10344 | ||
10345 | /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end | |
10346 | of the arguments string. */ | |
10347 | for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--) | |
10348 | { | |
10349 | /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */ | |
10350 | while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | |
10351 | tok--; | |
10352 | ||
10353 | /* Find the beginning of the last token. | |
10354 | This is the value of the parameter. */ | |
10355 | while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | |
10356 | tok--; | |
10357 | value_start = tok + 1; | |
10358 | ||
10359 | /* Skip whitespace. */ | |
10360 | while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t')) | |
10361 | tok--; | |
10362 | ||
10363 | end_tok = tok; | |
10364 | ||
10365 | /* Find the beginning of the second to last token. | |
10366 | This is the parameter itself. */ | |
10367 | while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t')) | |
10368 | tok--; | |
10369 | tok++; | |
10370 | toklen = end_tok - tok + 1; | |
10371 | ||
10372 | if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread")) | |
10373 | { | |
10374 | struct thread_info *thr; | |
10375 | /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means | |
10376 | the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers | |
10377 | only in a specific thread. */ | |
10378 | const char *endp; | |
10379 | ||
10380 | if (thread != -1) | |
10381 | error(_("You can specify only one thread.")); | |
10382 | ||
10383 | if (task != -1) | |
10384 | error (_("You can specify only one of thread or task.")); | |
10385 | ||
10386 | if (inferior != -1) | |
10387 | error (_("You can specify only one of inferior or thread.")); | |
10388 | ||
10389 | /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */ | |
10390 | thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp); | |
10391 | if (value_start == endp) | |
10392 | error (_("Junk after thread keyword.")); | |
10393 | ||
10394 | thread = thr->global_num; | |
10395 | } | |
10396 | else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "task")) | |
10397 | { | |
10398 | char *tmp; | |
10399 | ||
10400 | if (task != -1) | |
10401 | error(_("You can specify only one task.")); | |
10402 | ||
10403 | if (thread != -1) | |
10404 | error (_("You can specify only one of thread or task.")); | |
10405 | ||
10406 | if (inferior != -1) | |
10407 | error (_("You can specify only one of inferior or task.")); | |
10408 | ||
10409 | task = strtol (value_start, &tmp, 0); | |
10410 | if (tmp == value_start) | |
10411 | error (_("Junk after task keyword.")); | |
10412 | if (!valid_task_id (task)) | |
10413 | error (_("Unknown task %d."), task); | |
10414 | } | |
10415 | else if (toklen == 8 && startswith (tok, "inferior")) | |
10416 | { | |
10417 | /* Support for watchpoints will be added in a later commit. */ | |
10418 | error (_("Cannot use 'inferior' keyword with watchpoints")); | |
10419 | } | |
10420 | else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask")) | |
10421 | { | |
10422 | /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to | |
10423 | create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask | |
10424 | facility. */ | |
10425 | struct value *mask_value; | |
10426 | ||
10427 | if (use_mask) | |
10428 | error(_("You can specify only one mask.")); | |
10429 | ||
10430 | use_mask = just_location = true; | |
10431 | ||
10432 | scoped_value_mark mark; | |
10433 | mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start); | |
10434 | mask = value_as_address (mask_value); | |
10435 | } | |
10436 | else | |
10437 | /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */ | |
10438 | break; | |
10439 | ||
10440 | /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before | |
10441 | the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */ | |
10442 | exp_end = tok; | |
10443 | } | |
10444 | } | |
10445 | else | |
10446 | exp_end = arg; | |
10447 | ||
10448 | /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything | |
10449 | is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original | |
10450 | ARG. */ | |
10451 | std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg); | |
10452 | exp_start = arg = expression.c_str (); | |
10453 | innermost_block_tracker tracker; | |
10454 | expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker); | |
10455 | exp_end = arg; | |
10456 | /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it. | |
10457 | This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit | |
10458 | prettier. */ | |
10459 | while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t')) | |
10460 | --exp_end; | |
10461 | ||
10462 | /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */ | |
10463 | if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ())) | |
10464 | { | |
10465 | int len; | |
10466 | ||
10467 | len = exp_end - exp_start; | |
10468 | while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1])) | |
10469 | len--; | |
10470 | error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start); | |
10471 | } | |
10472 | ||
10473 | exp_valid_block = tracker.block (); | |
10474 | struct value *mark = value_mark (); | |
10475 | struct value *val_as_value = nullptr; | |
10476 | fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL, | |
10477 | just_location); | |
10478 | ||
10479 | if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location) | |
10480 | { | |
10481 | saved_bitpos = val_as_value->bitpos (); | |
10482 | saved_bitsize = val_as_value->bitsize (); | |
10483 | } | |
10484 | ||
10485 | value_ref_ptr val; | |
10486 | if (just_location) | |
10487 | { | |
10488 | int ret; | |
10489 | ||
10490 | exp_valid_block = NULL; | |
10491 | val = release_value (value_addr (result)); | |
10492 | value_free_to_mark (mark); | |
10493 | ||
10494 | if (use_mask) | |
10495 | { | |
10496 | ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()), | |
10497 | mask); | |
10498 | if (ret == -1) | |
10499 | error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints.")); | |
10500 | else if (ret == -2) | |
10501 | error (_("Invalid mask or memory region.")); | |
10502 | } | |
10503 | } | |
10504 | else if (val_as_value != NULL) | |
10505 | val = release_value (val_as_value); | |
10506 | ||
10507 | tok = skip_spaces (arg); | |
10508 | end_tok = skip_to_space (tok); | |
10509 | ||
10510 | toklen = end_tok - tok; | |
10511 | if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0) | |
10512 | { | |
10513 | tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1; | |
10514 | innermost_block_tracker if_tracker; | |
10515 | parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker); | |
10516 | ||
10517 | /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition | |
10518 | may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */ | |
10519 | cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block (); | |
10520 | ||
10521 | cond_end = tok; | |
10522 | } | |
10523 | if (*tok) | |
10524 | error (_("Junk at end of command.")); | |
10525 | ||
10526 | frame_info_ptr wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block); | |
10527 | ||
10528 | /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates | |
10529 | 'wp_frame'. */ | |
10530 | frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame); | |
10531 | ||
10532 | /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware | |
10533 | watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call | |
10534 | to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to | |
10535 | drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */ | |
10536 | ||
10537 | if (accessflag == hw_read) | |
10538 | bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint; | |
10539 | else if (accessflag == hw_access) | |
10540 | bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint; | |
10541 | else | |
10542 | bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint; | |
10543 | ||
10544 | std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w; | |
10545 | if (use_mask) | |
10546 | w = std::make_unique<masked_watchpoint> (nullptr, bp_type); | |
10547 | else | |
10548 | w = std::make_unique<watchpoint> (nullptr, bp_type); | |
10549 | ||
10550 | /* At most one of thread or task can be set on a watchpoint. */ | |
10551 | gdb_assert (thread == -1 || task == -1); | |
10552 | w->thread = thread; | |
10553 | w->inferior = inferior; | |
10554 | w->task = task; | |
10555 | w->disposition = disp_donttouch; | |
10556 | w->pspace = current_program_space; | |
10557 | w->exp = std::move (exp); | |
10558 | w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block; | |
10559 | w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block; | |
10560 | if (just_location) | |
10561 | { | |
10562 | struct type *t = val->type (); | |
10563 | CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ()); | |
10564 | ||
10565 | w->exp_string_reparse | |
10566 | = current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr); | |
10567 | ||
10568 | w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s", | |
10569 | (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start); | |
10570 | } | |
10571 | else | |
10572 | w->exp_string.reset (savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start)); | |
10573 | ||
10574 | if (use_mask) | |
10575 | { | |
10576 | w->hw_wp_mask = mask; | |
10577 | } | |
10578 | else | |
10579 | { | |
10580 | w->val = val; | |
10581 | w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos; | |
10582 | w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize; | |
10583 | w->val_valid = true; | |
10584 | } | |
10585 | ||
10586 | if (cond_start) | |
10587 | w->cond_string.reset (savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start)); | |
10588 | else | |
10589 | w->cond_string = 0; | |
10590 | ||
10591 | if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame)) | |
10592 | { | |
10593 | w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame; | |
10594 | w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid; | |
10595 | } | |
10596 | else | |
10597 | { | |
10598 | w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id; | |
10599 | w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid; | |
10600 | } | |
10601 | ||
10602 | if (!just_location) | |
10603 | value_free_to_mark (mark); | |
10604 | ||
10605 | /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations | |
10606 | that should be inserted. */ | |
10607 | update_watchpoint (w.get (), true /* reparse */); | |
10608 | ||
10609 | /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope" | |
10610 | breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint | |
10611 | expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so | |
10612 | that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */ | |
10613 | if (exp_valid_block != nullptr && wp_frame != nullptr) | |
10614 | { | |
10615 | frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame); | |
10616 | ||
10617 | if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) | |
10618 | { | |
10619 | gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame); | |
10620 | CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame); | |
10621 | ||
10622 | scope_breakpoint | |
10623 | = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc, | |
10624 | bp_watchpoint_scope); | |
10625 | ||
10626 | /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */ | |
10627 | wp_frame = nullptr; | |
10628 | ||
10629 | scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
10630 | ||
10631 | /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */ | |
10632 | scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del; | |
10633 | ||
10634 | /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */ | |
10635 | scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id; | |
10636 | ||
10637 | /* Set the address at which we will stop. */ | |
10638 | bp_location &loc = scope_breakpoint->first_loc (); | |
10639 | loc.gdbarch = caller_arch; | |
10640 | loc.requested_address = caller_pc; | |
10641 | loc.address | |
10642 | = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc.gdbarch, loc.requested_address, | |
10643 | scope_breakpoint->type, | |
10644 | current_program_space); | |
10645 | } | |
10646 | } | |
10647 | ||
10648 | if (scope_breakpoint != nullptr) | |
10649 | { | |
10650 | /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will | |
10651 | need to act on them together. */ | |
10652 | w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint; | |
10653 | scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get (); | |
10654 | } | |
10655 | ||
10656 | /* Verify that the scope breakpoint comes before the watchpoint in the | |
10657 | breakpoint chain. */ | |
10658 | gdb_assert (scope_breakpoint == nullptr | |
10659 | || &breakpoint_chain.back () == scope_breakpoint); | |
10660 | watchpoint *watchpoint_ptr = w.get (); | |
10661 | install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1); | |
10662 | gdb_assert (&breakpoint_chain.back () == watchpoint_ptr); | |
10663 | } | |
10664 | ||
10665 | /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression. | |
10666 | If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */ | |
10667 | ||
10668 | static int | |
10669 | can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals) | |
10670 | { | |
10671 | int found_memory_cnt = 0; | |
10672 | ||
10673 | /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */ | |
10674 | if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints) | |
10675 | return 0; | |
10676 | ||
10677 | gdb_assert (!vals.empty ()); | |
10678 | struct value *head = vals[0].get (); | |
10679 | ||
10680 | /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon | |
10681 | memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we | |
10682 | find any register references or function calls, we can't use a | |
10683 | hardware watchpoint. | |
10684 | ||
10685 | The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series | |
10686 | of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The | |
10687 | expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and | |
10688 | a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish | |
10689 | the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues, | |
10690 | register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate | |
10691 | the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves | |
10692 | behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the | |
10693 | expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints. | |
10694 | ||
10695 | However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior | |
10696 | function calls are special in any way. So this function may not | |
10697 | notice that an expression involving an inferior function call | |
10698 | can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */ | |
10699 | for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals) | |
10700 | { | |
10701 | struct value *v = iter.get (); | |
10702 | ||
10703 | if (v->lval () == lval_memory) | |
10704 | { | |
10705 | if (v != head && v->lazy ()) | |
10706 | /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never | |
10707 | needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g., | |
10708 | `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a' | |
10709 | in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is | |
10710 | lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */ | |
10711 | ; | |
10712 | else | |
10713 | { | |
10714 | /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover | |
10715 | it with hardware watchpoints. */ | |
10716 | struct type *vtype = check_typedef (v->type ()); | |
10717 | ||
10718 | /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it | |
10719 | explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a | |
10720 | middle of some value chain. */ | |
10721 | if (v == head | |
10722 | || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT | |
10723 | && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)) | |
10724 | { | |
10725 | CORE_ADDR vaddr = v->address (); | |
10726 | int len; | |
10727 | int num_regs; | |
10728 | ||
10729 | len = (target_exact_watchpoints | |
10730 | && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))? | |
10731 | 1 : v->type ()->length (); | |
10732 | ||
10733 | num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len); | |
10734 | if (!num_regs) | |
10735 | return 0; | |
10736 | else | |
10737 | found_memory_cnt += num_regs; | |
10738 | } | |
10739 | } | |
10740 | } | |
10741 | else if (v->lval () != not_lval && !v->deprecated_modifiable ()) | |
10742 | return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */ | |
10743 | else if (v->lval () == lval_register) | |
10744 | return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */ | |
10745 | } | |
10746 | ||
10747 | /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware | |
10748 | watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */ | |
10749 | return found_memory_cnt; | |
10750 | } | |
10751 | ||
10752 | void | |
10753 | watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | |
10754 | { | |
10755 | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal); | |
10756 | } | |
10757 | ||
10758 | /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands. */ | |
10759 | ||
10760 | struct watch_options | |
10761 | { | |
10762 | /* For -location. */ | |
10763 | bool location = false; | |
10764 | }; | |
10765 | ||
10766 | /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands. | |
10767 | ||
10768 | Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for | |
10769 | these commands (both flags being synonyms). When converting to the | |
10770 | newer option scheme only '-location' is added here. That's fine (for | |
10771 | backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be | |
10772 | accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted. | |
10773 | ||
10774 | What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here | |
10775 | that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so | |
10776 | please, don't do that! */ | |
10777 | ||
10778 | static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = { | |
10779 | gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> { | |
10780 | "location", | |
10781 | [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; }, | |
10782 | N_("\ | |
10783 | This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which it refers.\n\ | |
10784 | -l can be used as a short form of -location."), | |
10785 | }, | |
10786 | }; | |
10787 | ||
10788 | /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' | |
10789 | commands. */ | |
10790 | ||
10791 | static gdb::option::option_def_group | |
10792 | make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts) | |
10793 | { | |
10794 | return {{watch_option_defs}, opts}; | |
10795 | } | |
10796 | ||
10797 | /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then | |
10798 | calls watch_command_1. */ | |
10799 | ||
10800 | static void | |
10801 | watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty) | |
10802 | { | |
10803 | watch_options opts; | |
10804 | auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts); | |
10805 | gdb::option::process_options | |
10806 | (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp); | |
10807 | if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0') | |
10808 | arg = nullptr; | |
10809 | ||
10810 | watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false); | |
10811 | } | |
10812 | ||
10813 | /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands. */ | |
10814 | static void | |
10815 | watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore, | |
10816 | completion_tracker &tracker, | |
10817 | const char *text, const char * /*word*/) | |
10818 | { | |
10819 | const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); | |
10820 | if (gdb::option::complete_options | |
10821 | (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group)) | |
10822 | return; | |
10823 | ||
10824 | const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text); | |
10825 | expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word); | |
10826 | } | |
10827 | ||
10828 | static void | |
10829 | watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
10830 | { | |
10831 | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty); | |
10832 | } | |
10833 | ||
10834 | void | |
10835 | rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | |
10836 | { | |
10837 | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal); | |
10838 | } | |
10839 | ||
10840 | static void | |
10841 | rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
10842 | { | |
10843 | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty); | |
10844 | } | |
10845 | ||
10846 | void | |
10847 | awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal) | |
10848 | { | |
10849 | watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal); | |
10850 | } | |
10851 | ||
10852 | static void | |
10853 | awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
10854 | { | |
10855 | watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty); | |
10856 | } | |
10857 | \f | |
10858 | ||
10859 | /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands | |
10860 | in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of | |
10861 | breakpoints. */ | |
10862 | ||
10863 | struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm | |
10864 | { | |
10865 | /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */ | |
10866 | int thread; | |
10867 | ||
10868 | /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame, | |
10869 | plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */ | |
10870 | std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; | |
10871 | ||
10872 | until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread, | |
10873 | std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints) | |
10874 | : thread_fsm (cmd_interp), | |
10875 | thread (thread), | |
10876 | breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints)) | |
10877 | { | |
10878 | } | |
10879 | ||
10880 | void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override; | |
10881 | bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override; | |
10882 | enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override; | |
10883 | }; | |
10884 | ||
10885 | /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the | |
10886 | until(location)/advance commands. */ | |
10887 | ||
10888 | bool | |
10889 | until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp) | |
10890 | { | |
10891 | for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints) | |
10892 | if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat, | |
10893 | bp.get ()) != NULL) | |
10894 | { | |
10895 | set_finished (); | |
10896 | break; | |
10897 | } | |
10898 | ||
10899 | return true; | |
10900 | } | |
10901 | ||
10902 | /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the | |
10903 | until(location)/advance commands. */ | |
10904 | ||
10905 | void | |
10906 | until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *) | |
10907 | { | |
10908 | /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */ | |
10909 | breakpoints.clear (); | |
10910 | delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread); | |
10911 | } | |
10912 | ||
10913 | /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the | |
10914 | until(location)/advance commands. */ | |
10915 | ||
10916 | enum async_reply_reason | |
10917 | until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason () | |
10918 | { | |
10919 | return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED; | |
10920 | } | |
10921 | ||
10922 | void | |
10923 | until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere) | |
10924 | { | |
10925 | frame_info_ptr frame; | |
10926 | struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch; | |
10927 | struct frame_id stack_frame_id; | |
10928 | struct frame_id caller_frame_id; | |
10929 | int thread; | |
10930 | struct thread_info *tp; | |
10931 | ||
10932 | clear_proceed_status (0); | |
10933 | ||
10934 | /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from | |
10935 | this function. */ | |
10936 | ||
10937 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
10938 | ||
10939 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | |
10940 | = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid () | |
10941 | ? decode_line_1 (locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL, | |
10942 | get_last_displayed_symtab (), | |
10943 | get_last_displayed_line ()) | |
10944 | : decode_line_1 (locspec.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, | |
10945 | NULL, NULL, 0)); | |
10946 | ||
10947 | if (sals.empty ()) | |
10948 | error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line.")); | |
10949 | ||
10950 | if (*arg) | |
10951 | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | |
10952 | ||
10953 | tp = inferior_thread (); | |
10954 | thread = tp->global_num; | |
10955 | ||
10956 | /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain. | |
10957 | Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it | |
10958 | may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before | |
10959 | that. */ | |
10960 | ||
10961 | frame = get_selected_frame (NULL); | |
10962 | frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame); | |
10963 | stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame); | |
10964 | caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame); | |
10965 | ||
10966 | /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current | |
10967 | one. */ | |
10968 | ||
10969 | std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints; | |
10970 | ||
10971 | std::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter; | |
10972 | ||
10973 | if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id)) | |
10974 | { | |
10975 | struct symtab_and_line sal2; | |
10976 | struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch; | |
10977 | ||
10978 | sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0); | |
10979 | sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame); | |
10980 | caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame); | |
10981 | ||
10982 | breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint | |
10983 | = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2, | |
10984 | caller_frame_id, bp_until); | |
10985 | breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint)); | |
10986 | ||
10987 | set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, stack_frame_id); | |
10988 | lj_deleter.emplace (thread); | |
10989 | } | |
10990 | ||
10991 | /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we | |
10992 | don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise, | |
10993 | specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the | |
10994 | very same frame. */ | |
10995 | frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id; | |
10996 | ||
10997 | for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals) | |
10998 | { | |
10999 | resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | |
11000 | ||
11001 | breakpoint_up location_breakpoint | |
11002 | = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal, | |
11003 | stop_frame_id, bp_until); | |
11004 | breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint)); | |
11005 | } | |
11006 | ||
11007 | tp->set_thread_fsm | |
11008 | (std::unique_ptr<thread_fsm> | |
11009 | (new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num, | |
11010 | std::move (breakpoints)))); | |
11011 | ||
11012 | if (lj_deleter) | |
11013 | lj_deleter->release (); | |
11014 | ||
11015 | proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT); | |
11016 | } | |
11017 | ||
11018 | \f | |
11019 | ||
11020 | /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */ | |
11021 | ||
11022 | static int | |
11023 | compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b) | |
11024 | { | |
11025 | uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a; | |
11026 | uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b; | |
11027 | ||
11028 | if (a->number < b->number) | |
11029 | return -1; | |
11030 | else if (a->number > b->number) | |
11031 | return 1; | |
11032 | ||
11033 | /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with | |
11034 | the number 0. */ | |
11035 | if (ua < ub) | |
11036 | return -1; | |
11037 | return ua > ub ? 1 : 0; | |
11038 | } | |
11039 | ||
11040 | /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */ | |
11041 | ||
11042 | static void | |
11043 | clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
11044 | { | |
11045 | int default_match; | |
11046 | ||
11047 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals; | |
11048 | symtab_and_line last_sal; | |
11049 | gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals; | |
11050 | if (arg) | |
11051 | { | |
11052 | decoded_sals | |
11053 | = decode_line_with_current_source (arg, | |
11054 | (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE | |
11055 | | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE)); | |
11056 | default_match = 0; | |
11057 | sals = decoded_sals; | |
11058 | } | |
11059 | else | |
11060 | { | |
11061 | /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values | |
11062 | corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the | |
11063 | codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */ | |
11064 | last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal (); | |
11065 | if (last_sal.symtab == 0) | |
11066 | error (_("No source file specified.")); | |
11067 | ||
11068 | default_match = 1; | |
11069 | sals = last_sal; | |
11070 | } | |
11071 | ||
11072 | /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it | |
11073 | seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both | |
11074 | file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can | |
11075 | match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all. | |
11076 | ||
11077 | We only support clearing given the address explicitly | |
11078 | present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint | |
11079 | at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line, | |
11080 | due to optimization, all in one block. | |
11081 | ||
11082 | We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another | |
11083 | PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't | |
11084 | be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but | |
11085 | since the other PC value is never presented to user, user | |
11086 | can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important | |
11087 | to support that. */ | |
11088 | ||
11089 | /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do | |
11090 | it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that | |
11091 | from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one | |
11092 | breakpoint. */ | |
11093 | ||
11094 | std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found; | |
11095 | for (const auto &sal : sals) | |
11096 | { | |
11097 | const char *sal_fullname; | |
11098 | ||
11099 | /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc. | |
11100 | If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line. | |
11101 | If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line | |
11102 | or at default pc. | |
11103 | ||
11104 | defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do | |
11105 | ||
11106 | 0 1 pc | |
11107 | 1 1 pc _and_ line | |
11108 | 0 0 line | |
11109 | 1 0 <can't happen> */ | |
11110 | ||
11111 | sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL | |
11112 | ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab)); | |
11113 | ||
11114 | /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */ | |
11115 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
11116 | { | |
11117 | int match = 0; | |
11118 | /* Are we going to delete b? */ | |
11119 | if (b.type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (&b) | |
11120 | && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
11121 | { | |
11122 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
11123 | { | |
11124 | /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC | |
11125 | match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */ | |
11126 | int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line | |
11127 | && sal.pc | |
11128 | && (loc.pspace == sal.pspace) | |
11129 | && (loc.address == sal.pc) | |
11130 | && (!section_is_overlay (loc.section) | |
11131 | || loc.section == sal.section)); | |
11132 | int line_match = 0; | |
11133 | ||
11134 | if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line) | |
11135 | && loc.symtab != NULL | |
11136 | && sal_fullname != NULL | |
11137 | && sal.pspace == loc.pspace | |
11138 | && loc.line_number == sal.line | |
11139 | && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc.symtab), | |
11140 | sal_fullname) == 0) | |
11141 | line_match = 1; | |
11142 | ||
11143 | if (pc_match || line_match) | |
11144 | { | |
11145 | match = 1; | |
11146 | break; | |
11147 | } | |
11148 | } | |
11149 | } | |
11150 | ||
11151 | if (match) | |
11152 | found.push_back (&b); | |
11153 | } | |
11154 | } | |
11155 | ||
11156 | /* Now go through the 'found' chain and delete them. */ | |
11157 | if (found.empty ()) | |
11158 | { | |
11159 | if (arg) | |
11160 | error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg); | |
11161 | else | |
11162 | error (_("No breakpoint at this line.")); | |
11163 | } | |
11164 | ||
11165 | /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */ | |
11166 | std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (), | |
11167 | [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) | |
11168 | { | |
11169 | return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0; | |
11170 | }); | |
11171 | found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (), | |
11172 | [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b) | |
11173 | { | |
11174 | return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0; | |
11175 | }), | |
11176 | found.end ()); | |
11177 | ||
11178 | if (found.size () > 1) | |
11179 | from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */ | |
11180 | if (from_tty) | |
11181 | { | |
11182 | if (found.size () == 1) | |
11183 | gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoint ")); | |
11184 | else | |
11185 | gdb_printf (_("Deleted breakpoints ")); | |
11186 | } | |
11187 | ||
11188 | for (breakpoint *iter : found) | |
11189 | { | |
11190 | if (from_tty) | |
11191 | gdb_printf ("%d ", iter->number); | |
11192 | delete_breakpoint (iter); | |
11193 | } | |
11194 | if (from_tty) | |
11195 | gdb_putc ('\n'); | |
11196 | } | |
11197 | \f | |
11198 | /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and | |
11199 | all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not. | |
11200 | This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */ | |
11201 | ||
11202 | void | |
11203 | breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat *bs) | |
11204 | { | |
11205 | for (; bs; bs = bs->next) | |
11206 | if (bs->breakpoint_at | |
11207 | && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del | |
11208 | && bs->stop) | |
11209 | delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at); | |
11210 | ||
11211 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
11212 | if (b.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop) | |
11213 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
11214 | } | |
11215 | ||
11216 | /* A comparison function for bp_location pointers A and B being interfaced to | |
11217 | std::sort, for instance to sort an std::vector<bp_location *>. Sort | |
11218 | elements: | |
11219 | - primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what bl_address_is_meaningful | |
11220 | says), | |
11221 | - secondarily by ordering first permanent elements, and | |
11222 | - tertiarily just ensuring the array is sorted in a stable way despite | |
11223 | std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */ | |
11224 | ||
11225 | static bool | |
11226 | bp_location_ptr_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b) | |
11227 | { | |
11228 | if (a->address != b->address) | |
11229 | return a->address < b->address; | |
11230 | ||
11231 | /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping | |
11232 | locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment) | |
11233 | grouped. */ | |
11234 | ||
11235 | if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num) | |
11236 | return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num; | |
11237 | ||
11238 | /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */ | |
11239 | if (a->permanent != b->permanent) | |
11240 | return a->permanent > b->permanent; | |
11241 | ||
11242 | /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier. | |
11243 | See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with | |
11244 | breakpoint_locations_match. */ | |
11245 | if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type) | |
11246 | return true; | |
11247 | ||
11248 | /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */ | |
11249 | if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
11250 | && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint | |
11251 | && a->length < b->length) | |
11252 | return true; | |
11253 | ||
11254 | /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs | |
11255 | where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of | |
11256 | the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */ | |
11257 | ||
11258 | if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number) | |
11259 | return a->owner->number < b->owner->number; | |
11260 | ||
11261 | return a < b; | |
11262 | } | |
11263 | ||
11264 | /* A comparison function for bp_locations A and B being interfaced to | |
11265 | std::sort, for instance to sort an std::vector<bp_location>. */ | |
11266 | ||
11267 | static bool | |
11268 | bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location &a, const bp_location &b) | |
11269 | { | |
11270 | return bp_location_ptr_is_less_than (&a, &b); | |
11271 | } | |
11272 | ||
11273 | /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and | |
11274 | bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current | |
11275 | content of the bp_locations array. */ | |
11276 | ||
11277 | static void | |
11278 | bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void) | |
11279 | { | |
11280 | bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0; | |
11281 | bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0; | |
11282 | ||
11283 | for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ()) | |
11284 | { | |
11285 | CORE_ADDR start, end, addr; | |
11286 | ||
11287 | if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl)) | |
11288 | continue; | |
11289 | ||
11290 | start = bl->target_info.placed_address; | |
11291 | end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len; | |
11292 | ||
11293 | gdb_assert (bl->address >= start); | |
11294 | addr = bl->address - start; | |
11295 | if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max) | |
11296 | bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr; | |
11297 | ||
11298 | /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */ | |
11299 | ||
11300 | gdb_assert (bl->address < end); | |
11301 | addr = end - bl->address; | |
11302 | if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max) | |
11303 | bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr; | |
11304 | } | |
11305 | } | |
11306 | ||
11307 | /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */ | |
11308 | ||
11309 | static void | |
11310 | download_tracepoint_locations (void) | |
11311 | { | |
11312 | enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN; | |
11313 | ||
11314 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
11315 | ||
11316 | for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | |
11317 | { | |
11318 | bool bp_location_downloaded = false; | |
11319 | ||
11320 | if ((b.type == bp_fast_tracepoint | |
11321 | ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints | |
11322 | : !may_insert_tracepoints)) | |
11323 | continue; | |
11324 | ||
11325 | if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN) | |
11326 | { | |
11327 | if (target_can_download_tracepoint ()) | |
11328 | can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE; | |
11329 | else | |
11330 | can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE; | |
11331 | } | |
11332 | ||
11333 | if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE) | |
11334 | break; | |
11335 | ||
11336 | for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | |
11337 | { | |
11338 | /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so | |
11339 | should_be_inserted is equivalent to | |
11340 | unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */ | |
11341 | if (!should_be_inserted (&bl) || bl.inserted) | |
11342 | continue; | |
11343 | ||
11344 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl.pspace); | |
11345 | ||
11346 | target_download_tracepoint (&bl); | |
11347 | ||
11348 | bl.inserted = 1; | |
11349 | bp_location_downloaded = true; | |
11350 | } | |
11351 | ||
11352 | tracepoint &t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | |
11353 | t.number_on_target = b.number; | |
11354 | if (bp_location_downloaded) | |
11355 | notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | |
11356 | } | |
11357 | } | |
11358 | ||
11359 | /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */ | |
11360 | ||
11361 | static void | |
11362 | swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right) | |
11363 | { | |
11364 | const int left_inserted = left->inserted; | |
11365 | const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate; | |
11366 | const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update; | |
11367 | const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info; | |
11368 | ||
11369 | /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */ | |
11370 | if (is_tracepoint (left->owner)) | |
11371 | gdb_assert (!left->duplicate); | |
11372 | if (is_tracepoint (right->owner)) | |
11373 | gdb_assert (!right->duplicate); | |
11374 | ||
11375 | left->inserted = right->inserted; | |
11376 | left->duplicate = right->duplicate; | |
11377 | left->needs_update = right->needs_update; | |
11378 | left->target_info = right->target_info; | |
11379 | right->inserted = left_inserted; | |
11380 | right->duplicate = left_duplicate; | |
11381 | right->needs_update = left_needs_update; | |
11382 | right->target_info = left_target_info; | |
11383 | } | |
11384 | ||
11385 | /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called | |
11386 | once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating | |
11387 | conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on | |
11388 | the target. */ | |
11389 | ||
11390 | static void | |
11391 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl) | |
11392 | { | |
11393 | CORE_ADDR address = 0; | |
11394 | int pspace_num; | |
11395 | ||
11396 | address = bl->address; | |
11397 | pspace_num = bl->pspace->num; | |
11398 | ||
11399 | /* This is only meaningful if the target is | |
11400 | evaluating conditions and if the user has | |
11401 | opted for condition evaluation on the target's | |
11402 | side. */ | |
11403 | if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p () | |
11404 | || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ()) | |
11405 | return; | |
11406 | ||
11407 | /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and | |
11408 | the same program space as the location | |
11409 | as "its condition has changed". We need to | |
11410 | update the conditions on the target's side. */ | |
11411 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address)) | |
11412 | { | |
11413 | if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner) | |
11414 | || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num) | |
11415 | continue; | |
11416 | ||
11417 | /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to | |
11418 | let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations | |
11419 | with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so | |
11420 | we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations | |
11421 | that have already been marked. */ | |
11422 | loc->condition_changed = condition_updated; | |
11423 | ||
11424 | /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute | |
11425 | it later on. */ | |
11426 | loc->cond_bytecode.reset (); | |
11427 | } | |
11428 | } | |
11429 | ||
11430 | /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints | |
11431 | deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which | |
11432 | locations are duplicate of which. | |
11433 | ||
11434 | The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or | |
11435 | shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more | |
11436 | info. */ | |
11437 | ||
11438 | static void | |
11439 | update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | |
11440 | { | |
11441 | /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */ | |
11442 | CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0; | |
11443 | /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */ | |
11444 | int last_pspace_num = -1; | |
11445 | ||
11446 | breakpoint_debug_printf ("insert_mode = %s", | |
11447 | ugll_insert_mode_text (insert_mode)); | |
11448 | ||
11449 | /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all | |
11450 | bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address. | |
11451 | Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never | |
11452 | duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of | |
11453 | breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations | |
11454 | once. */ | |
11455 | struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */ | |
11456 | struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */ | |
11457 | struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */ | |
11458 | struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */ | |
11459 | ||
11460 | /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly | |
11461 | built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */ | |
11462 | std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations); | |
11463 | bp_locations.clear (); | |
11464 | ||
11465 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
11466 | for (bp_location &loc : b.locations ()) | |
11467 | bp_locations.push_back (&loc); | |
11468 | ||
11469 | /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware | |
11470 | breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are | |
11471 | duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order | |
11472 | depends on location type. */ | |
11473 | for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations) | |
11474 | if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc)) | |
11475 | handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc); | |
11476 | ||
11477 | std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (), | |
11478 | bp_location_ptr_is_less_than); | |
11479 | ||
11480 | bp_locations_target_extensions_update (); | |
11481 | ||
11482 | /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the | |
11483 | new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not | |
11484 | necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior -- | |
11485 | if there's another location at the same address (previously | |
11486 | marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the | |
11487 | location. | |
11488 | ||
11489 | LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current | |
11490 | and former bp_location array state respectively. */ | |
11491 | ||
11492 | size_t loc_i = 0; | |
11493 | for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations) | |
11494 | { | |
11495 | /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If | |
11496 | not, we have to free it. */ | |
11497 | bool found_object = false; | |
11498 | /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */ | |
11499 | bool keep_in_target = false; | |
11500 | bool removed = false; | |
11501 | ||
11502 | /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed. | |
11503 | Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */ | |
11504 | while (loc_i < bp_locations.size () | |
11505 | && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address) | |
11506 | loc_i++; | |
11507 | ||
11508 | for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; | |
11509 | (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () | |
11510 | && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); | |
11511 | loc2_i++) | |
11512 | { | |
11513 | /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated | |
11514 | location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send | |
11515 | its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking | |
11516 | place there. */ | |
11517 | if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified | |
11518 | && (last_addr != old_loc->address | |
11519 | || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num)) | |
11520 | { | |
11521 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]); | |
11522 | last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num; | |
11523 | } | |
11524 | ||
11525 | if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc) | |
11526 | found_object = true; | |
11527 | } | |
11528 | ||
11529 | /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't | |
11530 | have to go through updates again. */ | |
11531 | last_addr = old_loc->address; | |
11532 | ||
11533 | /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */ | |
11534 | if (!found_object) | |
11535 | force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc); | |
11536 | ||
11537 | /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if | |
11538 | there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so, | |
11539 | mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is | |
11540 | needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint | |
11541 | at certain location is not inserted. */ | |
11542 | ||
11543 | if (old_loc->inserted) | |
11544 | { | |
11545 | /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove | |
11546 | it. */ | |
11547 | ||
11548 | if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc)) | |
11549 | { | |
11550 | /* The location is still present in the location list, | |
11551 | and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */ | |
11552 | keep_in_target = true; | |
11553 | } | |
11554 | else | |
11555 | { | |
11556 | /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the | |
11557 | target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to | |
11558 | remove its target-side condition. */ | |
11559 | ||
11560 | /* The location is either no longer present, or got | |
11561 | disabled. See if there's another location at the | |
11562 | same address, in which case we don't need to remove | |
11563 | this one from the target. */ | |
11564 | ||
11565 | /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */ | |
11566 | if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc)) | |
11567 | { | |
11568 | for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i; | |
11569 | (loc2_i < bp_locations.size () | |
11570 | && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address); | |
11571 | loc2_i++) | |
11572 | { | |
11573 | bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i]; | |
11574 | ||
11575 | if (loc2 == old_loc) | |
11576 | continue; | |
11577 | ||
11578 | if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc)) | |
11579 | { | |
11580 | /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to | |
11581 | access watchpoints, if the former are not | |
11582 | supported, but the latter are. */ | |
11583 | if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner)) | |
11584 | { | |
11585 | gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner)); | |
11586 | loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type; | |
11587 | } | |
11588 | ||
11589 | /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check | |
11590 | if it should be inserted in case it will be | |
11591 | unduplicated. */ | |
11592 | if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2)) | |
11593 | { | |
11594 | swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2); | |
11595 | keep_in_target = true; | |
11596 | break; | |
11597 | } | |
11598 | } | |
11599 | } | |
11600 | } | |
11601 | } | |
11602 | ||
11603 | if (!keep_in_target) | |
11604 | { | |
11605 | if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc)) | |
11606 | { | |
11607 | /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep | |
11608 | this location on the global list, and try to | |
11609 | remove it next time, but there's no particular | |
11610 | reason why we will succeed next time. | |
11611 | ||
11612 | Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still | |
11613 | valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint | |
11614 | only after calling us. */ | |
11615 | warning (_("error removing breakpoint %d at %s"), | |
11616 | old_loc->owner->number, | |
11617 | paddress (old_loc->gdbarch, old_loc->address)); | |
11618 | } | |
11619 | removed = true; | |
11620 | } | |
11621 | } | |
11622 | ||
11623 | if (!found_object) | |
11624 | { | |
11625 | if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p () | |
11626 | && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc)) | |
11627 | { | |
11628 | /* This location was removed from the target. In | |
11629 | non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where | |
11630 | we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that | |
11631 | breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later. | |
11632 | We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such | |
11633 | SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this | |
11634 | breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it | |
11635 | after we see some number of events. The theory here | |
11636 | is that reporting of events should, "on the average", | |
11637 | be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all | |
11638 | threads that have anything of interest, and no longer | |
11639 | need to keep this breakpoint location around. We | |
11640 | don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of | |
11641 | mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint | |
11642 | SIGTRAP. | |
11643 | ||
11644 | The heuristic failing can be disastrous on | |
11645 | decr_pc_after_break targets. | |
11646 | ||
11647 | On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux, | |
11648 | if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP, | |
11649 | because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too | |
11650 | soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report | |
11651 | a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes | |
11652 | the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash | |
11653 | with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently | |
11654 | corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the | |
11655 | middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a | |
11656 | one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen | |
11657 | on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on | |
11658 | targets that do not support new thread events, like | |
11659 | remote, due to the heuristic depending on | |
11660 | thread_count. | |
11661 | ||
11662 | Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap | |
11663 | causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when | |
11664 | it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs | |
11665 | behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble. | |
11666 | ||
11667 | Since hardware watchpoint traps are always | |
11668 | distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to | |
11669 | apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations | |
11670 | around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint | |
11671 | traps we can no longer explain. */ | |
11672 | ||
11673 | process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr; | |
11674 | for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ()) | |
11675 | if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace) | |
11676 | { | |
11677 | proc_target = inf->process_target (); | |
11678 | break; | |
11679 | } | |
11680 | if (proc_target != nullptr) | |
11681 | old_loc->events_till_retirement | |
11682 | = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1); | |
11683 | else | |
11684 | old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1; | |
11685 | old_loc->owner = NULL; | |
11686 | ||
11687 | moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc); | |
11688 | } | |
11689 | else | |
11690 | { | |
11691 | old_loc->owner = NULL; | |
11692 | decref_bp_location (&old_loc); | |
11693 | } | |
11694 | } | |
11695 | } | |
11696 | ||
11697 | /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the | |
11698 | first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so | |
11699 | that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a | |
11700 | permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the | |
11701 | official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints | |
11702 | are sorted first for the same address. | |
11703 | ||
11704 | Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the | |
11705 | watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */ | |
11706 | ||
11707 | bp_loc_first = NULL; | |
11708 | wp_loc_first = NULL; | |
11709 | awp_loc_first = NULL; | |
11710 | rwp_loc_first = NULL; | |
11711 | ||
11712 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
11713 | { | |
11714 | /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always | |
11715 | non-NULL. */ | |
11716 | struct bp_location **loc_first_p; | |
11717 | breakpoint *b = loc->owner; | |
11718 | ||
11719 | if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc) | |
11720 | || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc) | |
11721 | /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are | |
11722 | never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of | |
11723 | `struct bp_location'. */ | |
11724 | || is_tracepoint (b)) | |
11725 | { | |
11726 | /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ | |
11727 | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | |
11728 | continue; | |
11729 | } | |
11730 | ||
11731 | if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | |
11732 | loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first; | |
11733 | else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint) | |
11734 | loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first; | |
11735 | else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint) | |
11736 | loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first; | |
11737 | else | |
11738 | loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first; | |
11739 | ||
11740 | if (*loc_first_p == NULL | |
11741 | || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section) | |
11742 | || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p)) | |
11743 | { | |
11744 | *loc_first_p = loc; | |
11745 | loc->duplicate = 0; | |
11746 | ||
11747 | if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed) | |
11748 | { | |
11749 | loc->needs_update = 1; | |
11750 | /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ | |
11751 | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | |
11752 | } | |
11753 | continue; | |
11754 | } | |
11755 | ||
11756 | ||
11757 | /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location | |
11758 | is not duplicated, and is the inserted one. | |
11759 | All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */ | |
11760 | if (loc->inserted) | |
11761 | swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p); | |
11762 | loc->duplicate = 1; | |
11763 | ||
11764 | /* Clear the condition modification flag. */ | |
11765 | loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged; | |
11766 | } | |
11767 | ||
11768 | if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ()) | |
11769 | { | |
11770 | if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | |
11771 | insert_breakpoint_locations (); | |
11772 | else | |
11773 | { | |
11774 | /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new | |
11775 | locations, we may still need to update conditions on the | |
11776 | target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted | |
11777 | if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We | |
11778 | only update conditions for locations that are marked | |
11779 | "needs_update". */ | |
11780 | update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (); | |
11781 | } | |
11782 | } | |
11783 | ||
11784 | if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT) | |
11785 | download_tracepoint_locations (); | |
11786 | } | |
11787 | ||
11788 | void | |
11789 | breakpoint_retire_moribund (void) | |
11790 | { | |
11791 | for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix) | |
11792 | { | |
11793 | struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix]; | |
11794 | if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0) | |
11795 | { | |
11796 | decref_bp_location (&loc); | |
11797 | unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix); | |
11798 | --ix; | |
11799 | } | |
11800 | } | |
11801 | } | |
11802 | ||
11803 | static void | |
11804 | update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode) | |
11805 | { | |
11806 | ||
11807 | try | |
11808 | { | |
11809 | update_global_location_list (insert_mode); | |
11810 | } | |
11811 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
11812 | { | |
11813 | } | |
11814 | } | |
11815 | ||
11816 | /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */ | |
11817 | ||
11818 | static void | |
11819 | bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat *bps, struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
11820 | { | |
11821 | bpstat *bs; | |
11822 | ||
11823 | for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next) | |
11824 | if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt) | |
11825 | { | |
11826 | bs->breakpoint_at = NULL; | |
11827 | bs->old_val = NULL; | |
11828 | /* bs->commands will be freed later. */ | |
11829 | } | |
11830 | } | |
11831 | ||
11832 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
11833 | ||
11834 | void | |
11835 | code_breakpoint::say_where () const | |
11836 | { | |
11837 | struct value_print_options opts; | |
11838 | ||
11839 | get_user_print_options (&opts); | |
11840 | ||
11841 | /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a | |
11842 | single string. */ | |
11843 | if (!this->has_locations ()) | |
11844 | { | |
11845 | /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based | |
11846 | on extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either | |
11847 | a condition or dprintf arguments. */ | |
11848 | if (extra_string == NULL) | |
11849 | { | |
11850 | gdb_printf (_(" (%s) pending."), locspec->to_string ()); | |
11851 | } | |
11852 | else if (type == bp_dprintf) | |
11853 | { | |
11854 | gdb_printf (_(" (%s,%s) pending."), | |
11855 | locspec->to_string (), | |
11856 | extra_string.get ()); | |
11857 | } | |
11858 | else | |
11859 | { | |
11860 | gdb_printf (_(" (%s %s) pending."), | |
11861 | locspec->to_string (), | |
11862 | extra_string.get ()); | |
11863 | } | |
11864 | } | |
11865 | else | |
11866 | { | |
11867 | const bp_location &bl = this->first_loc (); | |
11868 | if (opts.addressprint || bl.symtab == nullptr) | |
11869 | gdb_printf (" at %ps", | |
11870 | styled_string (address_style.style (), | |
11871 | paddress (bl.gdbarch, | |
11872 | bl.address))); | |
11873 | if (bl.symtab != NULL) | |
11874 | { | |
11875 | /* If there is a single location, we can print the location | |
11876 | more nicely. */ | |
11877 | if (!this->has_multiple_locations ()) | |
11878 | { | |
11879 | const char *filename | |
11880 | = symtab_to_filename_for_display (bl.symtab); | |
11881 | gdb_printf (": file %ps, line %ps.", | |
11882 | styled_string (file_name_style.style (), | |
11883 | filename), | |
11884 | styled_string (line_number_style.style (), | |
11885 | pulongest (bl.line_number))); | |
11886 | } | |
11887 | else | |
11888 | /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a | |
11889 | different file name, and this at least reflects the | |
11890 | real situation somewhat. */ | |
11891 | gdb_printf (": %s.", locspec->to_string ()); | |
11892 | } | |
11893 | ||
11894 | if (this->has_multiple_locations ()) | |
11895 | { | |
11896 | int n = std::distance (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end ()); | |
11897 | gdb_printf (" (%d locations)", n); | |
11898 | } | |
11899 | } | |
11900 | } | |
11901 | ||
11902 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
11903 | ||
11904 | bp_location_range | |
11905 | breakpoint::locations () const | |
11906 | { | |
11907 | return bp_location_range (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end ()); | |
11908 | } | |
11909 | ||
11910 | struct bp_location * | |
11911 | breakpoint::allocate_location () | |
11912 | { | |
11913 | return new bp_location (this); | |
11914 | } | |
11915 | ||
11916 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
11917 | ||
11918 | void | |
11919 | breakpoint::add_location (bp_location &loc) | |
11920 | { | |
11921 | gdb_assert (loc.owner == this); | |
11922 | gdb_assert (!loc.is_linked ()); | |
11923 | ||
11924 | auto ub = std::upper_bound (m_locations.begin (), m_locations.end (), | |
11925 | loc, | |
11926 | bp_location_is_less_than); | |
11927 | m_locations.insert (ub, loc); | |
11928 | } | |
11929 | ||
11930 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
11931 | ||
11932 | void | |
11933 | breakpoint::unadd_location (bp_location &loc) | |
11934 | { | |
11935 | gdb_assert (loc.owner == this); | |
11936 | gdb_assert (loc.is_linked ()); | |
11937 | ||
11938 | m_locations.erase (m_locations.iterator_to (loc)); | |
11939 | } | |
11940 | ||
11941 | #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \ | |
11942 | gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called") | |
11943 | ||
11944 | int | |
11945 | breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | |
11946 | { | |
11947 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11948 | } | |
11949 | ||
11950 | int | |
11951 | breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | |
11952 | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | |
11953 | { | |
11954 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11955 | } | |
11956 | ||
11957 | int | |
11958 | breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
11959 | const address_space *aspace, | |
11960 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
11961 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
11962 | { | |
11963 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11964 | } | |
11965 | ||
11966 | int | |
11967 | breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
11968 | { | |
11969 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11970 | } | |
11971 | ||
11972 | enum print_stop_action | |
11973 | breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
11974 | { | |
11975 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11976 | } | |
11977 | ||
11978 | void | |
11979 | breakpoint::print_mention () const | |
11980 | { | |
11981 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11982 | } | |
11983 | ||
11984 | void | |
11985 | breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
11986 | { | |
11987 | internal_error_pure_virtual_called (); | |
11988 | } | |
11989 | ||
11990 | /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */ | |
11991 | ||
11992 | void | |
11993 | code_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | |
11994 | { | |
11995 | /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */ | |
11996 | if (breakpoint_location_spec_empty_p (this)) | |
11997 | { | |
11998 | /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */ | |
11999 | delete_breakpoint (this); | |
12000 | return; | |
12001 | } | |
12002 | ||
12003 | re_set_default (pspace); | |
12004 | } | |
12005 | ||
12006 | int | |
12007 | code_breakpoint::insert_location (struct bp_location *bl) | |
12008 | { | |
12009 | CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address; | |
12010 | ||
12011 | bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr); | |
12012 | bl->target_info.placed_address = addr; | |
12013 | ||
12014 | int result; | |
12015 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
12016 | result = target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | |
12017 | else | |
12018 | result = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | |
12019 | ||
12020 | if (result == 0 && bl->probe.prob != nullptr) | |
12021 | { | |
12022 | /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore | |
12023 | if needed. */ | |
12024 | bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); | |
12025 | } | |
12026 | ||
12027 | return result; | |
12028 | } | |
12029 | ||
12030 | int | |
12031 | code_breakpoint::remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, | |
12032 | enum remove_bp_reason reason) | |
12033 | { | |
12034 | if (bl->probe.prob != nullptr) | |
12035 | { | |
12036 | /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */ | |
12037 | bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch); | |
12038 | } | |
12039 | ||
12040 | if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint) | |
12041 | return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info); | |
12042 | else | |
12043 | return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason); | |
12044 | } | |
12045 | ||
12046 | int | |
12047 | code_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
12048 | const address_space *aspace, | |
12049 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
12050 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
12051 | { | |
12052 | if (ws.kind () != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED | |
12053 | || ws.sig () != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP) | |
12054 | return 0; | |
12055 | ||
12056 | if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace.get (), bl->address, | |
12057 | aspace, bp_addr)) | |
12058 | return 0; | |
12059 | ||
12060 | if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */ | |
12061 | && section_is_overlay (bl->section) | |
12062 | && !section_is_mapped (bl->section)) | |
12063 | return 0; | |
12064 | ||
12065 | return 1; | |
12066 | } | |
12067 | ||
12068 | int | |
12069 | dprintf_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
12070 | const address_space *aspace, | |
12071 | CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
12072 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
12073 | { | |
12074 | if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent | |
12075 | && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ()) | |
12076 | { | |
12077 | /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap | |
12078 | for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to | |
12079 | be set at the same address. */ | |
12080 | return 0; | |
12081 | } | |
12082 | ||
12083 | return this->ordinary_breakpoint::breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws); | |
12084 | } | |
12085 | ||
12086 | int | |
12087 | ordinary_breakpoint::resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl) | |
12088 | { | |
12089 | gdb_assert (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint); | |
12090 | ||
12091 | return 1; | |
12092 | } | |
12093 | ||
12094 | enum print_stop_action | |
12095 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
12096 | { | |
12097 | const struct bp_location *bl; | |
12098 | int bp_temp; | |
12099 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
12100 | ||
12101 | bl = bs->bp_location_at.get (); | |
12102 | ||
12103 | bp_temp = disposition == disp_del; | |
12104 | if (bl->address != bl->requested_address) | |
12105 | breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address, | |
12106 | bl->address, | |
12107 | number, true); | |
12108 | annotate_breakpoint (number); | |
12109 | maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout); | |
12110 | ||
12111 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
12112 | { | |
12113 | uiout->field_string ("reason", | |
12114 | async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT)); | |
12115 | uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (disposition)); | |
12116 | } | |
12117 | ||
12118 | if (bp_temp) | |
12119 | uiout->text ("Temporary breakpoint "); | |
12120 | else | |
12121 | uiout->text ("Breakpoint "); | |
12122 | print_num_locno (bs, uiout); | |
12123 | uiout->text (", "); | |
12124 | ||
12125 | return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC; | |
12126 | } | |
12127 | ||
12128 | void | |
12129 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_mention () const | |
12130 | { | |
12131 | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
12132 | return; | |
12133 | ||
12134 | switch (type) | |
12135 | { | |
12136 | case bp_breakpoint: | |
12137 | case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver: | |
12138 | if (disposition == disp_del) | |
12139 | gdb_printf (_("Temporary breakpoint")); | |
12140 | else | |
12141 | gdb_printf (_("Breakpoint")); | |
12142 | gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | |
12143 | if (type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver) | |
12144 | gdb_printf (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver")); | |
12145 | break; | |
12146 | case bp_hardware_breakpoint: | |
12147 | gdb_printf (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), number); | |
12148 | break; | |
12149 | case bp_dprintf: | |
12150 | gdb_printf (_("Dprintf %d"), number); | |
12151 | break; | |
12152 | } | |
12153 | ||
12154 | say_where (); | |
12155 | } | |
12156 | ||
12157 | void | |
12158 | ordinary_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
12159 | { | |
12160 | if (type == bp_breakpoint && disposition == disp_del) | |
12161 | gdb_printf (fp, "tbreak"); | |
12162 | else if (type == bp_breakpoint) | |
12163 | gdb_printf (fp, "break"); | |
12164 | else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint | |
12165 | && disposition == disp_del) | |
12166 | gdb_printf (fp, "thbreak"); | |
12167 | else if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | |
12168 | gdb_printf (fp, "hbreak"); | |
12169 | else | |
12170 | internal_error (_("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) type); | |
12171 | ||
12172 | gdb_printf (fp, " %s", locspec->to_string ()); | |
12173 | ||
12174 | /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might | |
12175 | contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */ | |
12176 | if (!this->has_locations () && extra_string != NULL) | |
12177 | gdb_printf (fp, " %s", extra_string.get ()); | |
12178 | ||
12179 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
12180 | } | |
12181 | ||
12182 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | |
12183 | code_breakpoint::decode_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | |
12184 | program_space *search_pspace) | |
12185 | { | |
12186 | if (locspec->type () == PROBE_LOCATION_SPEC) | |
12187 | return bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec (this, locspec, search_pspace); | |
12188 | ||
12189 | struct linespec_result canonical; | |
12190 | ||
12191 | decode_line_full (locspec, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace, | |
12192 | NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all, | |
12193 | filter.get ()); | |
12194 | ||
12195 | /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */ | |
12196 | gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2); | |
12197 | ||
12198 | if (!canonical.lsals.empty ()) | |
12199 | { | |
12200 | const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0]; | |
12201 | return std::move (lsal.sals); | |
12202 | } | |
12203 | return {}; | |
12204 | } | |
12205 | ||
12206 | /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */ | |
12207 | ||
12208 | void | |
12209 | internal_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | |
12210 | { | |
12211 | switch (type) | |
12212 | { | |
12213 | /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they | |
12214 | will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */ | |
12215 | case bp_overlay_event: | |
12216 | case bp_longjmp_master: | |
12217 | case bp_std_terminate_master: | |
12218 | case bp_exception_master: | |
12219 | delete_breakpoint (this); | |
12220 | break; | |
12221 | ||
12222 | /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior | |
12223 | starts and we really don't want to touch it. */ | |
12224 | case bp_shlib_event: | |
12225 | ||
12226 | /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once | |
12227 | it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */ | |
12228 | case bp_thread_event: | |
12229 | break; | |
12230 | } | |
12231 | } | |
12232 | ||
12233 | void | |
12234 | internal_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | |
12235 | { | |
12236 | if (type == bp_shlib_event) | |
12237 | { | |
12238 | /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of | |
12239 | events. This allows the user to get control and place | |
12240 | breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded | |
12241 | objects (among other things). */ | |
12242 | bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events != 0; | |
12243 | bs->print = stop_on_solib_events != 0; | |
12244 | } | |
12245 | else | |
12246 | bs->stop = false; | |
12247 | } | |
12248 | ||
12249 | enum print_stop_action | |
12250 | internal_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
12251 | { | |
12252 | switch (type) | |
12253 | { | |
12254 | case bp_shlib_event: | |
12255 | /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events | |
12256 | variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due | |
12257 | to shlib event" message.) */ | |
12258 | print_solib_event (false); | |
12259 | break; | |
12260 | ||
12261 | case bp_thread_event: | |
12262 | /* Not sure how we will get here. | |
12263 | GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */ | |
12264 | gdb_printf (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | |
12265 | break; | |
12266 | ||
12267 | case bp_overlay_event: | |
12268 | /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */ | |
12269 | gdb_printf (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | |
12270 | break; | |
12271 | ||
12272 | case bp_longjmp_master: | |
12273 | /* These should never be enabled. */ | |
12274 | gdb_printf (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n")); | |
12275 | break; | |
12276 | ||
12277 | case bp_std_terminate_master: | |
12278 | /* These should never be enabled. */ | |
12279 | gdb_printf (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: " | |
12280 | "gdb should not stop!\n")); | |
12281 | break; | |
12282 | ||
12283 | case bp_exception_master: | |
12284 | /* These should never be enabled. */ | |
12285 | gdb_printf (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: " | |
12286 | "gdb should not stop!\n")); | |
12287 | break; | |
12288 | } | |
12289 | ||
12290 | return PRINT_NOTHING; | |
12291 | } | |
12292 | ||
12293 | void | |
12294 | internal_breakpoint::print_mention () const | |
12295 | { | |
12296 | /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */ | |
12297 | } | |
12298 | ||
12299 | /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */ | |
12300 | ||
12301 | void | |
12302 | momentary_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | |
12303 | { | |
12304 | /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step | |
12305 | over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints. | |
12306 | Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain | |
12307 | or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */ | |
12308 | } | |
12309 | ||
12310 | void | |
12311 | momentary_breakpoint::check_status (bpstat *bs) | |
12312 | { | |
12313 | /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */ | |
12314 | } | |
12315 | ||
12316 | enum print_stop_action | |
12317 | momentary_breakpoint::print_it (const bpstat *bs) const | |
12318 | { | |
12319 | return PRINT_UNKNOWN; | |
12320 | } | |
12321 | ||
12322 | void | |
12323 | momentary_breakpoint::print_mention () const | |
12324 | { | |
12325 | /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */ | |
12326 | } | |
12327 | ||
12328 | /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists. | |
12329 | ||
12330 | It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed | |
12331 | breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */ | |
12332 | ||
12333 | longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint () | |
12334 | { | |
12335 | thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread); | |
12336 | ||
12337 | if (tp != NULL) | |
12338 | tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id; | |
12339 | } | |
12340 | ||
12341 | static void | |
12342 | bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | |
12343 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
12344 | struct program_space *search_pspace) | |
12345 | ||
12346 | { | |
12347 | struct linespec_sals lsal; | |
12348 | ||
12349 | lsal.sals = parse_probes (locspec, search_pspace, canonical); | |
12350 | lsal.canonical = xstrdup (canonical->locspec->to_string ()); | |
12351 | canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | |
12352 | } | |
12353 | ||
12354 | static std::vector<symtab_and_line> | |
12355 | bkpt_probe_decode_location_spec (struct breakpoint *b, | |
12356 | location_spec *locspec, | |
12357 | program_space *search_pspace) | |
12358 | { | |
12359 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | |
12360 | = parse_probes (locspec, search_pspace, NULL); | |
12361 | if (sals.empty ()) | |
12362 | error (_("probe not found")); | |
12363 | return sals; | |
12364 | } | |
12365 | ||
12366 | int | |
12367 | tracepoint::breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl, | |
12368 | const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr, | |
12369 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
12370 | { | |
12371 | /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at | |
12372 | tracepoints. */ | |
12373 | return 0; | |
12374 | } | |
12375 | ||
12376 | void | |
12377 | tracepoint::print_one_detail (struct ui_out *uiout) const | |
12378 | { | |
12379 | if (!static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) | |
12380 | { | |
12381 | gdb_assert (type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
12382 | || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint); | |
12383 | ||
12384 | uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n", | |
12385 | string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id", | |
12386 | static_trace_marker_id.c_str ())); | |
12387 | } | |
12388 | } | |
12389 | ||
12390 | void | |
12391 | tracepoint::print_mention () const | |
12392 | { | |
12393 | if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
12394 | return; | |
12395 | ||
12396 | switch (type) | |
12397 | { | |
12398 | case bp_tracepoint: | |
12399 | gdb_printf (_("Tracepoint")); | |
12400 | gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | |
12401 | break; | |
12402 | case bp_fast_tracepoint: | |
12403 | gdb_printf (_("Fast tracepoint")); | |
12404 | gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | |
12405 | break; | |
12406 | case bp_static_tracepoint: | |
12407 | case bp_static_marker_tracepoint: | |
12408 | gdb_printf (_("Static tracepoint")); | |
12409 | gdb_printf (_(" %d"), number); | |
12410 | break; | |
12411 | default: | |
12412 | internal_error (_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); | |
12413 | } | |
12414 | ||
12415 | say_where (); | |
12416 | } | |
12417 | ||
12418 | void | |
12419 | tracepoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
12420 | { | |
12421 | if (type == bp_fast_tracepoint) | |
12422 | gdb_printf (fp, "ftrace"); | |
12423 | else if (type == bp_static_tracepoint | |
12424 | || type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint) | |
12425 | gdb_printf (fp, "strace"); | |
12426 | else if (type == bp_tracepoint) | |
12427 | gdb_printf (fp, "trace"); | |
12428 | else | |
12429 | internal_error (_("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) type); | |
12430 | ||
12431 | gdb_printf (fp, " %s", locspec->to_string ()); | |
12432 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
12433 | ||
12434 | if (pass_count) | |
12435 | gdb_printf (fp, " passcount %d\n", pass_count); | |
12436 | } | |
12437 | ||
12438 | void | |
12439 | dprintf_breakpoint::re_set (struct program_space *pspace) | |
12440 | { | |
12441 | re_set_default (pspace); | |
12442 | ||
12443 | /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands. | |
12444 | 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine. | |
12445 | 3 - disconnect from target 1 | |
12446 | 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands. | |
12447 | ||
12448 | After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to | |
12449 | be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different | |
12450 | answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands(). | |
12451 | Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do | |
12452 | it all the time. */ | |
12453 | update_dprintf_command_list (this); | |
12454 | } | |
12455 | ||
12456 | /* Implement the "print_recreate" method for dprintf. */ | |
12457 | ||
12458 | void | |
12459 | dprintf_breakpoint::print_recreate (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
12460 | { | |
12461 | gdb_printf (fp, "dprintf %s,%s", locspec->to_string (), extra_string.get ()); | |
12462 | print_recreate_thread (fp); | |
12463 | } | |
12464 | ||
12465 | /* Implement the "after_condition_true" method for dprintf. | |
12466 | ||
12467 | dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command | |
12468 | list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the | |
12469 | stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This | |
12470 | also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same | |
12471 | address are all handled. */ | |
12472 | ||
12473 | void | |
12474 | dprintf_breakpoint::after_condition_true (struct bpstat *bs) | |
12475 | { | |
12476 | /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the | |
12477 | check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's | |
12478 | condition not be evaluated. */ | |
12479 | bs->stop = false; | |
12480 | ||
12481 | /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of | |
12482 | copying. We never want these commands to run later in | |
12483 | bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to | |
12484 | be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the | |
12485 | commands here throws. */ | |
12486 | counted_command_line cmds = std::move (bs->commands); | |
12487 | gdb_assert (cmds != nullptr); | |
12488 | execute_control_commands (cmds.get (), 0); | |
12489 | } | |
12490 | ||
12491 | /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with | |
12492 | markers (`-m'). */ | |
12493 | ||
12494 | static void | |
12495 | strace_marker_create_sals_from_location_spec | |
12496 | (location_spec *locspec, | |
12497 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
12498 | struct program_space *search_pspace) | |
12499 | { | |
12500 | struct linespec_sals lsal; | |
12501 | const char *arg_start, *arg; | |
12502 | ||
12503 | arg = arg_start = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | |
12504 | lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg); | |
12505 | ||
12506 | std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start); | |
12507 | const char *ptr = str.c_str (); | |
12508 | canonical->locspec | |
12509 | = new_linespec_location_spec (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL); | |
12510 | ||
12511 | lsal.canonical = xstrdup (canonical->locspec->to_string ()); | |
12512 | canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal)); | |
12513 | } | |
12514 | ||
12515 | static void | |
12516 | strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
12517 | struct linespec_result *canonical, | |
12518 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string, | |
12519 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string, | |
12520 | enum bptype type_wanted, | |
12521 | enum bpdisp disposition, | |
12522 | int thread, | |
12523 | int task, int inferior, | |
12524 | int ignore_count, | |
12525 | int from_tty, int enabled, | |
12526 | int internal, unsigned flags) | |
12527 | { | |
12528 | const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0]; | |
12529 | ||
12530 | /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id | |
12531 | (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that | |
12532 | breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly | |
12533 | found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to | |
12534 | expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS | |
12535 | already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */ | |
12536 | ||
12537 | for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++) | |
12538 | { | |
12539 | location_spec_up locspec = canonical->locspec->clone (); | |
12540 | ||
12541 | std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp | |
12542 | (new tracepoint (gdbarch, | |
12543 | type_wanted, | |
12544 | lsal.sals[i], | |
12545 | std::move (locspec), | |
12546 | NULL, | |
12547 | std::move (cond_string), | |
12548 | std::move (extra_string), | |
12549 | disposition, | |
12550 | thread, task, inferior, ignore_count, | |
12551 | from_tty, enabled, flags, | |
12552 | canonical->special_display)); | |
12553 | ||
12554 | /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with | |
12555 | the same string id, if the user is creating a static | |
12556 | tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then | |
12557 | store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can | |
12558 | try to match up which of the newly found markers | |
12559 | corresponds to this one */ | |
12560 | tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i; | |
12561 | ||
12562 | install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0); | |
12563 | } | |
12564 | } | |
12565 | ||
12566 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | |
12567 | static_marker_tracepoint::decode_location_spec (location_spec *locspec, | |
12568 | program_space *search_pspace) | |
12569 | { | |
12570 | const char *s = as_linespec_location_spec (locspec)->spec_string.get (); | |
12571 | ||
12572 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s); | |
12573 | if (sals.size () > static_trace_marker_id_idx) | |
12574 | { | |
12575 | sals[0] = sals[static_trace_marker_id_idx]; | |
12576 | sals.resize (1); | |
12577 | return sals; | |
12578 | } | |
12579 | else | |
12580 | error (_("marker %s not found"), static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | |
12581 | } | |
12582 | ||
12583 | /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */ | |
12584 | static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops = | |
12585 | { | |
12586 | strace_marker_create_sals_from_location_spec, | |
12587 | strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal, | |
12588 | }; | |
12589 | ||
12590 | static bool | |
12591 | strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b) | |
12592 | { | |
12593 | return b->type == bp_static_marker_tracepoint; | |
12594 | } | |
12595 | ||
12596 | /* Notify interpreters and observers that breakpoint B was deleted. */ | |
12597 | ||
12598 | static void | |
12599 | notify_breakpoint_deleted (breakpoint *b) | |
12600 | { | |
12601 | interps_notify_breakpoint_deleted (b); | |
12602 | gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (b); | |
12603 | } | |
12604 | ||
12605 | /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data | |
12606 | structures. */ | |
12607 | ||
12608 | void | |
12609 | delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
12610 | { | |
12611 | gdb_assert (bpt != NULL); | |
12612 | ||
12613 | /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because | |
12614 | multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are | |
12615 | especial culprits. | |
12616 | ||
12617 | One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When | |
12618 | the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of | |
12619 | scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the | |
12620 | scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat. | |
12621 | That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are | |
12622 | deleted. | |
12623 | ||
12624 | A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in | |
12625 | bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing | |
12626 | bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's | |
12627 | storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid | |
12628 | was chosen. */ | |
12629 | if (bpt->type == bp_none) | |
12630 | return; | |
12631 | ||
12632 | /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting | |
12633 | of breakpoints gets resolved. */ | |
12634 | if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt) | |
12635 | { | |
12636 | struct breakpoint *related; | |
12637 | struct watchpoint *w; | |
12638 | ||
12639 | if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | |
12640 | w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt->related_breakpoint); | |
12641 | else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | |
12642 | w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt); | |
12643 | else | |
12644 | w = NULL; | |
12645 | if (w != NULL) | |
12646 | watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w); | |
12647 | ||
12648 | /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */ | |
12649 | for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt; | |
12650 | related = related->related_breakpoint); | |
12651 | related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint; | |
12652 | bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt; | |
12653 | } | |
12654 | ||
12655 | /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if | |
12656 | update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's | |
12657 | a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created | |
12658 | watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */ | |
12659 | if (bpt->number) | |
12660 | notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt); | |
12661 | ||
12662 | breakpoint_chain.erase (breakpoint_chain.iterator_to (*bpt)); | |
12663 | ||
12664 | /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's | |
12665 | been freed. */ | |
12666 | /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat | |
12667 | in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats | |
12668 | pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint | |
12669 | commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here, | |
12670 | then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in | |
12671 | event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with | |
12672 | commands won't work. */ | |
12673 | ||
12674 | iterate_over_threads ([&] (struct thread_info *th) | |
12675 | { | |
12676 | bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt); | |
12677 | return false; | |
12678 | }); | |
12679 | ||
12680 | /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the | |
12681 | global location list. This will remove locations that used to | |
12682 | belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint | |
12683 | itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It | |
12684 | might be better design to have location completely | |
12685 | self-contained, but it's not the case now. | |
12686 | ||
12687 | Clear the location linked list first, otherwise, the intrusive_list | |
12688 | destructor accesses the locations after they are freed. */ | |
12689 | bpt->clear_locations (); | |
12690 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
12691 | ||
12692 | /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this | |
12693 | same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */ | |
12694 | bpt->type = bp_none; | |
12695 | delete bpt; | |
12696 | } | |
12697 | ||
12698 | /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once | |
12699 | for each of B and its related breakpoints. */ | |
12700 | ||
12701 | static void | |
12702 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b, | |
12703 | gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | |
12704 | { | |
12705 | struct breakpoint *related; | |
12706 | ||
12707 | related = b; | |
12708 | do | |
12709 | { | |
12710 | struct breakpoint *next; | |
12711 | ||
12712 | /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */ | |
12713 | next = related->related_breakpoint; | |
12714 | ||
12715 | if (next == related) | |
12716 | { | |
12717 | /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */ | |
12718 | function (related); | |
12719 | ||
12720 | /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to | |
12721 | B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break | |
12722 | out. */ | |
12723 | break; | |
12724 | } | |
12725 | else | |
12726 | function (related); | |
12727 | ||
12728 | related = next; | |
12729 | } | |
12730 | while (related != b); | |
12731 | } | |
12732 | ||
12733 | static void | |
12734 | delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
12735 | { | |
12736 | dont_repeat (); | |
12737 | ||
12738 | if (arg == 0) | |
12739 | { | |
12740 | int breaks_to_delete = 0; | |
12741 | ||
12742 | /* Delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints | |
12743 | if no argument. Do not delete internal breakpoints, these have to | |
12744 | be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number argument. */ | |
12745 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
12746 | if (user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
12747 | { | |
12748 | breaks_to_delete = 1; | |
12749 | break; | |
12750 | } | |
12751 | ||
12752 | /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */ | |
12753 | if (!from_tty | |
12754 | || (breaks_to_delete | |
12755 | && query (_("Delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, " | |
12756 | "and catchpoints? ")))) | |
12757 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
12758 | if (user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
12759 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
12760 | } | |
12761 | else | |
12762 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
12763 | (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) | |
12764 | { | |
12765 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); | |
12766 | }); | |
12767 | } | |
12768 | ||
12769 | /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If | |
12770 | PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are | |
12771 | considered. */ | |
12772 | ||
12773 | static bool | |
12774 | all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace) | |
12775 | { | |
12776 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
12777 | if ((pspace == NULL | |
12778 | || loc.pspace == pspace) | |
12779 | && !loc.shlib_disabled | |
12780 | && !loc.pspace->executing_startup) | |
12781 | return false; | |
12782 | return true; | |
12783 | } | |
12784 | ||
12785 | /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it. | |
12786 | Return true if multiple fns in list LOCS have the same name. | |
12787 | Null names are ignored. */ | |
12788 | ||
12789 | static bool | |
12790 | ambiguous_names_p (const bp_location_range &locs) | |
12791 | { | |
12792 | gdb::unordered_set<std::string_view> htab; | |
12793 | ||
12794 | for (const bp_location &l : locs) | |
12795 | { | |
12796 | const char *name = l.function_name.get (); | |
12797 | ||
12798 | /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */ | |
12799 | if (name == NULL) | |
12800 | continue; | |
12801 | ||
12802 | if (!htab.insert (name).second) | |
12803 | return true; | |
12804 | } | |
12805 | ||
12806 | return false; | |
12807 | } | |
12808 | ||
12809 | /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well, | |
12810 | and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at | |
12811 | the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we | |
12812 | checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is | |
12813 | undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static | |
12814 | tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints | |
12815 | that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have | |
12816 | been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set. | |
12817 | The heuristic is: | |
12818 | ||
12819 | 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at | |
12820 | the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker. | |
12821 | If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the | |
12822 | previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker | |
12823 | in the sources, and output a warning. | |
12824 | ||
12825 | 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker | |
12826 | at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there, | |
12827 | assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the | |
12828 | marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that | |
12829 | means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a | |
12830 | warning. | |
12831 | ||
12832 | 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it | |
12833 | may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean | |
12834 | the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code | |
12835 | that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask | |
12836 | the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew | |
12837 | it. If found, update line number and address in the matching | |
12838 | static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one | |
12839 | marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised | |
12840 | precisely because it confuses tools). */ | |
12841 | ||
12842 | static struct symtab_and_line | |
12843 | update_static_tracepoint (tracepoint *tp, struct symtab_and_line sal) | |
12844 | { | |
12845 | struct static_tracepoint_marker marker; | |
12846 | CORE_ADDR pc; | |
12847 | ||
12848 | pc = sal.pc; | |
12849 | if (sal.line) | |
12850 | find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc); | |
12851 | ||
12852 | if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker)) | |
12853 | { | |
12854 | if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id) | |
12855 | warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"), | |
12856 | tp->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (), | |
12857 | marker.str_id.c_str ()); | |
12858 | ||
12859 | tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id); | |
12860 | ||
12861 | return sal; | |
12862 | } | |
12863 | ||
12864 | /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up | |
12865 | by string ID. */ | |
12866 | if (!sal.explicit_pc | |
12867 | && sal.line != 0 | |
12868 | && sal.symtab != NULL | |
12869 | && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ()) | |
12870 | { | |
12871 | std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers | |
12872 | = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid | |
12873 | (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | |
12874 | ||
12875 | if (!markers.empty ()) | |
12876 | { | |
12877 | struct symbol *sym; | |
12878 | struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker; | |
12879 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
12880 | ||
12881 | tpmarker = &markers[0]; | |
12882 | ||
12883 | tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id); | |
12884 | ||
12885 | warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not " | |
12886 | "found at previous line number"), | |
12887 | tp->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()); | |
12888 | ||
12889 | symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0); | |
12890 | sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL); | |
12891 | uiout->text ("Now in "); | |
12892 | if (sym) | |
12893 | { | |
12894 | uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (), | |
12895 | function_name_style.style ()); | |
12896 | uiout->text (" at "); | |
12897 | } | |
12898 | uiout->field_string ("file", | |
12899 | symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab), | |
12900 | file_name_style.style ()); | |
12901 | uiout->text (":"); | |
12902 | ||
12903 | if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) | |
12904 | { | |
12905 | const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab); | |
12906 | ||
12907 | uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname); | |
12908 | } | |
12909 | ||
12910 | uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line, line_number_style.style ()); | |
12911 | uiout->text ("\n"); | |
12912 | ||
12913 | tp->first_loc ().line_number = sal2.line; | |
12914 | tp->first_loc ().symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL; | |
12915 | ||
12916 | std::unique_ptr<explicit_location_spec> els | |
12917 | (new explicit_location_spec | |
12918 | (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab))); | |
12919 | els->line_offset.offset = tp->first_loc ().line_number; | |
12920 | els->line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE; | |
12921 | ||
12922 | tp->locspec = std::move (els); | |
12923 | ||
12924 | /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if | |
12925 | so. */ | |
12926 | } | |
12927 | } | |
12928 | return sal; | |
12929 | } | |
12930 | ||
12931 | /* Returns true iff location lists A and B are sufficiently same that | |
12932 | we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */ | |
12933 | ||
12934 | static bool | |
12935 | locations_are_equal (const bp_location_list &a, const bp_location_range &b) | |
12936 | { | |
12937 | auto a_iter = a.begin (); | |
12938 | auto b_iter = b.begin (); | |
12939 | ||
12940 | for (; a_iter != a.end () && b_iter != b.end (); ++a_iter, ++b_iter) | |
12941 | { | |
12942 | if (a_iter->address != b_iter->address) | |
12943 | return false; | |
12944 | ||
12945 | if (a_iter->shlib_disabled != b_iter->shlib_disabled) | |
12946 | return false; | |
12947 | ||
12948 | if (a_iter->enabled != b_iter->enabled) | |
12949 | return false; | |
12950 | ||
12951 | if (a_iter->disabled_by_cond != b_iter->disabled_by_cond) | |
12952 | return false; | |
12953 | ||
12954 | /* When a breakpoint is set by address, it is not created as | |
12955 | pending; but then during an solib event or the like it may | |
12956 | acquire a symbol. So, check this here. */ | |
12957 | if (a_iter->symbol != b_iter->symbol | |
12958 | || a_iter->msymbol != b_iter->msymbol) | |
12959 | return false; | |
12960 | } | |
12961 | ||
12962 | return (a_iter == a.end ()) == (b_iter == b.end ()); | |
12963 | } | |
12964 | ||
12965 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
12966 | ||
12967 | bp_location_list | |
12968 | breakpoint::steal_locations (program_space *pspace) | |
12969 | { | |
12970 | if (pspace == NULL) | |
12971 | return std::move (m_locations); | |
12972 | ||
12973 | bp_location_list ret; | |
12974 | ||
12975 | for (auto it = m_locations.begin (); it != m_locations.end (); ) | |
12976 | { | |
12977 | if (it->pspace == pspace) | |
12978 | { | |
12979 | bp_location &loc = *it; | |
12980 | it = m_locations.erase (it); | |
12981 | ret.push_back (loc); | |
12982 | } | |
12983 | else | |
12984 | ++it; | |
12985 | } | |
12986 | ||
12987 | return ret; | |
12988 | } | |
12989 | ||
12990 | /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software | |
12991 | breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not | |
12992 | zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for | |
12993 | FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left | |
12994 | untouched. */ | |
12995 | ||
12996 | void | |
12997 | update_breakpoint_locations (code_breakpoint *b, | |
12998 | struct program_space *filter_pspace, | |
12999 | gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals, | |
13000 | gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end) | |
13001 | { | |
13002 | if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1)) | |
13003 | { | |
13004 | /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end | |
13005 | location. */ | |
13006 | b->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
13007 | gdb_printf (gdb_stderr, | |
13008 | _("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: " | |
13009 | "multiple locations found\n"), | |
13010 | b->number); | |
13011 | return; | |
13012 | } | |
13013 | ||
13014 | /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are | |
13015 | pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where | |
13016 | all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded. | |
13017 | We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is | |
13018 | loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the | |
13019 | individual locations. */ | |
13020 | if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ()) | |
13021 | return; | |
13022 | ||
13023 | bp_location_list existing_locations = b->steal_locations (filter_pspace); | |
13024 | ||
13025 | for (const auto &sal : sals) | |
13026 | { | |
13027 | struct bp_location *new_loc; | |
13028 | ||
13029 | switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace); | |
13030 | ||
13031 | new_loc = b->add_location (sal); | |
13032 | ||
13033 | /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the | |
13034 | old symtab. */ | |
13035 | if (b->cond_string != NULL) | |
13036 | { | |
13037 | const char *s; | |
13038 | ||
13039 | s = b->cond_string.get (); | |
13040 | try | |
13041 | { | |
13042 | new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc, | |
13043 | block_for_pc (sal.pc), | |
13044 | 0); | |
13045 | } | |
13046 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
13047 | { | |
13048 | new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true; | |
13049 | } | |
13050 | } | |
13051 | ||
13052 | if (!sals_end.empty ()) | |
13053 | { | |
13054 | CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]); | |
13055 | ||
13056 | new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1; | |
13057 | } | |
13058 | } | |
13059 | ||
13060 | /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing | |
13061 | breakpoints. | |
13062 | ||
13063 | If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name, | |
13064 | e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work. | |
13065 | Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things | |
13066 | may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer | |
13067 | often enough until a better solution is found. */ | |
13068 | bool have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->locations ()); | |
13069 | ||
13070 | for (const bp_location &e : existing_locations) | |
13071 | { | |
13072 | if (e.function_name == nullptr || e.enabled) | |
13073 | continue; | |
13074 | ||
13075 | if (have_ambiguous_names) | |
13076 | { | |
13077 | for (bp_location &l : b->locations ()) | |
13078 | { | |
13079 | /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at | |
13080 | this point, because with "set breakpoint | |
13081 | auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were | |
13082 | hardware can end up as software, or vice versa. | |
13083 | As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in | |
13084 | practice should give the correct answer often | |
13085 | enough. */ | |
13086 | if (breakpoint_locations_match (&e, &l, true)) | |
13087 | { | |
13088 | l.enabled = e.enabled; | |
13089 | break; | |
13090 | } | |
13091 | } | |
13092 | } | |
13093 | else | |
13094 | { | |
13095 | for (bp_location &l : b->locations ()) | |
13096 | if (l.function_name | |
13097 | && strcmp (e.function_name.get (), | |
13098 | l.function_name.get ()) == 0) | |
13099 | { | |
13100 | l.enabled = e.enabled; | |
13101 | break; | |
13102 | } | |
13103 | } | |
13104 | } | |
13105 | ||
13106 | if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->locations ())) | |
13107 | notify_breakpoint_modified (b); | |
13108 | } | |
13109 | ||
13110 | /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCSPEC. | |
13111 | On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */ | |
13112 | ||
13113 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> | |
13114 | code_breakpoint::location_spec_to_sals (location_spec *locspec, | |
13115 | struct program_space *search_pspace, | |
13116 | int *found) | |
13117 | { | |
13118 | struct gdb_exception exception; | |
13119 | ||
13120 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals; | |
13121 | ||
13122 | try | |
13123 | { | |
13124 | sals = decode_location_spec (locspec, search_pspace); | |
13125 | } | |
13126 | catch (gdb_exception_error &e) | |
13127 | { | |
13128 | int not_found_and_ok = false; | |
13129 | ||
13130 | /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will | |
13131 | fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has | |
13132 | already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need | |
13133 | extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled | |
13134 | state, then user already saw the message about that | |
13135 | breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more | |
13136 | errors. */ | |
13137 | if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR | |
13138 | && (condition_not_parsed | |
13139 | || (this->has_locations () | |
13140 | && search_pspace != NULL | |
13141 | && this->first_loc ().pspace != search_pspace) | |
13142 | || (this->has_locations () && this->first_loc ().shlib_disabled) | |
13143 | || (this->has_locations () | |
13144 | && this->first_loc ().pspace->executing_startup) | |
13145 | || enable_state == bp_disabled)) | |
13146 | not_found_and_ok = true; | |
13147 | ||
13148 | if (!not_found_and_ok) | |
13149 | { | |
13150 | /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint | |
13151 | 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable | |
13152 | the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to | |
13153 | have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this | |
13154 | happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know | |
13155 | which approach is better. */ | |
13156 | enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
13157 | throw; | |
13158 | } | |
13159 | ||
13160 | exception = std::move (e); | |
13161 | } | |
13162 | ||
13163 | if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR) | |
13164 | { | |
13165 | for (auto &sal : sals) | |
13166 | resolve_sal_pc (&sal); | |
13167 | ||
13168 | if (type == bp_static_tracepoint) | |
13169 | { | |
13170 | tracepoint *t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (this); | |
13171 | sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (t, sals[0]); | |
13172 | } | |
13173 | ||
13174 | *found = 1; | |
13175 | } | |
13176 | else | |
13177 | *found = 0; | |
13178 | ||
13179 | return sals; | |
13180 | } | |
13181 | ||
13182 | /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software | |
13183 | breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its | |
13184 | locations. */ | |
13185 | ||
13186 | void | |
13187 | code_breakpoint::re_set_default (struct program_space *filter_pspace) | |
13188 | { | |
13189 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end; | |
13190 | ||
13191 | /* If this breakpoint is thread- or inferior-specific, then find the | |
13192 | program space in which this breakpoint exists. Otherwise, for | |
13193 | breakpoints that are not thread- or inferior-specific, BP_PSPACE will | |
13194 | be nullptr. */ | |
13195 | program_space *bp_pspace | |
13196 | = find_program_space_for_breakpoint (this->thread, this->inferior); | |
13197 | ||
13198 | /* If this is not a thread or inferior specific breakpoint, or it is a | |
13199 | thread or inferior specific breakpoint but we are looking for new | |
13200 | locations in the program space that the specific thread or inferior is | |
13201 | running, then look for new locations for this breakpoint. */ | |
13202 | if (bp_pspace == nullptr || filter_pspace == bp_pspace) | |
13203 | { | |
13204 | int found; | |
13205 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals | |
13206 | = location_spec_to_sals (locspec.get (), filter_pspace, &found); | |
13207 | if (found) | |
13208 | expanded = std::move (sals); | |
13209 | ||
13210 | if (locspec_range_end != nullptr) | |
13211 | { | |
13212 | std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end | |
13213 | = location_spec_to_sals (locspec_range_end.get (), | |
13214 | filter_pspace, &found); | |
13215 | if (found) | |
13216 | expanded_end = std::move (sals_end); | |
13217 | } | |
13218 | } | |
13219 | ||
13220 | /* Update the locations for this breakpoint. For thread-specific | |
13221 | breakpoints this will remove any old locations that are for the wrong | |
13222 | program space -- this can happen if the user changes the thread of a | |
13223 | thread-specific breakpoint. */ | |
13224 | update_breakpoint_locations (this, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end); | |
13225 | } | |
13226 | ||
13227 | /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space. | |
13228 | Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */ | |
13229 | ||
13230 | void | |
13231 | breakpoint_re_set (void) | |
13232 | { | |
13233 | { | |
13234 | scoped_restore_current_language save_language; | |
13235 | scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix); | |
13236 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
13237 | ||
13238 | /* To ::re_set each breakpoint we set the current_language to the | |
13239 | language of the breakpoint before re-evaluating the breakpoint's | |
13240 | location. This change can unfortunately get undone by accident if | |
13241 | the language_mode is set to auto, and we either switch frames, or | |
13242 | more likely in this context, we select the current frame. | |
13243 | ||
13244 | We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to | |
13245 | language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints | |
13246 | have been reset. */ | |
13247 | scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode); | |
13248 | language_mode = language_mode_manual; | |
13249 | ||
13250 | /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all | |
13251 | breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting | |
13252 | breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which | |
13253 | hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */ | |
13254 | ||
13255 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
13256 | { | |
13257 | try | |
13258 | { | |
13259 | input_radix = b.input_radix; | |
13260 | set_language (b.language); | |
13261 | b.re_set (current_program_space); | |
13262 | } | |
13263 | catch (const gdb_exception &ex) | |
13264 | { | |
13265 | exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | |
13266 | "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", | |
13267 | b.number); | |
13268 | } | |
13269 | } | |
13270 | ||
13271 | jit_breakpoint_re_set (); | |
13272 | } | |
13273 | ||
13274 | create_overlay_event_breakpoint (); | |
13275 | create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (); | |
13276 | create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (); | |
13277 | create_exception_master_breakpoint (); | |
13278 | ||
13279 | /* Now we can insert. */ | |
13280 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
13281 | } | |
13282 | ||
13283 | /* Re-set locations for breakpoint B in FILTER_PSPACE. If FILTER_PSPACE is | |
13284 | nullptr then re-set locations for B in all program spaces. Locations | |
13285 | bound to program spaces other than FILTER_PSPACE are left untouched. */ | |
13286 | ||
13287 | static void | |
13288 | breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b, program_space *filter_pspace) | |
13289 | { | |
13290 | { | |
13291 | scoped_restore_current_language save_language; | |
13292 | scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix); | |
13293 | scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread; | |
13294 | ||
13295 | /* To ::re_set each breakpoint we set the current_language to the | |
13296 | language of the breakpoint before re-evaluating the breakpoint's | |
13297 | location. This change can unfortunately get undone by accident if | |
13298 | the language_mode is set to auto, and we either switch frames, or | |
13299 | more likely in this context, we select the current frame. | |
13300 | ||
13301 | We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to | |
13302 | language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints | |
13303 | have been reset. */ | |
13304 | scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode); | |
13305 | language_mode = language_mode_manual; | |
13306 | ||
13307 | /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all | |
13308 | breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting | |
13309 | breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which | |
13310 | hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */ | |
13311 | ||
13312 | try | |
13313 | { | |
13314 | input_radix = b->input_radix; | |
13315 | set_language (b->language); | |
13316 | b->re_set (filter_pspace); | |
13317 | } | |
13318 | catch (const gdb_exception &ex) | |
13319 | { | |
13320 | exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex, | |
13321 | "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ", | |
13322 | b->number); | |
13323 | } | |
13324 | } | |
13325 | ||
13326 | /* Now we can insert. */ | |
13327 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
13328 | } | |
13329 | \f | |
13330 | /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint: | |
13331 | ||
13332 | - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is. | |
13333 | - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */ | |
13334 | void | |
13335 | breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b) | |
13336 | { | |
13337 | if (b->thread != -1) | |
13338 | { | |
13339 | b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num; | |
13340 | ||
13341 | /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is | |
13342 | selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a | |
13343 | different program space from the original thread. Reset that | |
13344 | as well. */ | |
13345 | b->first_loc ().pspace = current_program_space; | |
13346 | } | |
13347 | } | |
13348 | ||
13349 | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | |
13350 | If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | |
13351 | which ends with a period (no newline). */ | |
13352 | ||
13353 | void | |
13354 | set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty) | |
13355 | { | |
13356 | if (count < 0) | |
13357 | count = 0; | |
13358 | ||
13359 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
13360 | if (b.number == bptnum) | |
13361 | { | |
13362 | if (is_tracepoint (&b)) | |
13363 | { | |
13364 | if (from_tty && count != 0) | |
13365 | gdb_printf (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."), | |
13366 | bptnum); | |
13367 | return; | |
13368 | } | |
13369 | ||
13370 | b.ignore_count = count; | |
13371 | if (from_tty) | |
13372 | { | |
13373 | if (count == 0) | |
13374 | gdb_printf (_("Will stop next time " | |
13375 | "breakpoint %d is reached."), | |
13376 | bptnum); | |
13377 | else if (count == 1) | |
13378 | gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."), | |
13379 | bptnum); | |
13380 | else | |
13381 | gdb_printf (_("Will ignore next %d " | |
13382 | "crossings of breakpoint %d."), | |
13383 | count, bptnum); | |
13384 | } | |
13385 | notify_breakpoint_modified (&b); | |
13386 | return; | |
13387 | } | |
13388 | ||
13389 | error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum); | |
13390 | } | |
13391 | ||
13392 | /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */ | |
13393 | ||
13394 | static void | |
13395 | ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13396 | { | |
13397 | const char *p = args; | |
13398 | int num; | |
13399 | ||
13400 | if (p == 0) | |
13401 | error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number")); | |
13402 | ||
13403 | num = get_number (&p); | |
13404 | if (num == 0) | |
13405 | error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args); | |
13406 | if (*p == 0) | |
13407 | error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing.")); | |
13408 | ||
13409 | set_ignore_count (num, | |
13410 | longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))), | |
13411 | from_tty); | |
13412 | if (from_tty) | |
13413 | gdb_printf ("\n"); | |
13414 | } | |
13415 | \f | |
13416 | ||
13417 | /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range | |
13418 | defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */ | |
13419 | ||
13420 | static void | |
13421 | map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, | |
13422 | gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | |
13423 | { | |
13424 | if (bp_num_range.first == 0) | |
13425 | { | |
13426 | warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"), | |
13427 | bp_num_range.first); | |
13428 | } | |
13429 | else | |
13430 | { | |
13431 | for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++) | |
13432 | { | |
13433 | bool match = false; | |
13434 | ||
13435 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
13436 | if (b.number == i) | |
13437 | { | |
13438 | match = true; | |
13439 | function (&b); | |
13440 | break; | |
13441 | } | |
13442 | if (!match) | |
13443 | gdb_printf (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i); | |
13444 | } | |
13445 | } | |
13446 | } | |
13447 | ||
13448 | /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in | |
13449 | ARGS. */ | |
13450 | ||
13451 | static void | |
13452 | map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args, | |
13453 | gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function) | |
13454 | { | |
13455 | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | |
13456 | error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers")); | |
13457 | ||
13458 | number_or_range_parser parser (args); | |
13459 | ||
13460 | while (!parser.finished ()) | |
13461 | { | |
13462 | int num = parser.get_number (); | |
13463 | map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function); | |
13464 | } | |
13465 | } | |
13466 | ||
13467 | /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the | |
13468 | BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */ | |
13469 | ||
13470 | static struct bp_location * | |
13471 | find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num) | |
13472 | { | |
13473 | breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num); | |
13474 | ||
13475 | if (!b || b->number != bp_num) | |
13476 | error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num); | |
13477 | ||
13478 | if (loc_num == 0) | |
13479 | error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); | |
13480 | ||
13481 | int n = 0; | |
13482 | for (bp_location &loc : b->locations ()) | |
13483 | if (++n == loc_num) | |
13484 | return &loc; | |
13485 | ||
13486 | error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num); | |
13487 | } | |
13488 | ||
13489 | /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */ | |
13490 | enum class extract_bp_kind | |
13491 | { | |
13492 | /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */ | |
13493 | bp, | |
13494 | ||
13495 | /* Extracting a location number. */ | |
13496 | loc, | |
13497 | }; | |
13498 | ||
13499 | /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND) | |
13500 | from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which | |
13501 | can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use | |
13502 | '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed | |
13503 | string. This always returns a positive integer. */ | |
13504 | ||
13505 | static int | |
13506 | extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start, | |
13507 | int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL) | |
13508 | { | |
13509 | const char *end = start; | |
13510 | int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer); | |
13511 | if (num < 0) | |
13512 | error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | |
13513 | ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'") | |
13514 | : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), | |
13515 | int (end - start), start); | |
13516 | if (num == 0) | |
13517 | error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | |
13518 | ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'") | |
13519 | : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"), | |
13520 | int (end - start), start); | |
13521 | ||
13522 | if (end_out != NULL) | |
13523 | *end_out = end; | |
13524 | return num; | |
13525 | } | |
13526 | ||
13527 | /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in | |
13528 | the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair | |
13529 | representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements | |
13530 | are always positive integers. */ | |
13531 | ||
13532 | static std::pair<int, int> | |
13533 | extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind, | |
13534 | const std::string &arg, | |
13535 | std::string::size_type arg_offset) | |
13536 | { | |
13537 | std::pair<int, int> range; | |
13538 | const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset]; | |
13539 | std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset); | |
13540 | if (dash != std::string::npos) | |
13541 | { | |
13542 | /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */ | |
13543 | if (arg.length () == dash + 1) | |
13544 | error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | |
13545 | ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'") | |
13546 | : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"), | |
13547 | bp_loc); | |
13548 | ||
13549 | const char *end; | |
13550 | const char *start_first = bp_loc; | |
13551 | const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1]; | |
13552 | range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-'); | |
13553 | range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end); | |
13554 | ||
13555 | if (range.first > range.second) | |
13556 | error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp | |
13557 | ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'") | |
13558 | : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"), | |
13559 | int (end - start_first), start_first); | |
13560 | } | |
13561 | else | |
13562 | { | |
13563 | /* bp_loc is a single value. */ | |
13564 | range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0'); | |
13565 | range.second = range.first; | |
13566 | } | |
13567 | return range; | |
13568 | } | |
13569 | ||
13570 | /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns | |
13571 | the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in | |
13572 | BP_LOC_RANGE. | |
13573 | ||
13574 | ARG may be in any of the following forms: | |
13575 | ||
13576 | x where 'x' is a breakpoint number. | |
13577 | x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range. | |
13578 | x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number. | |
13579 | x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a | |
13580 | location number range. | |
13581 | */ | |
13582 | ||
13583 | static void | |
13584 | extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg, | |
13585 | std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range, | |
13586 | std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range) | |
13587 | { | |
13588 | std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.'); | |
13589 | ||
13590 | if (dot != std::string::npos) | |
13591 | { | |
13592 | /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */ | |
13593 | ||
13594 | if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0) | |
13595 | error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ()); | |
13596 | ||
13597 | bp_num_range.first | |
13598 | = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.'); | |
13599 | bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first; | |
13600 | ||
13601 | bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc, | |
13602 | arg, dot + 1); | |
13603 | } | |
13604 | else | |
13605 | { | |
13606 | /* Handle x and x-y cases. */ | |
13607 | ||
13608 | bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0); | |
13609 | bp_loc_range.first = 0; | |
13610 | bp_loc_range.second = 0; | |
13611 | } | |
13612 | } | |
13613 | ||
13614 | /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE | |
13615 | specifies whether to enable or disable. */ | |
13616 | ||
13617 | static void | |
13618 | enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable) | |
13619 | { | |
13620 | struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num); | |
13621 | if (loc != NULL) | |
13622 | { | |
13623 | if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable) | |
13624 | error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, " | |
13625 | "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num); | |
13626 | ||
13627 | if (loc->enabled != enable) | |
13628 | { | |
13629 | loc->enabled = enable; | |
13630 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | |
13631 | } | |
13632 | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | |
13633 | && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | |
13634 | && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | |
13635 | target_disable_tracepoint (loc); | |
13636 | } | |
13637 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
13638 | ||
13639 | notify_breakpoint_modified (loc->owner); | |
13640 | } | |
13641 | ||
13642 | /* Calculates LOC_NUM for LOC by traversing the bp_location chain of LOC's | |
13643 | owner. 1-based indexing. -1 signals NOT FOUND. */ | |
13644 | ||
13645 | static int | |
13646 | find_loc_num_by_location (const bp_location *loc) | |
13647 | { | |
13648 | if (loc != nullptr && loc->owner != nullptr) | |
13649 | { | |
13650 | /* Locations use 1-based indexing. */ | |
13651 | int loc_num = 1; | |
13652 | for (bp_location &it : loc->owner->locations ()) | |
13653 | { | |
13654 | if (&it == loc) | |
13655 | return loc_num; | |
13656 | loc_num++; | |
13657 | } | |
13658 | } | |
13659 | return -1; | |
13660 | } | |
13661 | ||
13662 | /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location LOC. ENABLE | |
13663 | specifies whether to enable or disable. */ | |
13664 | ||
13665 | void | |
13666 | enable_disable_bp_location (bp_location *loc, bool enable) | |
13667 | { | |
13668 | if (loc == nullptr) | |
13669 | error (_("Breakpoint location is invalid.")); | |
13670 | ||
13671 | if (loc->owner == nullptr) | |
13672 | error (_("Breakpoint location does not have an owner breakpoint.")); | |
13673 | ||
13674 | if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable) | |
13675 | { | |
13676 | int loc_num = find_loc_num_by_location (loc); | |
13677 | if (loc_num == -1) | |
13678 | error (_("Breakpoint location LOC_NUM could not be found.")); | |
13679 | else | |
13680 | error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, " | |
13681 | "cannot enable."), loc->owner->number, loc_num); | |
13682 | } | |
13683 | ||
13684 | if (loc->enabled != enable) | |
13685 | { | |
13686 | loc->enabled = enable; | |
13687 | mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc); | |
13688 | } | |
13689 | ||
13690 | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | |
13691 | && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner | |
13692 | && is_tracepoint (loc->owner)) | |
13693 | target_disable_tracepoint (loc); | |
13694 | ||
13695 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
13696 | notify_breakpoint_modified (loc->owner); | |
13697 | } | |
13698 | ||
13699 | /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the | |
13700 | number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the | |
13701 | (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to | |
13702 | enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the | |
13703 | location. */ | |
13704 | ||
13705 | static void | |
13706 | enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num, | |
13707 | std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range, | |
13708 | bool enable) | |
13709 | { | |
13710 | for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++) | |
13711 | enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable); | |
13712 | } | |
13713 | ||
13714 | /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT. | |
13715 | If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect, | |
13716 | which ends with a period (no newline). */ | |
13717 | ||
13718 | void | |
13719 | disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
13720 | { | |
13721 | /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to | |
13722 | hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the | |
13723 | watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */ | |
13724 | if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope) | |
13725 | return; | |
13726 | ||
13727 | bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
13728 | ||
13729 | /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */ | |
13730 | mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | |
13731 | ||
13732 | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | |
13733 | && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | |
13734 | { | |
13735 | for (bp_location &location : bpt->locations ()) | |
13736 | target_disable_tracepoint (&location); | |
13737 | } | |
13738 | ||
13739 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT); | |
13740 | ||
13741 | notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | |
13742 | } | |
13743 | ||
13744 | /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s) | |
13745 | specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by | |
13746 | extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable | |
13747 | or disable the breakpoints/locations. */ | |
13748 | ||
13749 | static void | |
13750 | enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable) | |
13751 | { | |
13752 | if (args == 0) | |
13753 | { | |
13754 | for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | |
13755 | if (user_breakpoint_p (&bpt)) | |
13756 | { | |
13757 | if (enable) | |
13758 | enable_breakpoint (&bpt); | |
13759 | else | |
13760 | disable_breakpoint (&bpt); | |
13761 | } | |
13762 | } | |
13763 | else | |
13764 | { | |
13765 | std::string num = extract_arg (&args); | |
13766 | ||
13767 | while (!num.empty ()) | |
13768 | { | |
13769 | std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range; | |
13770 | ||
13771 | extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range); | |
13772 | ||
13773 | if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second | |
13774 | && (bp_loc_range.first == 0 | |
13775 | || (bp_loc_range.first == 1 | |
13776 | && bp_num_range.first == bp_num_range.second | |
13777 | && !has_multiple_locations (bp_num_range.first)))) | |
13778 | { | |
13779 | /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z' | |
13780 | or 'y.1' where y has only one code location. */ | |
13781 | map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range, | |
13782 | enable | |
13783 | ? enable_breakpoint | |
13784 | : disable_breakpoint); | |
13785 | } | |
13786 | else | |
13787 | { | |
13788 | /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or | |
13789 | 'x.y-z'. */ | |
13790 | enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range | |
13791 | (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable); | |
13792 | } | |
13793 | num = extract_arg (&args); | |
13794 | } | |
13795 | } | |
13796 | } | |
13797 | ||
13798 | /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations | |
13799 | (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in | |
13800 | stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in | |
13801 | extract_bp_number_and_location. */ | |
13802 | ||
13803 | static void | |
13804 | disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13805 | { | |
13806 | enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false); | |
13807 | } | |
13808 | ||
13809 | static void | |
13810 | enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition, | |
13811 | int count) | |
13812 | { | |
13813 | int target_resources_ok; | |
13814 | ||
13815 | if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint) | |
13816 | { | |
13817 | int i; | |
13818 | i = hw_breakpoint_used_count (); | |
13819 | target_resources_ok = | |
13820 | target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint, | |
13821 | i + 1, 0); | |
13822 | if (target_resources_ok == 0) | |
13823 | error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target.")); | |
13824 | else if (target_resources_ok < 0) | |
13825 | error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit.")); | |
13826 | } | |
13827 | ||
13828 | if (is_watchpoint (bpt)) | |
13829 | { | |
13830 | /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */ | |
13831 | enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled; | |
13832 | ||
13833 | try | |
13834 | { | |
13835 | watchpoint *w = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint *> (bpt); | |
13836 | ||
13837 | orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state; | |
13838 | bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
13839 | update_watchpoint (w, true /* reparse */); | |
13840 | } | |
13841 | catch (const gdb_exception_error &e) | |
13842 | { | |
13843 | bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state; | |
13844 | exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "), | |
13845 | bpt->number); | |
13846 | return; | |
13847 | } | |
13848 | } | |
13849 | ||
13850 | bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled; | |
13851 | ||
13852 | /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */ | |
13853 | mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | |
13854 | ||
13855 | if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint () | |
13856 | && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt)) | |
13857 | { | |
13858 | for (bp_location &location : bpt->locations ()) | |
13859 | target_enable_tracepoint (&location); | |
13860 | } | |
13861 | ||
13862 | bpt->disposition = disposition; | |
13863 | bpt->enable_count = count; | |
13864 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT); | |
13865 | ||
13866 | notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt); | |
13867 | } | |
13868 | ||
13869 | ||
13870 | void | |
13871 | enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt) | |
13872 | { | |
13873 | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0); | |
13874 | } | |
13875 | ||
13876 | /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or | |
13877 | all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to | |
13878 | be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the | |
13879 | forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */ | |
13880 | ||
13881 | static void | |
13882 | enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13883 | { | |
13884 | enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true); | |
13885 | } | |
13886 | ||
13887 | static void | |
13888 | enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13889 | { | |
13890 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
13891 | (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | |
13892 | { | |
13893 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints | |
13894 | (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | |
13895 | { | |
13896 | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1); | |
13897 | }); | |
13898 | }); | |
13899 | } | |
13900 | ||
13901 | static void | |
13902 | enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13903 | { | |
13904 | int count; | |
13905 | ||
13906 | if (args == NULL) | |
13907 | error_no_arg (_("hit count")); | |
13908 | ||
13909 | count = get_number (&args); | |
13910 | ||
13911 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
13912 | (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | |
13913 | { | |
13914 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints | |
13915 | (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | |
13916 | { | |
13917 | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count); | |
13918 | }); | |
13919 | }); | |
13920 | } | |
13921 | ||
13922 | static void | |
13923 | enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
13924 | { | |
13925 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
13926 | (args, [&] (breakpoint *b) | |
13927 | { | |
13928 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints | |
13929 | (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt) | |
13930 | { | |
13931 | enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1); | |
13932 | }); | |
13933 | }); | |
13934 | } | |
13935 | \f | |
13936 | /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if | |
13937 | the memory which that value represents has been written to by | |
13938 | GDB itself. */ | |
13939 | ||
13940 | static void | |
13941 | invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior, | |
13942 | CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len, | |
13943 | const bfd_byte *data) | |
13944 | { | |
13945 | for (breakpoint &bp : all_breakpoints ()) | |
13946 | if (bp.enable_state == bp_enabled | |
13947 | && bp.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint) | |
13948 | { | |
13949 | watchpoint &wp = gdb::checked_static_cast<watchpoint &> (bp); | |
13950 | ||
13951 | if (wp.val_valid && wp.val != nullptr) | |
13952 | { | |
13953 | for (bp_location &loc : bp.locations ()) | |
13954 | if (loc.loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint | |
13955 | && loc.address + loc.length > addr | |
13956 | && addr + len > loc.address) | |
13957 | { | |
13958 | wp.val = NULL; | |
13959 | wp.val_valid = false; | |
13960 | } | |
13961 | } | |
13962 | } | |
13963 | } | |
13964 | ||
13965 | /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */ | |
13966 | ||
13967 | void | |
13968 | insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, | |
13969 | const address_space *aspace, | |
13970 | CORE_ADDR next_pc) | |
13971 | { | |
13972 | struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread (); | |
13973 | struct symtab_and_line sal; | |
13974 | CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc; | |
13975 | ||
13976 | if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL) | |
13977 | { | |
13978 | std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b | |
13979 | (new momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, bp_single_step, | |
13980 | current_program_space, | |
13981 | null_frame_id, | |
13982 | tp->global_num)); | |
13983 | ||
13984 | tp->control.single_step_breakpoints | |
13985 | = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b)); | |
13986 | } | |
13987 | ||
13988 | sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0); | |
13989 | sal.pc = pc; | |
13990 | sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc); | |
13991 | sal.explicit_pc = 1; | |
13992 | ||
13993 | auto *ss_bp | |
13994 | = (gdb::checked_static_cast<momentary_breakpoint *> | |
13995 | (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints)); | |
13996 | ss_bp->add_location (sal); | |
13997 | ||
13998 | update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT); | |
13999 | } | |
14000 | ||
14001 | /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */ | |
14002 | ||
14003 | int | |
14004 | insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch) | |
14005 | { | |
14006 | regcache *regcache = get_thread_regcache (inferior_thread ()); | |
14007 | std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs; | |
14008 | ||
14009 | next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache); | |
14010 | ||
14011 | if (!next_pcs.empty ()) | |
14012 | { | |
14013 | frame_info_ptr frame = get_current_frame (); | |
14014 | const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame); | |
14015 | ||
14016 | for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs) | |
14017 | insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc); | |
14018 | ||
14019 | return 1; | |
14020 | } | |
14021 | else | |
14022 | return 0; | |
14023 | } | |
14024 | ||
14025 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
14026 | ||
14027 | int | |
14028 | breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp, | |
14029 | const address_space *aspace, | |
14030 | CORE_ADDR pc) | |
14031 | { | |
14032 | for (bp_location &loc : bp->locations ()) | |
14033 | if (loc.inserted | |
14034 | && breakpoint_location_address_match (&loc, aspace, pc)) | |
14035 | return 1; | |
14036 | ||
14037 | return 0; | |
14038 | } | |
14039 | ||
14040 | /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at | |
14041 | PC. */ | |
14042 | ||
14043 | int | |
14044 | single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, | |
14045 | CORE_ADDR pc) | |
14046 | { | |
14047 | for (breakpoint &bpt : all_breakpoints ()) | |
14048 | { | |
14049 | if (bpt.type == bp_single_step | |
14050 | && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (&bpt, aspace, pc)) | |
14051 | return 1; | |
14052 | } | |
14053 | return 0; | |
14054 | } | |
14055 | ||
14056 | /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */ | |
14057 | ||
14058 | /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */ | |
14059 | static void | |
14060 | set_tracepoint_count (int num) | |
14061 | { | |
14062 | tracepoint_count = num; | |
14063 | set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num); | |
14064 | } | |
14065 | ||
14066 | static void | |
14067 | trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
14068 | { | |
14069 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, | |
14070 | current_language); | |
14071 | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_location_spec | |
14072 | (locspec.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */); | |
14073 | ||
14074 | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
14075 | locspec.get (), | |
14076 | NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | |
14077 | 0 /* tempflag */, | |
14078 | bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | |
14079 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
14080 | pending_break_support, | |
14081 | ops, | |
14082 | from_tty, | |
14083 | 1 /* enabled */, | |
14084 | 0 /* internal */, 0); | |
14085 | } | |
14086 | ||
14087 | static void | |
14088 | ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
14089 | { | |
14090 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, | |
14091 | current_language); | |
14092 | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
14093 | locspec.get (), | |
14094 | NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | |
14095 | 0 /* tempflag */, | |
14096 | bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */, | |
14097 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
14098 | pending_break_support, | |
14099 | &code_breakpoint_ops, | |
14100 | from_tty, | |
14101 | 1 /* enabled */, | |
14102 | 0 /* internal */, 0); | |
14103 | } | |
14104 | ||
14105 | /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */ | |
14106 | ||
14107 | static void | |
14108 | strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
14109 | { | |
14110 | const struct breakpoint_ops *ops; | |
14111 | location_spec_up locspec; | |
14112 | enum bptype type; | |
14113 | ||
14114 | /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'), | |
14115 | or with a normal static tracepoint. */ | |
14116 | if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2])) | |
14117 | { | |
14118 | ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops; | |
14119 | locspec = new_linespec_location_spec (&arg, | |
14120 | symbol_name_match_type::FULL); | |
14121 | type = bp_static_marker_tracepoint; | |
14122 | } | |
14123 | else | |
14124 | { | |
14125 | ops = &code_breakpoint_ops; | |
14126 | locspec = string_to_location_spec (&arg, current_language); | |
14127 | type = bp_static_tracepoint; | |
14128 | } | |
14129 | ||
14130 | create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
14131 | locspec.get (), | |
14132 | NULL, -1, -1, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */, | |
14133 | 0 /* tempflag */, | |
14134 | type /* type_wanted */, | |
14135 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
14136 | pending_break_support, | |
14137 | ops, | |
14138 | from_tty, | |
14139 | 1 /* enabled */, | |
14140 | 0 /* internal */, 0); | |
14141 | } | |
14142 | ||
14143 | /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked | |
14144 | list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */ | |
14145 | ||
14146 | static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp; | |
14147 | static int next_cmd; | |
14148 | ||
14149 | static const char * | |
14150 | read_uploaded_action (std::string &buffer) | |
14151 | { | |
14152 | char *rslt = nullptr; | |
14153 | ||
14154 | if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ()) | |
14155 | { | |
14156 | rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get (); | |
14157 | next_cmd++; | |
14158 | } | |
14159 | ||
14160 | return rslt; | |
14161 | } | |
14162 | ||
14163 | /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which | |
14164 | can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an | |
14165 | equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since | |
14166 | the target does not necessarily have all the information used when | |
14167 | the tracepoint was originally defined. */ | |
14168 | ||
14169 | struct tracepoint * | |
14170 | create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp) | |
14171 | { | |
14172 | const char *addr_str; | |
14173 | char small_buf[100]; | |
14174 | struct tracepoint *tp; | |
14175 | ||
14176 | if (utp->at_string) | |
14177 | addr_str = utp->at_string.get (); | |
14178 | else | |
14179 | { | |
14180 | /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw | |
14181 | address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address | |
14182 | means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the | |
14183 | user. */ | |
14184 | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no " | |
14185 | "source location, using raw address"), | |
14186 | utp->number); | |
14187 | xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr)); | |
14188 | addr_str = small_buf; | |
14189 | } | |
14190 | ||
14191 | /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */ | |
14192 | if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string) | |
14193 | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition " | |
14194 | "has no source form, ignoring it"), | |
14195 | utp->number); | |
14196 | ||
14197 | location_spec_up locspec = string_to_location_spec (&addr_str, | |
14198 | current_language); | |
14199 | ||
14200 | ||
14201 | gdb_assert (addr_str != nullptr); | |
14202 | if (*addr_str != '\0') | |
14203 | error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), addr_str); | |
14204 | ||
14205 | if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), | |
14206 | locspec.get (), | |
14207 | utp->cond_string.get (), -1, -1, addr_str, | |
14208 | false /* force_condition */, | |
14209 | 0 /* parse cond/thread */, | |
14210 | 0 /* tempflag */, | |
14211 | utp->type /* type_wanted */, | |
14212 | 0 /* Ignore count */, | |
14213 | pending_break_support, | |
14214 | &code_breakpoint_ops, | |
14215 | 0 /* from_tty */, | |
14216 | utp->enabled /* enabled */, | |
14217 | 0 /* internal */, | |
14218 | CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED)) | |
14219 | return NULL; | |
14220 | ||
14221 | /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */ | |
14222 | tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count); | |
14223 | gdb_assert (tp != NULL); | |
14224 | ||
14225 | if (utp->pass > 0) | |
14226 | { | |
14227 | xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass, | |
14228 | tp->number); | |
14229 | ||
14230 | trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0); | |
14231 | } | |
14232 | ||
14233 | /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a | |
14234 | special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line | |
14235 | reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting | |
14236 | function. */ | |
14237 | if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ()) | |
14238 | { | |
14239 | counted_command_line cmd_list; | |
14240 | ||
14241 | this_utp = utp; | |
14242 | next_cmd = 0; | |
14243 | ||
14244 | cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL); | |
14245 | ||
14246 | breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list)); | |
14247 | } | |
14248 | else if (!utp->actions.empty () | |
14249 | || !utp->step_actions.empty ()) | |
14250 | warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions " | |
14251 | "have no source form, ignoring them"), | |
14252 | utp->number); | |
14253 | ||
14254 | /* Copy any status information that might be available. */ | |
14255 | tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count; | |
14256 | tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage; | |
14257 | ||
14258 | return tp; | |
14259 | } | |
14260 | ||
14261 | /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if | |
14262 | omitted. */ | |
14263 | ||
14264 | static void | |
14265 | info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14266 | { | |
14267 | struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout; | |
14268 | int num_printed; | |
14269 | ||
14270 | num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint); | |
14271 | ||
14272 | if (num_printed == 0) | |
14273 | { | |
14274 | if (args == NULL || *args == '\0') | |
14275 | uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n"); | |
14276 | else | |
14277 | uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args); | |
14278 | } | |
14279 | ||
14280 | default_collect_info (); | |
14281 | } | |
14282 | ||
14283 | /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints. | |
14284 | Not supported by all targets. */ | |
14285 | static void | |
14286 | enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14287 | { | |
14288 | enable_command (args, from_tty); | |
14289 | } | |
14290 | ||
14291 | /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints. | |
14292 | Not supported by all targets. */ | |
14293 | static void | |
14294 | disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14295 | { | |
14296 | disable_command (args, from_tty); | |
14297 | } | |
14298 | ||
14299 | /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */ | |
14300 | static void | |
14301 | delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty) | |
14302 | { | |
14303 | dont_repeat (); | |
14304 | ||
14305 | if (arg == 0) | |
14306 | { | |
14307 | int breaks_to_delete = 0; | |
14308 | ||
14309 | /* Delete all tracepoints if no argument. | |
14310 | Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these | |
14311 | have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number | |
14312 | argument. */ | |
14313 | for (breakpoint &tp : all_tracepoints ()) | |
14314 | if (is_tracepoint (&tp) && user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | |
14315 | { | |
14316 | breaks_to_delete = 1; | |
14317 | break; | |
14318 | } | |
14319 | ||
14320 | /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */ | |
14321 | if (!from_tty | |
14322 | || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? ")))) | |
14323 | { | |
14324 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints_safe ()) | |
14325 | if (is_tracepoint (&b) && user_breakpoint_p (&b)) | |
14326 | delete_breakpoint (&b); | |
14327 | } | |
14328 | } | |
14329 | else | |
14330 | map_breakpoint_numbers | |
14331 | (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br) | |
14332 | { | |
14333 | iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint); | |
14334 | }); | |
14335 | } | |
14336 | ||
14337 | /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */ | |
14338 | ||
14339 | static void | |
14340 | trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty) | |
14341 | { | |
14342 | tp->pass_count = count; | |
14343 | notify_breakpoint_modified (tp); | |
14344 | if (from_tty) | |
14345 | gdb_printf (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"), | |
14346 | tp->number, count); | |
14347 | } | |
14348 | ||
14349 | /* Set passcount for tracepoint. | |
14350 | ||
14351 | First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number. | |
14352 | If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined. | |
14353 | Also accepts special argument "all". */ | |
14354 | ||
14355 | static void | |
14356 | trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14357 | { | |
14358 | ULONGEST count; | |
14359 | ||
14360 | if (args == 0 || *args == 0) | |
14361 | error (_("passcount command requires an " | |
14362 | "argument (count + optional TP num)")); | |
14363 | ||
14364 | count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */ | |
14365 | ||
14366 | args = skip_spaces (args); | |
14367 | if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0) | |
14368 | { | |
14369 | args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */ | |
14370 | if (*args) | |
14371 | error (_("Junk at end of arguments.")); | |
14372 | ||
14373 | for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | |
14374 | { | |
14375 | tracepoint &t1 = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | |
14376 | trace_pass_set_count (&t1, count, from_tty); | |
14377 | } | |
14378 | } | |
14379 | else if (*args == '\0') | |
14380 | { | |
14381 | tracepoint *t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL); | |
14382 | if (t1) | |
14383 | trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | |
14384 | } | |
14385 | else | |
14386 | { | |
14387 | number_or_range_parser parser (args); | |
14388 | while (!parser.finished ()) | |
14389 | { | |
14390 | tracepoint *t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser); | |
14391 | if (t1) | |
14392 | trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty); | |
14393 | } | |
14394 | } | |
14395 | } | |
14396 | ||
14397 | struct tracepoint * | |
14398 | get_tracepoint (int num) | |
14399 | { | |
14400 | for (breakpoint &t : all_tracepoints ()) | |
14401 | if (t.number == num) | |
14402 | return gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (&t); | |
14403 | ||
14404 | return NULL; | |
14405 | } | |
14406 | ||
14407 | /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be | |
14408 | different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and | |
14409 | reconnecting). */ | |
14410 | ||
14411 | struct tracepoint * | |
14412 | get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num) | |
14413 | { | |
14414 | for (breakpoint &b : all_tracepoints ()) | |
14415 | { | |
14416 | tracepoint &t = gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint &> (b); | |
14417 | ||
14418 | if (t.number_on_target == num) | |
14419 | return &t; | |
14420 | } | |
14421 | ||
14422 | return NULL; | |
14423 | } | |
14424 | ||
14425 | /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list. | |
14426 | If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG. | |
14427 | If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint | |
14428 | (tracepoint_count) is returned. */ | |
14429 | ||
14430 | struct tracepoint * | |
14431 | get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg, | |
14432 | number_or_range_parser *parser) | |
14433 | { | |
14434 | int tpnum; | |
14435 | const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg; | |
14436 | ||
14437 | if (parser != NULL) | |
14438 | { | |
14439 | gdb_assert (!parser->finished ()); | |
14440 | tpnum = parser->get_number (); | |
14441 | } | |
14442 | else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg) | |
14443 | tpnum = tracepoint_count; | |
14444 | else | |
14445 | tpnum = get_number (arg); | |
14446 | ||
14447 | if (tpnum <= 0) | |
14448 | { | |
14449 | if (instring && *instring) | |
14450 | gdb_printf (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"), | |
14451 | instring); | |
14452 | else | |
14453 | gdb_printf (_("No previous tracepoint\n")); | |
14454 | return NULL; | |
14455 | } | |
14456 | ||
14457 | for (breakpoint &t : all_tracepoints ()) | |
14458 | if (t.number == tpnum) | |
14459 | return gdb::checked_static_cast<tracepoint *> (&t); | |
14460 | ||
14461 | gdb_printf ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum); | |
14462 | return NULL; | |
14463 | } | |
14464 | ||
14465 | void | |
14466 | breakpoint::print_recreate_thread (struct ui_file *fp) const | |
14467 | { | |
14468 | if (thread != -1) | |
14469 | { | |
14470 | struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (thread); | |
14471 | gdb_printf (fp, " thread %s", print_full_thread_id (thr)); | |
14472 | } | |
14473 | ||
14474 | if (task != -1) | |
14475 | gdb_printf (fp, " task %d", task); | |
14476 | ||
14477 | gdb_printf (fp, "\n"); | |
14478 | } | |
14479 | ||
14480 | /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to | |
14481 | a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it | |
14482 | on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns | |
14483 | true. */ | |
14484 | ||
14485 | static void | |
14486 | save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty, | |
14487 | bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *)) | |
14488 | { | |
14489 | bool any = false; | |
14490 | int extra_trace_bits = 0; | |
14491 | ||
14492 | if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0) | |
14493 | error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)")); | |
14494 | ||
14495 | /* See if we have anything to save. */ | |
14496 | for (breakpoint &tp : all_breakpoints ()) | |
14497 | { | |
14498 | /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */ | |
14499 | if (!user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | |
14500 | continue; | |
14501 | ||
14502 | /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */ | |
14503 | if (filter && !filter (&tp)) | |
14504 | continue; | |
14505 | ||
14506 | any = true; | |
14507 | ||
14508 | if (is_tracepoint (&tp)) | |
14509 | { | |
14510 | extra_trace_bits = 1; | |
14511 | ||
14512 | /* We can stop searching. */ | |
14513 | break; | |
14514 | } | |
14515 | } | |
14516 | ||
14517 | if (!any) | |
14518 | { | |
14519 | warning (_("Nothing to save.")); | |
14520 | return; | |
14521 | } | |
14522 | ||
14523 | gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename)); | |
14524 | ||
14525 | stdio_file fp; | |
14526 | ||
14527 | if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w")) | |
14528 | error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"), | |
14529 | expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno)); | |
14530 | ||
14531 | if (extra_trace_bits) | |
14532 | save_trace_state_variables (&fp); | |
14533 | ||
14534 | for (breakpoint &tp : all_breakpoints ()) | |
14535 | { | |
14536 | /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */ | |
14537 | if (!user_breakpoint_p (&tp)) | |
14538 | continue; | |
14539 | ||
14540 | /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */ | |
14541 | if (filter && !filter (&tp)) | |
14542 | continue; | |
14543 | ||
14544 | tp.print_recreate (&fp); | |
14545 | ||
14546 | /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't | |
14547 | assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum | |
14548 | instead. */ | |
14549 | ||
14550 | if (tp.cond_string) | |
14551 | fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp.cond_string.get ()); | |
14552 | ||
14553 | if (tp.ignore_count) | |
14554 | fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp.ignore_count); | |
14555 | ||
14556 | if (tp.type != bp_dprintf && tp.commands) | |
14557 | { | |
14558 | fp.puts (" commands\n"); | |
14559 | ||
14560 | ui_out_redirect_pop redir (current_uiout, &fp); | |
14561 | print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp.commands.get (), 2); | |
14562 | ||
14563 | fp.puts (" end\n"); | |
14564 | } | |
14565 | ||
14566 | if (tp.enable_state == bp_disabled) | |
14567 | fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n"); | |
14568 | ||
14569 | /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations | |
14570 | should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are | |
14571 | special, and not user visible. */ | |
14572 | if (!is_watchpoint (&tp) && tp.has_multiple_locations ()) | |
14573 | { | |
14574 | int n = 1; | |
14575 | ||
14576 | for (bp_location &loc : tp.locations ()) | |
14577 | { | |
14578 | if (!loc.enabled) | |
14579 | fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n); | |
14580 | ||
14581 | n++; | |
14582 | } | |
14583 | } | |
14584 | } | |
14585 | ||
14586 | if (extra_trace_bits && !default_collect.empty ()) | |
14587 | fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect.c_str ()); | |
14588 | ||
14589 | if (from_tty) | |
14590 | gdb_printf (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ()); | |
14591 | } | |
14592 | ||
14593 | /* The `save breakpoints' command. */ | |
14594 | ||
14595 | static void | |
14596 | save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14597 | { | |
14598 | save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL); | |
14599 | } | |
14600 | ||
14601 | /* The `save tracepoints' command. */ | |
14602 | ||
14603 | static void | |
14604 | save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty) | |
14605 | { | |
14606 | save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint); | |
14607 | } | |
14608 | ||
14609 | \f | |
14610 | /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying | |
14611 | locations used by several commands. */ | |
14612 | ||
14613 | #define LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING \ | |
14614 | "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\ | |
14615 | source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\ | |
14616 | Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | |
14617 | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\ | |
14618 | \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\ | |
14619 | \n\ | |
14620 | Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\ | |
14621 | program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\ | |
14622 | \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\ | |
14623 | \n\ | |
14624 | Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\ | |
14625 | syntax to specify location parameters.\n\ | |
14626 | Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\ | |
14627 | function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\ | |
14628 | -function fact -label the_top\".\n\ | |
14629 | \n\ | |
14630 | By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\ | |
14631 | functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\ | |
14632 | classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\ | |
14633 | \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\ | |
14634 | \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\ | |
14635 | specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead." | |
14636 | ||
14637 | /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak | |
14638 | commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication. | |
14639 | COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the | |
14640 | command. */ | |
14641 | ||
14642 | #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \ | |
14643 | command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\ | |
14644 | \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\ | |
14645 | PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\ | |
14646 | probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\ | |
14647 | guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or\n\ | |
14648 | `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\ | |
14649 | LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\ | |
14650 | below.\n\ | |
14651 | \n\ | |
14652 | With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\ | |
14653 | stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\ | |
14654 | \n\ | |
14655 | THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\ | |
14656 | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | |
14657 | \n\ | |
14658 | With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\ | |
14659 | it is invalid for all current locations.\n\ | |
14660 | \n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | |
14661 | Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | |
14662 | conditions are different.\n\ | |
14663 | \n\ | |
14664 | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints." | |
14665 | ||
14666 | /* List of subcommands for "catch". */ | |
14667 | static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist; | |
14668 | ||
14669 | /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */ | |
14670 | static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist; | |
14671 | ||
14672 | void | |
14673 | add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring, | |
14674 | cmd_func_ftype *func, | |
14675 | completer_ftype *completer, | |
14676 | void *user_data_catch, | |
14677 | void *user_data_tcatch) | |
14678 | { | |
14679 | struct cmd_list_element *command; | |
14680 | ||
14681 | command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, | |
14682 | &catch_cmdlist); | |
14683 | command->func = func; | |
14684 | command->set_context (user_data_catch); | |
14685 | set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | |
14686 | ||
14687 | command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring, | |
14688 | &tcatch_cmdlist); | |
14689 | command->func = func; | |
14690 | command->set_context (user_data_tcatch); | |
14691 | set_cmd_completer (command, completer); | |
14692 | } | |
14693 | ||
14694 | /* False if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where | |
14695 | functions have been inlined, true otherwise. */ | |
14696 | ||
14697 | static bool | |
14698 | is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b) | |
14699 | { | |
14700 | /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a | |
14701 | non-inline function. */ | |
14702 | return (b->type == bp_shlib_event); | |
14703 | } | |
14704 | ||
14705 | /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions | |
14706 | have been inlined. */ | |
14707 | ||
14708 | int | |
14709 | pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc, | |
14710 | const target_waitstatus &ws) | |
14711 | { | |
14712 | for (breakpoint &b : all_breakpoints ()) | |
14713 | { | |
14714 | if (!is_non_inline_function (&b)) | |
14715 | continue; | |
14716 | ||
14717 | for (bp_location &bl : b.locations ()) | |
14718 | { | |
14719 | if (!bl.shlib_disabled | |
14720 | && bpstat_check_location (&bl, aspace, pc, ws)) | |
14721 | return 1; | |
14722 | } | |
14723 | } | |
14724 | ||
14725 | return 0; | |
14726 | } | |
14727 | ||
14728 | /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */ | |
14729 | ||
14730 | void | |
14731 | breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile) | |
14732 | { | |
14733 | for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ()) | |
14734 | { | |
14735 | if (loc->symtab != nullptr | |
14736 | && loc->symtab->compunit ()->objfile () == objfile) | |
14737 | { | |
14738 | loc->symtab = nullptr; | |
14739 | loc->symbol = nullptr; | |
14740 | loc->msymbol = nullptr; | |
14741 | } | |
14742 | ||
14743 | if (loc->section != nullptr | |
14744 | && loc->section->objfile == objfile) | |
14745 | { | |
14746 | /* If symtab was set then it should have already been cleared. | |
14747 | But if bp_location::msymbol was set then the symbol and symtab | |
14748 | might already have been nullptr. */ | |
14749 | gdb_assert (loc->symtab == nullptr); | |
14750 | loc->section = nullptr; | |
14751 | loc->symbol = nullptr; | |
14752 | loc->msymbol = nullptr; | |
14753 | } | |
14754 | ||
14755 | if (loc->probe.objfile == objfile) | |
14756 | loc->probe = bound_probe (); | |
14757 | } | |
14758 | } | |
14759 | ||
14760 | /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */ | |
14761 | ||
14762 | static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL; | |
14763 | ||
14764 | /* See breakpoint.h. */ | |
14765 | ||
14766 | cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr; | |
14767 | ||
14768 | INIT_GDB_FILE (breakpoint) | |
14769 | { | |
14770 | struct cmd_list_element *c; | |
14771 | ||
14772 | gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, | |
14773 | "breakpoint"); | |
14774 | gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile, | |
14775 | "breakpoint"); | |
14776 | gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change, | |
14777 | "breakpoint"); | |
14778 | ||
14779 | /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful | |
14780 | before a breakpoint is set. */ | |
14781 | breakpoint_count = 0; | |
14782 | ||
14783 | tracepoint_count = 0; | |
14784 | ||
14785 | add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\ | |
14786 | Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\ | |
14787 | Usage is `ignore N COUNT'.")); | |
14788 | ||
14789 | commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, | |
14790 | commands_command, _("\ | |
14791 | Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\ | |
14792 | Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\ | |
14793 | A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\ | |
14794 | (e.g. `5-7').\n\ | |
14795 | With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\ | |
14796 | The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\ | |
14797 | Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\ | |
14798 | Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\ | |
14799 | then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print.")); | |
14800 | ||
14801 | const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr); | |
14802 | static std::string condition_command_help | |
14803 | = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | |
14804 | Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\ | |
14805 | Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\ | |
14806 | is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\ | |
14807 | \n\ | |
14808 | Options:\n\ | |
14809 | %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts); | |
14810 | ||
14811 | c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, | |
14812 | condition_command_help.c_str ()); | |
14813 | set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer); | |
14814 | ||
14815 | c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\ | |
14816 | Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\ | |
14817 | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | |
14818 | so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\ | |
14819 | by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\ | |
14820 | \n" | |
14821 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak"))); | |
14822 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
14823 | ||
14824 | c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\ | |
14825 | Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | |
14826 | Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\ | |
14827 | some target hardware may not have this support.\n\ | |
14828 | \n" | |
14829 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak"))); | |
14830 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
14831 | ||
14832 | c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\ | |
14833 | Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\ | |
14834 | Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\ | |
14835 | so it will be deleted when hit.\n\ | |
14836 | \n" | |
14837 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak"))); | |
14838 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
14839 | ||
14840 | cmd_list_element *enable_cmd | |
14841 | = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | |
14842 | Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | |
14843 | Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14844 | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | |
14845 | With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\ | |
14846 | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | |
14847 | With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."), | |
14848 | &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist); | |
14849 | ||
14850 | add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14851 | ||
14852 | add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\ | |
14853 | Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | |
14854 | Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14855 | Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\ | |
14856 | This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\ | |
14857 | May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."), | |
14858 | &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist); | |
14859 | ||
14860 | add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | |
14861 | Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ | |
14862 | Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14863 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | |
14864 | &enablebreaklist); | |
14865 | ||
14866 | add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | |
14867 | Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ | |
14868 | Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14869 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | |
14870 | &enablebreaklist); | |
14871 | ||
14872 | add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | |
14873 | Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ | |
14874 | Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14875 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | |
14876 | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | |
14877 | &enablebreaklist); | |
14878 | ||
14879 | add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\ | |
14880 | Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\ | |
14881 | Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14882 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."), | |
14883 | &enablelist); | |
14884 | ||
14885 | add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\ | |
14886 | Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\ | |
14887 | Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14888 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."), | |
14889 | &enablelist); | |
14890 | ||
14891 | add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\ | |
14892 | Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\ | |
14893 | Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\ | |
14894 | If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\ | |
14895 | the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."), | |
14896 | &enablelist); | |
14897 | ||
14898 | cmd_list_element *disable_cmd | |
14899 | = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ | |
14900 | Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | |
14901 | Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14902 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | |
14903 | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | |
14904 | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."), | |
14905 | &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist); | |
14906 | add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14907 | add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14908 | ||
14909 | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\ | |
14910 | Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\ | |
14911 | Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14912 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | |
14913 | To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\ | |
14914 | A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\ | |
14915 | This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."), | |
14916 | &disablelist); | |
14917 | ||
14918 | cmd_list_element *delete_cmd | |
14919 | = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ | |
14920 | Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\ | |
14921 | Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14922 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | |
14923 | To delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints,\n\ | |
14924 | give no argument.\n\ | |
14925 | \n\ | |
14926 | Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."), | |
14927 | &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist); | |
14928 | add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14929 | add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14930 | ||
14931 | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\ | |
14932 | Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\ | |
14933 | Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\ | |
14934 | Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\ | |
14935 | To delete all breakpoints, watchpoints, tracepoints, and catchpoints,\n\ | |
14936 | give no argument.\n\ | |
14937 | This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."), | |
14938 | &deletelist); | |
14939 | ||
14940 | cmd_list_element *clear_cmd | |
14941 | = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\ | |
14942 | Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\ | |
14943 | Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\ | |
14944 | \n\ | |
14945 | With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\ | |
14946 | is executing in.\n" | |
14947 | "\n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | |
14948 | See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number.")); | |
14949 | add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
14950 | ||
14951 | cmd_list_element *break_cmd | |
14952 | = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\ | |
14953 | Set breakpoint at specified location.\n" | |
14954 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break"))); | |
14955 | set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer); | |
14956 | ||
14957 | add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | |
14958 | add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | |
14959 | add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | |
14960 | add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1); | |
14961 | ||
14962 | cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd | |
14963 | = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\ | |
14964 | Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\ | |
14965 | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | |
14966 | \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\ | |
14967 | \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\ | |
14968 | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | |
14969 | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\ | |
14970 | breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | |
14971 | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | |
14972 | \n\ | |
14973 | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | |
14974 | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | |
14975 | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | |
14976 | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | |
14977 | breakpoint set.")); | |
14978 | ||
14979 | add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1); | |
14980 | ||
14981 | add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\ | |
14982 | Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\ | |
14983 | The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\ | |
14984 | \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\ | |
14985 | \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\ | |
14986 | \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\ | |
14987 | \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\ | |
14988 | \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\ | |
14989 | \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\ | |
14990 | The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\ | |
14991 | the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\ | |
14992 | breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\ | |
14993 | address and file/line number respectively.\n\ | |
14994 | \n\ | |
14995 | Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\ | |
14996 | are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\ | |
14997 | is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\ | |
14998 | Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\ | |
14999 | breakpoint set."), | |
15000 | &maintenanceinfolist); | |
15001 | ||
15002 | add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\ | |
15003 | Set catchpoints to catch events."), | |
15004 | &catch_cmdlist, | |
15005 | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | |
15006 | ||
15007 | add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\ | |
15008 | Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."), | |
15009 | &tcatch_cmdlist, | |
15010 | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | |
15011 | ||
15012 | const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr); | |
15013 | ||
15014 | static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | |
15015 | Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | |
15016 | Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | |
15017 | \n\ | |
15018 | Options:\n\ | |
15019 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | |
15020 | \n\ | |
15021 | A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | |
15022 | an expression changes."), opts); | |
15023 | c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, | |
15024 | watch_help.c_str ()); | |
15025 | set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | |
15026 | ||
15027 | static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | |
15028 | Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | |
15029 | Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | |
15030 | \n\ | |
15031 | Options:\n\ | |
15032 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | |
15033 | \n\ | |
15034 | A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\ | |
15035 | an expression is read."), opts); | |
15036 | c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, | |
15037 | rwatch_help.c_str ()); | |
15038 | set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | |
15039 | ||
15040 | static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\ | |
15041 | Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\ | |
15042 | Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\ | |
15043 | \n\ | |
15044 | Options:\n\ | |
15045 | %OPTIONS%\n\ | |
15046 | \n\ | |
15047 | An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\ | |
15048 | of an expression is either read or written."), opts); | |
15049 | c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, | |
15050 | awatch_help.c_str ()); | |
15051 | set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer); | |
15052 | ||
15053 | add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\ | |
15054 | Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument).")); | |
15055 | ||
15056 | /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should | |
15057 | respond to changes - contrary to the description. */ | |
15058 | add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support, | |
15059 | &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\ | |
15060 | Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | |
15061 | Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\ | |
15062 | If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\ | |
15063 | such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\ | |
15064 | created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\ | |
15065 | hardware.)"), | |
15066 | NULL, | |
15067 | show_can_use_hw_watchpoints, | |
15068 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15069 | ||
15070 | can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1; | |
15071 | ||
15072 | /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */ | |
15073 | ||
15074 | cmd_list_element *trace_cmd | |
15075 | = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\ | |
15076 | Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | |
15077 | \n" | |
15078 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\ | |
15079 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | |
15080 | set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer); | |
15081 | ||
15082 | add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0); | |
15083 | add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
15084 | add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
15085 | add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1); | |
15086 | ||
15087 | c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\ | |
15088 | Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\ | |
15089 | \n" | |
15090 | BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\ | |
15091 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | |
15092 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
15093 | ||
15094 | c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\ | |
15095 | Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\ | |
15096 | \n\ | |
15097 | strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\ | |
15098 | LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below)\n\ | |
15099 | or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\ | |
15100 | If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\ | |
15101 | no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\ | |
15102 | Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\ | |
15103 | This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\ | |
15104 | tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\ | |
15105 | by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\ | |
15106 | \n\ | |
15107 | CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\ | |
15108 | \n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING "\n\n\ | |
15109 | Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\ | |
15110 | conditions are different.\n\ | |
15111 | \n\ | |
15112 | Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\ | |
15113 | Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands.")); | |
15114 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
15115 | ||
15116 | cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd | |
15117 | = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\ | |
15118 | Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\ | |
15119 | Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\ | |
15120 | last tracepoint set.")); | |
15121 | ||
15122 | add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1); | |
15123 | ||
15124 | cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd | |
15125 | = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\ | |
15126 | Delete specified tracepoints.\n\ | |
15127 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | |
15128 | No argument means delete all tracepoints."), | |
15129 | &deletelist); | |
15130 | add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist); | |
15131 | ||
15132 | c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\ | |
15133 | Disable specified tracepoints.\n\ | |
15134 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | |
15135 | No argument means disable all tracepoints."), | |
15136 | &disablelist); | |
15137 | deprecate_cmd (c, "disable"); | |
15138 | ||
15139 | c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\ | |
15140 | Enable specified tracepoints.\n\ | |
15141 | Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\ | |
15142 | No argument means enable all tracepoints."), | |
15143 | &enablelist); | |
15144 | deprecate_cmd (c, "enable"); | |
15145 | ||
15146 | add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\ | |
15147 | Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\ | |
15148 | The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\ | |
15149 | Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\ | |
15150 | if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined.")); | |
15151 | ||
15152 | add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, | |
15153 | _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."), | |
15154 | &save_cmdlist, | |
15155 | 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist); | |
15156 | ||
15157 | c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\ | |
15158 | Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\ | |
15159 | This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\ | |
15160 | catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\ | |
15161 | session to restore them."), | |
15162 | &save_cmdlist); | |
15163 | set_cmd_completer (c, deprecated_filename_completer); | |
15164 | ||
15165 | cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd | |
15166 | = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\ | |
15167 | Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\ | |
15168 | Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."), | |
15169 | &save_cmdlist); | |
15170 | set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, deprecated_filename_completer); | |
15171 | ||
15172 | c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0); | |
15173 | deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints"); | |
15174 | ||
15175 | add_setshow_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, | |
15176 | _("\ | |
15177 | Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ | |
15178 | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | |
15179 | pending breakpoint behavior."), | |
15180 | _("\ | |
15181 | Breakpoint specific settings.\n\ | |
15182 | Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\ | |
15183 | pending breakpoint behavior."), | |
15184 | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, | |
15185 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15186 | ||
15187 | add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class, | |
15188 | &pending_break_support, _("\ | |
15189 | Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15190 | Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15191 | If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\ | |
15192 | pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\ | |
15193 | an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\ | |
15194 | user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."), | |
15195 | NULL, | |
15196 | show_pending_break_support, | |
15197 | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | |
15198 | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | |
15199 | ||
15200 | pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO; | |
15201 | ||
15202 | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class, | |
15203 | &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\ | |
15204 | Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15205 | Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15206 | If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\ | |
15207 | breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\ | |
15208 | a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."), | |
15209 | NULL, | |
15210 | show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints, | |
15211 | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | |
15212 | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | |
15213 | ||
15214 | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support, | |
15215 | &always_inserted_mode, _("\ | |
15216 | Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15217 | Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\ | |
15218 | When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\ | |
15219 | they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\ | |
15220 | only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\ | |
15221 | breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\ | |
15222 | when execution stops."), | |
15223 | NULL, | |
15224 | &show_always_inserted_mode, | |
15225 | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | |
15226 | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | |
15227 | ||
15228 | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, | |
15229 | &debug_breakpoint, _("\ | |
15230 | Set breakpoint location debugging."), _("\ | |
15231 | Show breakpoint location debugging."), _("\ | |
15232 | When on, breakpoint location specific debugging is enabled."), | |
15233 | NULL, | |
15234 | show_debug_breakpoint, | |
15235 | &setdebuglist, &showdebuglist); | |
15236 | ||
15237 | add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint, | |
15238 | condition_evaluation_enums, | |
15239 | &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\ | |
15240 | Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | |
15241 | Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\ | |
15242 | When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\ | |
15243 | evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\ | |
15244 | breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\ | |
15245 | supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\ | |
15246 | If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\ | |
15247 | \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\ | |
15248 | be set to \"host\"."), | |
15249 | &set_condition_evaluation_mode, | |
15250 | &show_condition_evaluation_mode, | |
15251 | &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, | |
15252 | &breakpoint_show_cmdlist); | |
15253 | ||
15254 | add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\ | |
15255 | Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\ | |
15256 | break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\ | |
15257 | where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\ | |
15258 | LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\ | |
15259 | FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\ | |
15260 | +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\ | |
15261 | or the start of the range\n\ | |
15262 | FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\ | |
15263 | FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\ | |
15264 | *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\ | |
15265 | \n\ | |
15266 | The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\ | |
15267 | an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\ | |
15268 | range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION).")); | |
15269 | ||
15270 | c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\ | |
15271 | Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\ | |
15272 | dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\ | |
15273 | location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n" | |
15274 | "\n" LOCATION_SPEC_HELP_STRING)); | |
15275 | set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer); | |
15276 | ||
15277 | add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support, | |
15278 | dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\ | |
15279 | Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | |
15280 | Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\ | |
15281 | This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\ | |
15282 | If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\ | |
15283 | console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\ | |
15284 | If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\ | |
15285 | program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\ | |
15286 | output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."), | |
15287 | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | |
15288 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15289 | ||
15290 | add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support, | |
15291 | &dprintf_function, _("\ | |
15292 | Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ | |
15293 | Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, | |
15294 | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | |
15295 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15296 | ||
15297 | add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support, | |
15298 | &dprintf_channel, _("\ | |
15299 | Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\ | |
15300 | Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL, | |
15301 | update_dprintf_commands, NULL, | |
15302 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15303 | ||
15304 | add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class, | |
15305 | &disconnected_dprintf, _("\ | |
15306 | Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | |
15307 | Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\ | |
15308 | Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\ | |
15309 | even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."), | |
15310 | NULL, | |
15311 | NULL, | |
15312 | &setlist, &showlist); | |
15313 | ||
15314 | add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\ | |
15315 | Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\ | |
15316 | Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\ | |
15317 | This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\ | |
15318 | This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands.")); | |
15319 | ||
15320 | automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true; | |
15321 | ||
15322 | gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed, | |
15323 | "breakpoint"); | |
15324 | gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints, | |
15325 | "breakpoint"); | |
15326 | gdb::observers::inferior_removed.attach (remove_inferior_breakpoints, | |
15327 | "breakpoint"); | |
15328 | } |